Subversion Repositories planix.SVN

Rev

Blame | Last modification | View Log | RSS feed

/* vi:set ts=8 sts=4 sw=4:
 *
 * VIM - Vi IMproved    by Bram Moolenaar
 *
 * Do ":help uganda"  in Vim to read copying and usage conditions.
 * Do ":help credits" in Vim to see a list of people who contributed.
 * See README.txt for an overview of the Vim source code.
 */

/*
 * spell.c: code for spell checking
 *
 * The spell checking mechanism uses a tree (aka trie).  Each node in the tree
 * has a list of bytes that can appear (siblings).  For each byte there is a
 * pointer to the node with the byte that follows in the word (child).
 *
 * A NUL byte is used where the word may end.  The bytes are sorted, so that
 * binary searching can be used and the NUL bytes are at the start.  The
 * number of possible bytes is stored before the list of bytes.
 *
 * The tree uses two arrays: "byts" stores the characters, "idxs" stores
 * either the next index or flags.  The tree starts at index 0.  For example,
 * to lookup "vi" this sequence is followed:
 *      i = 0
 *      len = byts[i]
 *      n = where "v" appears in byts[i + 1] to byts[i + len]
 *      i = idxs[n]
 *      len = byts[i]
 *      n = where "i" appears in byts[i + 1] to byts[i + len]
 *      i = idxs[n]
 *      len = byts[i]
 *      find that byts[i + 1] is 0, idxs[i + 1] has flags for "vi".
 *
 * There are two word trees: one with case-folded words and one with words in
 * original case.  The second one is only used for keep-case words and is
 * usually small.
 *
 * There is one additional tree for when not all prefixes are applied when
 * generating the .spl file.  This tree stores all the possible prefixes, as
 * if they were words.  At each word (prefix) end the prefix nr is stored, the
 * following word must support this prefix nr.  And the condition nr is
 * stored, used to lookup the condition that the word must match with.
 *
 * Thanks to Olaf Seibert for providing an example implementation of this tree
 * and the compression mechanism.
 * LZ trie ideas:
 *      http://www.irb.hr/hr/home/ristov/papers/RistovLZtrieRevision1.pdf
 * More papers: http://www-igm.univ-mlv.fr/~laporte/publi_en.html
 *
 * Matching involves checking the caps type: Onecap ALLCAP KeepCap.
 *
 * Why doesn't Vim use aspell/ispell/myspell/etc.?
 * See ":help develop-spell".
 */

/* Use SPELL_PRINTTREE for debugging: dump the word tree after adding a word.
 * Only use it for small word lists! */
#if 0
# define SPELL_PRINTTREE
#endif

/* Use DEBUG_TRIEWALK to print the changes made in suggest_trie_walk() for a
 * specific word. */
#if 0
# define DEBUG_TRIEWALK
#endif

/*
 * Use this to adjust the score after finding suggestions, based on the
 * suggested word sounding like the bad word.  This is much faster than doing
 * it for every possible suggestion.
 * Disadvantage: When "the" is typed as "hte" it sounds quite different ("@"
 * vs "ht") and goes down in the list.
 * Used when 'spellsuggest' is set to "best".
 */
#define RESCORE(word_score, sound_score) ((3 * word_score + sound_score) / 4)

/*
 * Do the opposite: based on a maximum end score and a known sound score,
 * compute the the maximum word score that can be used.
 */
#define MAXSCORE(word_score, sound_score) ((4 * word_score - sound_score) / 3)

/*
 * Vim spell file format: <HEADER>
 *                        <SECTIONS>
 *                        <LWORDTREE>
 *                        <KWORDTREE>
 *                        <PREFIXTREE>
 *
 * <HEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr>
 *
 * <fileID>     8 bytes    "VIMspell"
 * <versionnr>  1 byte      VIMSPELLVERSION
 *
 *
 * Sections make it possible to add information to the .spl file without
 * making it incompatible with previous versions.  There are two kinds of
 * sections:
 * 1. Not essential for correct spell checking.  E.g. for making suggestions.
 *    These are skipped when not supported.
 * 2. Optional information, but essential for spell checking when present.
 *    E.g. conditions for affixes.  When this section is present but not
 *    supported an error message is given.
 *
 * <SECTIONS>: <section> ... <sectionend>
 *
 * <section>: <sectionID> <sectionflags> <sectionlen> (section contents)
 *
 * <sectionID>    1 byte    number from 0 to 254 identifying the section
 *
 * <sectionflags> 1 byte    SNF_REQUIRED: this section is required for correct
 *                                          spell checking
 *
 * <sectionlen>   4 bytes   length of section contents, MSB first
 *
 * <sectionend>   1 byte    SN_END
 *
 *
 * sectionID == SN_INFO: <infotext>
 * <infotext>    N bytes    free format text with spell file info (version,
 *                          website, etc)
 *
 * sectionID == SN_REGION: <regionname> ...
 * <regionname>  2 bytes    Up to 8 region names: ca, au, etc.  Lower case.
 *                          First <regionname> is region 1.
 *
 * sectionID == SN_CHARFLAGS: <charflagslen> <charflags>
 *                              <folcharslen> <folchars>
 * <charflagslen> 1 byte    Number of bytes in <charflags> (should be 128).
 * <charflags>  N bytes     List of flags (first one is for character 128):
 *                          0x01  word character        CF_WORD
 *                          0x02  upper-case character  CF_UPPER
 * <folcharslen>  2 bytes   Number of bytes in <folchars>.
 * <folchars>     N bytes   Folded characters, first one is for character 128.
 *
 * sectionID == SN_MIDWORD: <midword>
 * <midword>     N bytes    Characters that are word characters only when used
 *                          in the middle of a word.
 *
 * sectionID == SN_PREFCOND: <prefcondcnt> <prefcond> ...
 * <prefcondcnt> 2 bytes    Number of <prefcond> items following.
 * <prefcond> : <condlen> <condstr>
 * <condlen>    1 byte      Length of <condstr>.
 * <condstr>    N bytes     Condition for the prefix.
 *
 * sectionID == SN_REP: <repcount> <rep> ...
 * <repcount>    2 bytes    number of <rep> items, MSB first.
 * <rep> : <repfromlen> <repfrom> <reptolen> <repto>
 * <repfromlen>  1 byte     length of <repfrom>
 * <repfrom>     N bytes    "from" part of replacement
 * <reptolen>    1 byte     length of <repto>
 * <repto>       N bytes    "to" part of replacement
 *
 * sectionID == SN_REPSAL: <repcount> <rep> ...
 *   just like SN_REP but for soundfolded words
 *
 * sectionID == SN_SAL: <salflags> <salcount> <sal> ...
 * <salflags>    1 byte     flags for soundsalike conversion:
 *                          SAL_F0LLOWUP
 *                          SAL_COLLAPSE
 *                          SAL_REM_ACCENTS
 * <salcount>    2 bytes    number of <sal> items following
 * <sal> : <salfromlen> <salfrom> <saltolen> <salto>
 * <salfromlen>  1 byte     length of <salfrom>
 * <salfrom>     N bytes    "from" part of soundsalike
 * <saltolen>    1 byte     length of <salto>
 * <salto>       N bytes    "to" part of soundsalike
 *
 * sectionID == SN_SOFO: <sofofromlen> <sofofrom> <sofotolen> <sofoto>
 * <sofofromlen> 2 bytes    length of <sofofrom>
 * <sofofrom>    N bytes    "from" part of soundfold
 * <sofotolen>   2 bytes    length of <sofoto>
 * <sofoto>      N bytes    "to" part of soundfold
 *
 * sectionID == SN_SUGFILE: <timestamp>
 * <timestamp>   8 bytes    time in seconds that must match with .sug file
 *
 * sectionID == SN_NOSPLITSUGS: nothing
 *
 * sectionID == SN_WORDS: <word> ...
 * <word>        N bytes    NUL terminated common word
 *
 * sectionID == SN_MAP: <mapstr>
 * <mapstr>      N bytes    String with sequences of similar characters,
 *                          separated by slashes.
 *
 * sectionID == SN_COMPOUND: <compmax> <compminlen> <compsylmax> <compoptions>
 *                              <comppatcount> <comppattern> ... <compflags>
 * <compmax>     1 byte     Maximum nr of words in compound word.
 * <compminlen>  1 byte     Minimal word length for compounding.
 * <compsylmax>  1 byte     Maximum nr of syllables in compound word.
 * <compoptions> 2 bytes    COMP_ flags.
 * <comppatcount> 2 bytes   number of <comppattern> following
 * <compflags>   N bytes    Flags from COMPOUNDRULE items, separated by
 *                          slashes.
 *
 * <comppattern>: <comppatlen> <comppattext>
 * <comppatlen>  1 byte     length of <comppattext>
 * <comppattext> N bytes    end or begin chars from CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN
 *
 * sectionID == SN_NOBREAK: (empty, its presence is what matters)
 *
 * sectionID == SN_SYLLABLE: <syllable>
 * <syllable>    N bytes    String from SYLLABLE item.
 *
 * <LWORDTREE>: <wordtree>
 *
 * <KWORDTREE>: <wordtree>
 *
 * <PREFIXTREE>: <wordtree>
 *
 *
 * <wordtree>: <nodecount> <nodedata> ...
 *
 * <nodecount>  4 bytes     Number of nodes following.  MSB first.
 *
 * <nodedata>: <siblingcount> <sibling> ...
 *
 * <siblingcount> 1 byte    Number of siblings in this node.  The siblings
 *                          follow in sorted order.
 *
 * <sibling>: <byte> [ <nodeidx> <xbyte>
 *                    | <flags> [<flags2>] [<region>] [<affixID>]
 *                    | [<pflags>] <affixID> <prefcondnr> ]
 *
 * <byte>       1 byte      Byte value of the sibling.  Special cases:
 *                          BY_NOFLAGS: End of word without flags and for all
 *                                      regions.
 *                                      For PREFIXTREE <affixID> and
 *                                      <prefcondnr> follow.
 *                          BY_FLAGS:   End of word, <flags> follow.
 *                                      For PREFIXTREE <pflags>, <affixID>
 *                                      and <prefcondnr> follow.
 *                          BY_FLAGS2:  End of word, <flags> and <flags2>
 *                                      follow.  Not used in PREFIXTREE.
 *                          BY_INDEX:   Child of sibling is shared, <nodeidx>
 *                                      and <xbyte> follow.
 *
 * <nodeidx>    3 bytes     Index of child for this sibling, MSB first.
 *
 * <xbyte>      1 byte      byte value of the sibling.
 *
 * <flags>      1 byte      bitmask of:
 *                          WF_ALLCAP   word must have only capitals
 *                          WF_ONECAP   first char of word must be capital
 *                          WF_KEEPCAP  keep-case word
 *                          WF_FIXCAP   keep-case word, all caps not allowed
 *                          WF_RARE     rare word
 *                          WF_BANNED   bad word
 *                          WF_REGION   <region> follows
 *                          WF_AFX      <affixID> follows
 *
 * <flags2>     1 byte      Bitmask of:
 *                          WF_HAS_AFF >> 8   word includes affix
 *                          WF_NEEDCOMP >> 8  word only valid in compound
 *                          WF_NOSUGGEST >> 8  word not used for suggestions
 *                          WF_COMPROOT >> 8  word already a compound
 *                          WF_NOCOMPBEF >> 8 no compounding before this word
 *                          WF_NOCOMPAFT >> 8 no compounding after this word
 *
 * <pflags>     1 byte      bitmask of:
 *                          WFP_RARE    rare prefix
 *                          WFP_NC      non-combining prefix
 *                          WFP_UP      letter after prefix made upper case
 *
 * <region>     1 byte      Bitmask for regions in which word is valid.  When
 *                          omitted it's valid in all regions.
 *                          Lowest bit is for region 1.
 *
 * <affixID>    1 byte      ID of affix that can be used with this word.  In
 *                          PREFIXTREE used for the required prefix ID.
 *
 * <prefcondnr> 2 bytes     Prefix condition number, index in <prefcond> list
 *                          from HEADER.
 *
 * All text characters are in 'encoding', but stored as single bytes.
 */

/*
 * Vim .sug file format:  <SUGHEADER>
 *                        <SUGWORDTREE>
 *                        <SUGTABLE>
 *
 * <SUGHEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr> <timestamp>
 *
 * <fileID>     6 bytes     "VIMsug"
 * <versionnr>  1 byte      VIMSUGVERSION
 * <timestamp>  8 bytes     timestamp that must match with .spl file
 *
 *
 * <SUGWORDTREE>: <wordtree>  (see above, no flags or region used)
 *
 *
 * <SUGTABLE>: <sugwcount> <sugline> ...
 *
 * <sugwcount>  4 bytes     number of <sugline> following
 *
 * <sugline>: <sugnr> ... NUL
 *
 * <sugnr>:     X bytes     word number that results in this soundfolded word,
 *                          stored as an offset to the previous number in as
 *                          few bytes as possible, see offset2bytes())
 */

#if defined(MSDOS) || defined(WIN16) || defined(WIN32) || defined(_WIN64)
# include "vimio.h"     /* for lseek(), must be before vim.h */
#endif

#include "vim.h"

#if defined(FEAT_SPELL) || defined(PROTO)

#ifdef HAVE_FCNTL_H
# include <fcntl.h>
#endif

#ifndef UNIX            /* it's in os_unix.h for Unix */
# include <time.h>      /* for time_t */
#endif

#define MAXWLEN 250             /* Assume max. word len is this many bytes.
                                   Some places assume a word length fits in a
                                   byte, thus it can't be above 255. */

/* Type used for indexes in the word tree need to be at least 4 bytes.  If int
 * is 8 bytes we could use something smaller, but what? */
#if SIZEOF_INT > 3
typedef int idx_T;
#else
typedef long idx_T;
#endif

/* Flags used for a word.  Only the lowest byte can be used, the region byte
 * comes above it. */
#define WF_REGION   0x01        /* region byte follows */
#define WF_ONECAP   0x02        /* word with one capital (or all capitals) */
#define WF_ALLCAP   0x04        /* word must be all capitals */
#define WF_RARE     0x08        /* rare word */
#define WF_BANNED   0x10        /* bad word */
#define WF_AFX      0x20        /* affix ID follows */
#define WF_FIXCAP   0x40        /* keep-case word, allcap not allowed */
#define WF_KEEPCAP  0x80        /* keep-case word */

/* for <flags2>, shifted up one byte to be used in wn_flags */
#define WF_HAS_AFF  0x0100      /* word includes affix */
#define WF_NEEDCOMP 0x0200      /* word only valid in compound */
#define WF_NOSUGGEST 0x0400     /* word not to be suggested */
#define WF_COMPROOT 0x0800      /* already compounded word, COMPOUNDROOT */
#define WF_NOCOMPBEF 0x1000     /* no compounding before this word */
#define WF_NOCOMPAFT 0x2000     /* no compounding after this word */

/* only used for su_badflags */
#define WF_MIXCAP   0x20        /* mix of upper and lower case: macaRONI */

#define WF_CAPMASK (WF_ONECAP | WF_ALLCAP | WF_KEEPCAP | WF_FIXCAP)

/* flags for <pflags> */
#define WFP_RARE            0x01        /* rare prefix */
#define WFP_NC              0x02        /* prefix is not combining */
#define WFP_UP              0x04        /* to-upper prefix */
#define WFP_COMPPERMIT      0x08        /* prefix with COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG */
#define WFP_COMPFORBID      0x10        /* prefix with COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG */

/* Flags for postponed prefixes in "sl_pidxs".  Must be above affixID (one
 * byte) and prefcondnr (two bytes). */
#define WF_RAREPFX  (WFP_RARE << 24)    /* rare postponed prefix */
#define WF_PFX_NC   (WFP_NC << 24)      /* non-combining postponed prefix */
#define WF_PFX_UP   (WFP_UP << 24)      /* to-upper postponed prefix */
#define WF_PFX_COMPPERMIT (WFP_COMPPERMIT << 24) /* postponed prefix with
                                                  * COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG */
#define WF_PFX_COMPFORBID (WFP_COMPFORBID << 24) /* postponed prefix with
                                                  * COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG */


/* flags for <compoptions> */
#define COMP_CHECKDUP           1       /* CHECKCOMPOUNDDUP */
#define COMP_CHECKREP           2       /* CHECKCOMPOUNDREP */
#define COMP_CHECKCASE          4       /* CHECKCOMPOUNDCASE */
#define COMP_CHECKTRIPLE        8       /* CHECKCOMPOUNDTRIPLE */

/* Special byte values for <byte>.  Some are only used in the tree for
 * postponed prefixes, some only in the other trees.  This is a bit messy... */
#define BY_NOFLAGS      0        /* end of word without flags or region; for
                                 * postponed prefix: no <pflags> */
#define BY_INDEX        1       /* child is shared, index follows */
#define BY_FLAGS        2       /* end of word, <flags> byte follows; for
                                 * postponed prefix: <pflags> follows */
#define BY_FLAGS2       3       /* end of word, <flags> and <flags2> bytes
                                 * follow; never used in prefix tree */
#define BY_SPECIAL  BY_FLAGS2   /* highest special byte value */

/* Info from "REP", "REPSAL" and "SAL" entries in ".aff" file used in si_rep,
 * si_repsal, sl_rep, and si_sal.  Not for sl_sal!
 * One replacement: from "ft_from" to "ft_to". */
typedef struct fromto_S
{
    char_u      *ft_from;
    char_u      *ft_to;
} fromto_T;

/* Info from "SAL" entries in ".aff" file used in sl_sal.
 * The info is split for quick processing by spell_soundfold().
 * Note that "sm_oneof" and "sm_rules" point into sm_lead. */
typedef struct salitem_S
{
    char_u      *sm_lead;       /* leading letters */
    int         sm_leadlen;     /* length of "sm_lead" */
    char_u      *sm_oneof;      /* letters from () or NULL */
    char_u      *sm_rules;      /* rules like ^, $, priority */
    char_u      *sm_to;         /* replacement. */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    int         *sm_lead_w;     /* wide character copy of "sm_lead" */
    int         *sm_oneof_w;    /* wide character copy of "sm_oneof" */
    int         *sm_to_w;       /* wide character copy of "sm_to" */
#endif
} salitem_T;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
typedef int salfirst_T;
#else
typedef short salfirst_T;
#endif

/* Values for SP_*ERROR are negative, positive values are used by
 * read_cnt_string(). */
#define SP_TRUNCERROR   -1      /* spell file truncated error */
#define SP_FORMERROR    -2      /* format error in spell file */
#define SP_OTHERERROR   -3      /* other error while reading spell file */

/*
 * Structure used to store words and other info for one language, loaded from
 * a .spl file.
 * The main access is through the tree in "sl_fbyts/sl_fidxs", storing the
 * case-folded words.  "sl_kbyts/sl_kidxs" is for keep-case words.
 *
 * The "byts" array stores the possible bytes in each tree node, preceded by
 * the number of possible bytes, sorted on byte value:
 *      <len> <byte1> <byte2> ...
 * The "idxs" array stores the index of the child node corresponding to the
 * byte in "byts".
 * Exception: when the byte is zero, the word may end here and "idxs" holds
 * the flags, region mask and affixID for the word.  There may be several
 * zeros in sequence for alternative flag/region/affixID combinations.
 */
typedef struct slang_S slang_T;
struct slang_S
{
    slang_T     *sl_next;       /* next language */
    char_u      *sl_name;       /* language name "en", "en.rare", "nl", etc. */
    char_u      *sl_fname;      /* name of .spl file */
    int         sl_add;         /* TRUE if it's a .add file. */

    char_u      *sl_fbyts;      /* case-folded word bytes */
    idx_T       *sl_fidxs;      /* case-folded word indexes */
    char_u      *sl_kbyts;      /* keep-case word bytes */
    idx_T       *sl_kidxs;      /* keep-case word indexes */
    char_u      *sl_pbyts;      /* prefix tree word bytes */
    idx_T       *sl_pidxs;      /* prefix tree word indexes */

    char_u      *sl_info;       /* infotext string or NULL */

    char_u      sl_regions[17]; /* table with up to 8 region names plus NUL */

    char_u      *sl_midword;    /* MIDWORD string or NULL */

    hashtab_T   sl_wordcount;   /* hashtable with word count, wordcount_T */

    int         sl_compmax;     /* COMPOUNDWORDMAX (default: MAXWLEN) */
    int         sl_compminlen;  /* COMPOUNDMIN (default: 0) */
    int         sl_compsylmax;  /* COMPOUNDSYLMAX (default: MAXWLEN) */
    int         sl_compoptions; /* COMP_* flags */
    garray_T    sl_comppat;     /* CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN items */
    regprog_T   *sl_compprog;   /* COMPOUNDRULE turned into a regexp progrm
                                 * (NULL when no compounding) */
    char_u      *sl_compstartflags; /* flags for first compound word */
    char_u      *sl_compallflags; /* all flags for compound words */
    char_u      sl_nobreak;     /* When TRUE: no spaces between words */
    char_u      *sl_syllable;   /* SYLLABLE repeatable chars or NULL */
    garray_T    sl_syl_items;   /* syllable items */

    int         sl_prefixcnt;   /* number of items in "sl_prefprog" */
    regprog_T   **sl_prefprog;  /* table with regprogs for prefixes */

    garray_T    sl_rep;         /* list of fromto_T entries from REP lines */
    short       sl_rep_first[256];  /* indexes where byte first appears, -1 if
                                       there is none */
    garray_T    sl_sal;         /* list of salitem_T entries from SAL lines */
    salfirst_T  sl_sal_first[256];  /* indexes where byte first appears, -1 if
                                       there is none */
    int         sl_followup;    /* SAL followup */
    int         sl_collapse;    /* SAL collapse_result */
    int         sl_rem_accents; /* SAL remove_accents */
    int         sl_sofo;        /* SOFOFROM and SOFOTO instead of SAL items:
                                 * "sl_sal_first" maps chars, when has_mbyte
                                 * "sl_sal" is a list of wide char lists. */
    garray_T    sl_repsal;      /* list of fromto_T entries from REPSAL lines */
    short       sl_repsal_first[256];  /* sl_rep_first for REPSAL lines */
    int         sl_nosplitsugs; /* don't suggest splitting a word */

    /* Info from the .sug file.  Loaded on demand. */
    time_t      sl_sugtime;     /* timestamp for .sug file */
    char_u      *sl_sbyts;      /* soundfolded word bytes */
    idx_T       *sl_sidxs;      /* soundfolded word indexes */
    buf_T       *sl_sugbuf;     /* buffer with word number table */
    int         sl_sugloaded;   /* TRUE when .sug file was loaded or failed to
                                   load */

    int         sl_has_map;     /* TRUE if there is a MAP line */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    hashtab_T   sl_map_hash;    /* MAP for multi-byte chars */
    int         sl_map_array[256]; /* MAP for first 256 chars */
#else
    char_u      sl_map_array[256]; /* MAP for first 256 chars */
#endif
    hashtab_T   sl_sounddone;   /* table with soundfolded words that have
                                   handled, see add_sound_suggest() */
};

/* First language that is loaded, start of the linked list of loaded
 * languages. */
static slang_T *first_lang = NULL;

/* Flags used in .spl file for soundsalike flags. */
#define SAL_F0LLOWUP            1
#define SAL_COLLAPSE            2
#define SAL_REM_ACCENTS         4

/*
 * Structure used in "b_langp", filled from 'spelllang'.
 */
typedef struct langp_S
{
    slang_T     *lp_slang;      /* info for this language */
    slang_T     *lp_sallang;    /* language used for sound folding or NULL */
    slang_T     *lp_replang;    /* language used for REP items or NULL */
    int         lp_region;      /* bitmask for region or REGION_ALL */
} langp_T;

#define LANGP_ENTRY(ga, i)      (((langp_T *)(ga).ga_data) + (i))

#define REGION_ALL 0xff         /* word valid in all regions */

#define VIMSPELLMAGIC "VIMspell"  /* string at start of Vim spell file */
#define VIMSPELLMAGICL 8
#define VIMSPELLVERSION 50

#define VIMSUGMAGIC "VIMsug"    /* string at start of Vim .sug file */
#define VIMSUGMAGICL 6
#define VIMSUGVERSION 1

/* Section IDs.  Only renumber them when VIMSPELLVERSION changes! */
#define SN_REGION       0        /* <regionname> section */
#define SN_CHARFLAGS    1       /* charflags section */
#define SN_MIDWORD      2       /* <midword> section */
#define SN_PREFCOND     3       /* <prefcond> section */
#define SN_REP          4       /* REP items section */
#define SN_SAL          5       /* SAL items section */
#define SN_SOFO         6       /* soundfolding section */
#define SN_MAP          7       /* MAP items section */
#define SN_COMPOUND     8       /* compound words section */
#define SN_SYLLABLE     9       /* syllable section */
#define SN_NOBREAK      10      /* NOBREAK section */
#define SN_SUGFILE      11      /* timestamp for .sug file */
#define SN_REPSAL       12      /* REPSAL items section */
#define SN_WORDS        13      /* common words */
#define SN_NOSPLITSUGS  14      /* don't split word for suggestions */
#define SN_INFO         15      /* info section */
#define SN_END          255     /* end of sections */

#define SNF_REQUIRED    1       /* <sectionflags>: required section */

/* Result values.  Lower number is accepted over higher one. */
#define SP_BANNED       -1
#define SP_OK           0
#define SP_RARE         1
#define SP_LOCAL        2
#define SP_BAD          3

/* file used for "zG" and "zW" */
static char_u   *int_wordlist = NULL;

typedef struct wordcount_S
{
    short_u     wc_count;           /* nr of times word was seen */
    char_u      wc_word[1];         /* word, actually longer */
} wordcount_T;

static wordcount_T dumwc;
#define WC_KEY_OFF  (unsigned)(dumwc.wc_word - (char_u *)&dumwc)
#define HI2WC(hi)     ((wordcount_T *)((hi)->hi_key - WC_KEY_OFF))
#define MAXWORDCOUNT 0xffff

/*
 * Information used when looking for suggestions.
 */
typedef struct suginfo_S
{
    garray_T    su_ga;              /* suggestions, contains "suggest_T" */
    int         su_maxcount;        /* max. number of suggestions displayed */
    int         su_maxscore;        /* maximum score for adding to su_ga */
    int         su_sfmaxscore;      /* idem, for when doing soundfold words */
    garray_T    su_sga;             /* like su_ga, sound-folded scoring */
    char_u      *su_badptr;         /* start of bad word in line */
    int         su_badlen;          /* length of detected bad word in line */
    int         su_badflags;        /* caps flags for bad word */
    char_u      su_badword[MAXWLEN]; /* bad word truncated at su_badlen */
    char_u      su_fbadword[MAXWLEN]; /* su_badword case-folded */
    char_u      su_sal_badword[MAXWLEN]; /* su_badword soundfolded */
    hashtab_T   su_banned;          /* table with banned words */
    slang_T     *su_sallang;        /* default language for sound folding */
} suginfo_T;

/* One word suggestion.  Used in "si_ga". */
typedef struct suggest_S
{
    char_u      *st_word;       /* suggested word, allocated string */
    int         st_wordlen;     /* STRLEN(st_word) */
    int         st_orglen;      /* length of replaced text */
    int         st_score;       /* lower is better */
    int         st_altscore;    /* used when st_score compares equal */
    int         st_salscore;    /* st_score is for soundalike */
    int         st_had_bonus;   /* bonus already included in score */
    slang_T     *st_slang;      /* language used for sound folding */
} suggest_T;

#define SUG(ga, i) (((suggest_T *)(ga).ga_data)[i])

/* TRUE if a word appears in the list of banned words.  */
#define WAS_BANNED(su, word) (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hash_find(&su->su_banned, word)))

/* Number of suggestions kept when cleaning up.  we need to keep more than
 * what is displayed, because when rescore_suggestions() is called the score
 * may change and wrong suggestions may be removed later. */
#define SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su)    ((su)->su_maxcount < 130 ? 150 : (su)->su_maxcount + 20)

/* Threshold for sorting and cleaning up suggestions.  Don't want to keep lots
 * of suggestions that are not going to be displayed. */
#define SUG_MAX_COUNT(su)       (SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su) + 50)

/* score for various changes */
#define SCORE_SPLIT     149     /* split bad word */
#define SCORE_SPLIT_NO  249     /* split bad word with NOSPLITSUGS */
#define SCORE_ICASE     52      /* slightly different case */
#define SCORE_REGION    200     /* word is for different region */
#define SCORE_RARE      180     /* rare word */
#define SCORE_SWAP      75      /* swap two characters */
#define SCORE_SWAP3     110     /* swap two characters in three */
#define SCORE_REP       65      /* REP replacement */
#define SCORE_SUBST     93      /* substitute a character */
#define SCORE_SIMILAR   33      /* substitute a similar character */
#define SCORE_SUBCOMP   33      /* substitute a composing character */
#define SCORE_DEL       94      /* delete a character */
#define SCORE_DELDUP    66      /* delete a duplicated character */
#define SCORE_DELCOMP   28      /* delete a composing character */
#define SCORE_INS       96      /* insert a character */
#define SCORE_INSDUP    67      /* insert a duplicate character */
#define SCORE_INSCOMP   30      /* insert a composing character */
#define SCORE_NONWORD   103     /* change non-word to word char */

#define SCORE_FILE      30      /* suggestion from a file */
#define SCORE_MAXINIT   350     /* Initial maximum score: higher == slower.
                                 * 350 allows for about three changes. */

#define SCORE_COMMON1   30      /* subtracted for words seen before */
#define SCORE_COMMON2   40      /* subtracted for words often seen */
#define SCORE_COMMON3   50      /* subtracted for words very often seen */
#define SCORE_THRES2    10      /* word count threshold for COMMON2 */
#define SCORE_THRES3    100     /* word count threshold for COMMON3 */

/* When trying changed soundfold words it becomes slow when trying more than
 * two changes.  With less then two changes it's slightly faster but we miss a
 * few good suggestions.  In rare cases we need to try three of four changes.
 */
#define SCORE_SFMAX1    200     /* maximum score for first try */
#define SCORE_SFMAX2    300     /* maximum score for second try */
#define SCORE_SFMAX3    400     /* maximum score for third try */

#define SCORE_BIG       SCORE_INS * 3   /* big difference */
#define SCORE_MAXMAX    999999          /* accept any score */
#define SCORE_LIMITMAX  350             /* for spell_edit_score_limit() */

/* for spell_edit_score_limit() we need to know the minimum value of
 * SCORE_ICASE, SCORE_SWAP, SCORE_DEL, SCORE_SIMILAR and SCORE_INS */
#define SCORE_EDIT_MIN  SCORE_SIMILAR

/*
 * Structure to store info for word matching.
 */
typedef struct matchinf_S
{
    langp_T     *mi_lp;                 /* info for language and region */

    /* pointers to original text to be checked */
    char_u      *mi_word;               /* start of word being checked */
    char_u      *mi_end;                /* end of matching word so far */
    char_u      *mi_fend;               /* next char to be added to mi_fword */
    char_u      *mi_cend;               /* char after what was used for
                                           mi_capflags */

    /* case-folded text */
    char_u      mi_fword[MAXWLEN + 1];  /* mi_word case-folded */
    int         mi_fwordlen;            /* nr of valid bytes in mi_fword */

    /* for when checking word after a prefix */
    int         mi_prefarridx;          /* index in sl_pidxs with list of
                                           affixID/condition */
    int         mi_prefcnt;             /* number of entries at mi_prefarridx */
    int         mi_prefixlen;           /* byte length of prefix */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    int         mi_cprefixlen;          /* byte length of prefix in original
                                           case */
#else
# define mi_cprefixlen mi_prefixlen     /* it's the same value */
#endif

    /* for when checking a compound word */
    int         mi_compoff;             /* start of following word offset */
    char_u      mi_compflags[MAXWLEN];  /* flags for compound words used */
    int         mi_complen;             /* nr of compound words used */
    int         mi_compextra;           /* nr of COMPOUNDROOT words */

    /* others */
    int         mi_result;              /* result so far: SP_BAD, SP_OK, etc. */
    int         mi_capflags;            /* WF_ONECAP WF_ALLCAP WF_KEEPCAP */
    buf_T       *mi_buf;                /* buffer being checked */

    /* for NOBREAK */
    int         mi_result2;             /* "mi_resul" without following word */
    char_u      *mi_end2;               /* "mi_end" without following word */
} matchinf_T;

/*
 * The tables used for recognizing word characters according to spelling.
 * These are only used for the first 256 characters of 'encoding'.
 */
typedef struct spelltab_S
{
    char_u  st_isw[256];        /* flags: is word char */
    char_u  st_isu[256];        /* flags: is uppercase char */
    char_u  st_fold[256];       /* chars: folded case */
    char_u  st_upper[256];      /* chars: upper case */
} spelltab_T;

static spelltab_T   spelltab;
static int          did_set_spelltab;

#define CF_WORD         0x01
#define CF_UPPER        0x02

static void clear_spell_chartab __ARGS((spelltab_T *sp));
static int set_spell_finish __ARGS((spelltab_T  *new_st));
static int spell_iswordp __ARGS((char_u *p, buf_T *buf));
static int spell_iswordp_nmw __ARGS((char_u *p));
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
static int spell_iswordp_w __ARGS((int *p, buf_T *buf));
#endif
static int write_spell_prefcond __ARGS((FILE *fd, garray_T *gap));

/*
 * For finding suggestions: At each node in the tree these states are tried:
 */
typedef enum
{
    STATE_START = 0,    /* At start of node check for NUL bytes (goodword
                         * ends); if badword ends there is a match, otherwise
                         * try splitting word. */
    STATE_NOPREFIX,     /* try without prefix */
    STATE_SPLITUNDO,    /* Undo splitting. */
    STATE_ENDNUL,       /* Past NUL bytes at start of the node. */
    STATE_PLAIN,        /* Use each byte of the node. */
    STATE_DEL,          /* Delete a byte from the bad word. */
    STATE_INS_PREP,     /* Prepare for inserting bytes. */
    STATE_INS,          /* Insert a byte in the bad word. */
    STATE_SWAP,         /* Swap two bytes. */
    STATE_UNSWAP,       /* Undo swap two characters. */
    STATE_SWAP3,        /* Swap two characters over three. */
    STATE_UNSWAP3,      /* Undo Swap two characters over three. */
    STATE_UNROT3L,      /* Undo rotate three characters left */
    STATE_UNROT3R,      /* Undo rotate three characters right */
    STATE_REP_INI,      /* Prepare for using REP items. */
    STATE_REP,          /* Use matching REP items from the .aff file. */
    STATE_REP_UNDO,     /* Undo a REP item replacement. */
    STATE_FINAL         /* End of this node. */
} state_T;

/*
 * Struct to keep the state at each level in suggest_try_change().
 */
typedef struct trystate_S
{
    state_T     ts_state;       /* state at this level, STATE_ */
    int         ts_score;       /* score */
    idx_T       ts_arridx;      /* index in tree array, start of node */
    short       ts_curi;        /* index in list of child nodes */
    char_u      ts_fidx;        /* index in fword[], case-folded bad word */
    char_u      ts_fidxtry;     /* ts_fidx at which bytes may be changed */
    char_u      ts_twordlen;    /* valid length of tword[] */
    char_u      ts_prefixdepth; /* stack depth for end of prefix or
                                 * PFD_PREFIXTREE or PFD_NOPREFIX */
    char_u      ts_flags;       /* TSF_ flags */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    char_u      ts_tcharlen;    /* number of bytes in tword character */
    char_u      ts_tcharidx;    /* current byte index in tword character */
    char_u      ts_isdiff;      /* DIFF_ values */
    char_u      ts_fcharstart;  /* index in fword where badword char started */
#endif
    char_u      ts_prewordlen;  /* length of word in "preword[]" */
    char_u      ts_splitoff;    /* index in "tword" after last split */
    char_u      ts_splitfidx;   /* "ts_fidx" at word split */
    char_u      ts_complen;     /* nr of compound words used */
    char_u      ts_compsplit;   /* index for "compflags" where word was spit */
    char_u      ts_save_badflags;   /* su_badflags saved here */
    char_u      ts_delidx;      /* index in fword for char that was deleted,
                                   valid when "ts_flags" has TSF_DIDDEL */
} trystate_T;

/* values for ts_isdiff */
#define DIFF_NONE       0        /* no different byte (yet) */
#define DIFF_YES        1       /* different byte found */
#define DIFF_INSERT     2       /* inserting character */

/* values for ts_flags */
#define TSF_PREFIXOK    1       /* already checked that prefix is OK */
#define TSF_DIDSPLIT    2       /* tried split at this point */
#define TSF_DIDDEL      4       /* did a delete, "ts_delidx" has index */

/* special values ts_prefixdepth */
#define PFD_NOPREFIX    0xff    /* not using prefixes */
#define PFD_PREFIXTREE  0xfe    /* walking through the prefix tree */
#define PFD_NOTSPECIAL  0xfd    /* highest value that's not special */

/* mode values for find_word */
#define FIND_FOLDWORD       0   /* find word case-folded */
#define FIND_KEEPWORD       1   /* find keep-case word */
#define FIND_PREFIX         2   /* find word after prefix */
#define FIND_COMPOUND       3   /* find case-folded compound word */
#define FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND   4   /* find keep-case compound word */

static slang_T *slang_alloc __ARGS((char_u *lang));
static void slang_free __ARGS((slang_T *lp));
static void slang_clear __ARGS((slang_T *lp));
static void slang_clear_sug __ARGS((slang_T *lp));
static void find_word __ARGS((matchinf_T *mip, int mode));
static int can_compound __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *word, char_u *flags));
static int valid_word_prefix __ARGS((int totprefcnt, int arridx, int flags, char_u *word, slang_T *slang, int cond_req));
static void find_prefix __ARGS((matchinf_T *mip, int mode));
static int fold_more __ARGS((matchinf_T *mip));
static int spell_valid_case __ARGS((int wordflags, int treeflags));
static int no_spell_checking __ARGS((win_T *wp));
static void spell_load_lang __ARGS((char_u *lang));
static char_u *spell_enc __ARGS((void));
static void int_wordlist_spl __ARGS((char_u *fname));
static void spell_load_cb __ARGS((char_u *fname, void *cookie));
static slang_T *spell_load_file __ARGS((char_u *fname, char_u *lang, slang_T *old_lp, int silent));
static int get2c __ARGS((FILE *fd));
static int get3c __ARGS((FILE *fd));
static int get4c __ARGS((FILE *fd));
static time_t get8c __ARGS((FILE *fd));
static char_u *read_cnt_string __ARGS((FILE *fd, int cnt_bytes, int *lenp));
static char_u *read_string __ARGS((FILE *fd, int cnt));
static int read_region_section __ARGS((FILE *fd, slang_T *slang, int len));
static int read_charflags_section __ARGS((FILE *fd));
static int read_prefcond_section __ARGS((FILE *fd, slang_T *lp));
static int read_rep_section __ARGS((FILE *fd, garray_T *gap, short *first));
static int read_sal_section __ARGS((FILE *fd, slang_T *slang));
static int read_words_section __ARGS((FILE *fd, slang_T *lp, int len));
static void count_common_word __ARGS((slang_T *lp, char_u *word, int len, int count));
static int score_wordcount_adj __ARGS((slang_T *slang, int score, char_u *word, int split));
static int read_sofo_section __ARGS((FILE *fd, slang_T *slang));
static int read_compound __ARGS((FILE *fd, slang_T *slang, int len));
static int byte_in_str __ARGS((char_u *str, int byte));
static int init_syl_tab __ARGS((slang_T *slang));
static int count_syllables __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *word));
static int set_sofo __ARGS((slang_T *lp, char_u *from, char_u *to));
static void set_sal_first __ARGS((slang_T *lp));
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
static int *mb_str2wide __ARGS((char_u *s));
#endif
static int spell_read_tree __ARGS((FILE *fd, char_u **bytsp, idx_T **idxsp, int prefixtree, int prefixcnt));
static idx_T read_tree_node __ARGS((FILE *fd, char_u *byts, idx_T *idxs, int maxidx, idx_T startidx, int prefixtree, int maxprefcondnr));
static void clear_midword __ARGS((buf_T *buf));
static void use_midword __ARGS((slang_T *lp, buf_T *buf));
static int find_region __ARGS((char_u *rp, char_u *region));
static int captype __ARGS((char_u *word, char_u *end));
static int badword_captype __ARGS((char_u *word, char_u *end));
static void spell_reload_one __ARGS((char_u *fname, int added_word));
static void set_spell_charflags __ARGS((char_u *flags, int cnt, char_u *upp));
static int set_spell_chartab __ARGS((char_u *fol, char_u *low, char_u *upp));
static int spell_casefold __ARGS((char_u *p, int len, char_u *buf, int buflen));
static int check_need_cap __ARGS((linenr_T lnum, colnr_T col));
static void spell_find_suggest __ARGS((char_u *badptr, int badlen, suginfo_T *su, int maxcount, int banbadword, int need_cap, int interactive));
#ifdef FEAT_EVAL
static void spell_suggest_expr __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, char_u *expr));
#endif
static void spell_suggest_file __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, char_u *fname));
static void spell_suggest_intern __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, int interactive));
static void suggest_load_files __ARGS((void));
static void tree_count_words __ARGS((char_u *byts, idx_T *idxs));
static void spell_find_cleanup __ARGS((suginfo_T *su));
static void onecap_copy __ARGS((char_u *word, char_u *wcopy, int upper));
static void allcap_copy __ARGS((char_u *word, char_u *wcopy));
static void suggest_try_special __ARGS((suginfo_T *su));
static void suggest_try_change __ARGS((suginfo_T *su));
static void suggest_trie_walk __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, langp_T *lp, char_u *fword, int soundfold));
static void go_deeper __ARGS((trystate_T *stack, int depth, int score_add));
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
static int nofold_len __ARGS((char_u *fword, int flen, char_u *word));
#endif
static void find_keepcap_word __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *fword, char_u *kword));
static void score_comp_sal __ARGS((suginfo_T *su));
static void score_combine __ARGS((suginfo_T *su));
static int stp_sal_score __ARGS((suggest_T *stp, suginfo_T *su, slang_T *slang, char_u *badsound));
static void suggest_try_soundalike_prep __ARGS((void));
static void suggest_try_soundalike __ARGS((suginfo_T *su));
static void suggest_try_soundalike_finish __ARGS((void));
static void add_sound_suggest __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, char_u *goodword, int score, langp_T *lp));
static int soundfold_find __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *word));
static void make_case_word __ARGS((char_u *fword, char_u *cword, int flags));
static void set_map_str __ARGS((slang_T *lp, char_u *map));
static int similar_chars __ARGS((slang_T *slang, int c1, int c2));
static void add_suggestion __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, garray_T *gap, char_u *goodword, int badlen, int score, int altscore, int had_bonus, slang_T *slang, int maxsf));
static void check_suggestions __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, garray_T *gap));
static void add_banned __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, char_u *word));
static void rescore_suggestions __ARGS((suginfo_T *su));
static void rescore_one __ARGS((suginfo_T *su, suggest_T *stp));
static int cleanup_suggestions __ARGS((garray_T *gap, int maxscore, int keep));
static void spell_soundfold __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *inword, int folded, char_u *res));
static void spell_soundfold_sofo __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *inword, char_u *res));
static void spell_soundfold_sal __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *inword, char_u *res));
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
static void spell_soundfold_wsal __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *inword, char_u *res));
#endif
static int soundalike_score __ARGS((char_u *goodsound, char_u *badsound));
static int spell_edit_score __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *badword, char_u *goodword));
static int spell_edit_score_limit __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *badword, char_u *goodword, int limit));
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
static int spell_edit_score_limit_w __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *badword, char_u *goodword, int limit));
#endif
static void dump_word __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *word, char_u *pat, int *dir, int round, int flags, linenr_T lnum));
static linenr_T dump_prefixes __ARGS((slang_T *slang, char_u *word, char_u *pat, int *dir, int round, int flags, linenr_T startlnum));
static buf_T *open_spellbuf __ARGS((void));
static void close_spellbuf __ARGS((buf_T *buf));

/*
 * Use our own character-case definitions, because the current locale may
 * differ from what the .spl file uses.
 * These must not be called with negative number!
 */
#ifndef FEAT_MBYTE
/* Non-multi-byte implementation. */
# define SPELL_TOFOLD(c) ((c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_fold[c] : (c))
# define SPELL_TOUPPER(c) ((c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_upper[c] : (c))
# define SPELL_ISUPPER(c) ((c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_isu[c] : FALSE)
#else
# if defined(HAVE_WCHAR_H)
#  include <wchar.h>        /* for towupper() and towlower() */
# endif
/* Multi-byte implementation.  For Unicode we can call utf_*(), but don't do
 * that for ASCII, because we don't want to use 'casemap' here.  Otherwise use
 * the "w" library function for characters above 255 if available. */
# ifdef HAVE_TOWLOWER
#  define SPELL_TOFOLD(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_fold(c) \
            : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_fold[c] : towlower(c))
# else
#  define SPELL_TOFOLD(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_fold(c) \
            : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_fold[c] : (c))
# endif

# ifdef HAVE_TOWUPPER
#  define SPELL_TOUPPER(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_toupper(c) \
            : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_upper[c] : towupper(c))
# else
#  define SPELL_TOUPPER(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_toupper(c) \
            : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_upper[c] : (c))
# endif

# ifdef HAVE_ISWUPPER
#  define SPELL_ISUPPER(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_isupper(c) \
            : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_isu[c] : iswupper(c))
# else
#  define SPELL_ISUPPER(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_isupper(c) \
            : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_isu[c] : (FALSE))
# endif
#endif


static char *e_format = N_("E759: Format error in spell file");
static char *e_spell_trunc = N_("E758: Truncated spell file");
static char *e_afftrailing = N_("Trailing text in %s line %d: %s");
static char *e_affname = N_("Affix name too long in %s line %d: %s");
static char *e_affform = N_("E761: Format error in affix file FOL, LOW or UPP");
static char *e_affrange = N_("E762: Character in FOL, LOW or UPP is out of range");
static char *msg_compressing = N_("Compressing word tree...");

/* Remember what "z?" replaced. */
static char_u   *repl_from = NULL;
static char_u   *repl_to = NULL;

/*
 * Main spell-checking function.
 * "ptr" points to a character that could be the start of a word.
 * "*attrp" is set to the highlight index for a badly spelled word.  For a
 * non-word or when it's OK it remains unchanged.
 * This must only be called when 'spelllang' is not empty.
 *
 * "capcol" is used to check for a Capitalised word after the end of a
 * sentence.  If it's zero then perform the check.  Return the column where to
 * check next, or -1 when no sentence end was found.  If it's NULL then don't
 * worry.
 *
 * Returns the length of the word in bytes, also when it's OK, so that the
 * caller can skip over the word.
 */
    int
spell_check(wp, ptr, attrp, capcol, docount)
    win_T       *wp;            /* current window */
    char_u      *ptr;
    hlf_T       *attrp;
    int         *capcol;        /* column to check for Capital */
    int         docount;        /* count good words */
{
    matchinf_T  mi;             /* Most things are put in "mi" so that it can
                                   be passed to functions quickly. */
    int         nrlen = 0;      /* found a number first */
    int         c;
    int         wrongcaplen = 0;
    int         lpi;
    int         count_word = docount;

    /* A word never starts at a space or a control character.  Return quickly
     * then, skipping over the character. */
    if (*ptr <= ' ')
        return 1;

    /* Return here when loading language files failed. */
    if (wp->w_buffer->b_langp.ga_len == 0)
        return 1;

    vim_memset(&mi, 0, sizeof(matchinf_T));

    /* A number is always OK.  Also skip hexadecimal numbers 0xFF99 and
     * 0X99FF.  But always do check spelling to find "3GPP" and "11
     * julifeest". */
    if (*ptr >= '0' && *ptr <= '9')
    {
        if (*ptr == '0' && (ptr[1] == 'x' || ptr[1] == 'X'))
            mi.mi_end = skiphex(ptr + 2);
        else
            mi.mi_end = skipdigits(ptr);
        nrlen = (int)(mi.mi_end - ptr);
    }

    /* Find the normal end of the word (until the next non-word character). */
    mi.mi_word = ptr;
    mi.mi_fend = ptr;
    if (spell_iswordp(mi.mi_fend, wp->w_buffer))
    {
        do
        {
            mb_ptr_adv(mi.mi_fend);
        } while (*mi.mi_fend != NUL && spell_iswordp(mi.mi_fend, wp->w_buffer));

        if (capcol != NULL && *capcol == 0 && wp->w_buffer->b_cap_prog != NULL)
        {
            /* Check word starting with capital letter. */
            c = PTR2CHAR(ptr);
            if (!SPELL_ISUPPER(c))
                wrongcaplen = (int)(mi.mi_fend - ptr);
        }
    }
    if (capcol != NULL)
        *capcol = -1;

    /* We always use the characters up to the next non-word character,
     * also for bad words. */
    mi.mi_end = mi.mi_fend;

    /* Check caps type later. */
    mi.mi_buf = wp->w_buffer;

    /* case-fold the word with one non-word character, so that we can check
     * for the word end. */
    if (*mi.mi_fend != NUL)
        mb_ptr_adv(mi.mi_fend);

    (void)spell_casefold(ptr, (int)(mi.mi_fend - ptr), mi.mi_fword,
                                                             MAXWLEN + 1);
    mi.mi_fwordlen = (int)STRLEN(mi.mi_fword);

    /* The word is bad unless we recognize it. */
    mi.mi_result = SP_BAD;
    mi.mi_result2 = SP_BAD;

    /*
     * Loop over the languages specified in 'spelllang'.
     * We check them all, because a word may be matched longer in another
     * language.
     */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < wp->w_buffer->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        mi.mi_lp = LANGP_ENTRY(wp->w_buffer->b_langp, lpi);

        /* If reloading fails the language is still in the list but everything
         * has been cleared. */
        if (mi.mi_lp->lp_slang->sl_fidxs == NULL)
            continue;

        /* Check for a matching word in case-folded words. */
        find_word(&mi, FIND_FOLDWORD);

        /* Check for a matching word in keep-case words. */
        find_word(&mi, FIND_KEEPWORD);

        /* Check for matching prefixes. */
        find_prefix(&mi, FIND_FOLDWORD);

        /* For a NOBREAK language, may want to use a word without a following
         * word as a backup. */
        if (mi.mi_lp->lp_slang->sl_nobreak && mi.mi_result == SP_BAD
                                                   && mi.mi_result2 != SP_BAD)
        {
            mi.mi_result = mi.mi_result2;
            mi.mi_end = mi.mi_end2;
        }

        /* Count the word in the first language where it's found to be OK. */
        if (count_word && mi.mi_result == SP_OK)
        {
            count_common_word(mi.mi_lp->lp_slang, ptr,
                                                   (int)(mi.mi_end - ptr), 1);
            count_word = FALSE;
        }
    }

    if (mi.mi_result != SP_OK)
    {
        /* If we found a number skip over it.  Allows for "42nd".  Do flag
         * rare and local words, e.g., "3GPP". */
        if (nrlen > 0)
        {
            if (mi.mi_result == SP_BAD || mi.mi_result == SP_BANNED)
                return nrlen;
        }

        /* When we are at a non-word character there is no error, just
         * skip over the character (try looking for a word after it). */
        else if (!spell_iswordp_nmw(ptr))
        {
            if (capcol != NULL && wp->w_buffer->b_cap_prog != NULL)
            {
                regmatch_T      regmatch;

                /* Check for end of sentence. */
                regmatch.regprog = wp->w_buffer->b_cap_prog;
                regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE;
                if (vim_regexec(&regmatch, ptr, 0))
                    *capcol = (int)(regmatch.endp[0] - ptr);
            }

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
                return (*mb_ptr2len)(ptr);
#endif
            return 1;
        }
        else if (mi.mi_end == ptr)
            /* Always include at least one character.  Required for when there
             * is a mixup in "midword". */
            mb_ptr_adv(mi.mi_end);
        else if (mi.mi_result == SP_BAD
                && LANGP_ENTRY(wp->w_buffer->b_langp, 0)->lp_slang->sl_nobreak)
        {
            char_u      *p, *fp;
            int         save_result = mi.mi_result;

            /* First language in 'spelllang' is NOBREAK.  Find first position
             * at which any word would be valid. */
            mi.mi_lp = LANGP_ENTRY(wp->w_buffer->b_langp, 0);
            if (mi.mi_lp->lp_slang->sl_fidxs != NULL)
            {
                p = mi.mi_word;
                fp = mi.mi_fword;
                for (;;)
                {
                    mb_ptr_adv(p);
                    mb_ptr_adv(fp);
                    if (p >= mi.mi_end)
                        break;
                    mi.mi_compoff = (int)(fp - mi.mi_fword);
                    find_word(&mi, FIND_COMPOUND);
                    if (mi.mi_result != SP_BAD)
                    {
                        mi.mi_end = p;
                        break;
                    }
                }
                mi.mi_result = save_result;
            }
        }

        if (mi.mi_result == SP_BAD || mi.mi_result == SP_BANNED)
            *attrp = HLF_SPB;
        else if (mi.mi_result == SP_RARE)
            *attrp = HLF_SPR;
        else
            *attrp = HLF_SPL;
    }

    if (wrongcaplen > 0 && (mi.mi_result == SP_OK || mi.mi_result == SP_RARE))
    {
        /* Report SpellCap only when the word isn't badly spelled. */
        *attrp = HLF_SPC;
        return wrongcaplen;
    }

    return (int)(mi.mi_end - ptr);
}

/*
 * Check if the word at "mip->mi_word" is in the tree.
 * When "mode" is FIND_FOLDWORD check in fold-case word tree.
 * When "mode" is FIND_KEEPWORD check in keep-case word tree.
 * When "mode" is FIND_PREFIX check for word after prefix in fold-case word
 * tree.
 *
 * For a match mip->mi_result is updated.
 */
    static void
find_word(mip, mode)
    matchinf_T  *mip;
    int         mode;
{
    idx_T       arridx = 0;
    int         endlen[MAXWLEN];    /* length at possible word endings */
    idx_T       endidx[MAXWLEN];    /* possible word endings */
    int         endidxcnt = 0;
    int         len;
    int         wlen = 0;
    int         flen;
    int         c;
    char_u      *ptr;
    idx_T       lo, hi, m;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    char_u      *s;
#endif
    char_u      *p;
    int         res = SP_BAD;
    slang_T     *slang = mip->mi_lp->lp_slang;
    unsigned    flags;
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;
    int         word_ends;
    int         prefix_found;
    int         nobreak_result;

    if (mode == FIND_KEEPWORD || mode == FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND)
    {
        /* Check for word with matching case in keep-case tree. */
        ptr = mip->mi_word;
        flen = 9999;                /* no case folding, always enough bytes */
        byts = slang->sl_kbyts;
        idxs = slang->sl_kidxs;

        if (mode == FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND)
            /* Skip over the previously found word(s). */
            wlen += mip->mi_compoff;
    }
    else
    {
        /* Check for case-folded in case-folded tree. */
        ptr = mip->mi_fword;
        flen = mip->mi_fwordlen;    /* available case-folded bytes */
        byts = slang->sl_fbyts;
        idxs = slang->sl_fidxs;

        if (mode == FIND_PREFIX)
        {
            /* Skip over the prefix. */
            wlen = mip->mi_prefixlen;
            flen -= mip->mi_prefixlen;
        }
        else if (mode == FIND_COMPOUND)
        {
            /* Skip over the previously found word(s). */
            wlen = mip->mi_compoff;
            flen -= mip->mi_compoff;
        }

    }

    if (byts == NULL)
        return;                 /* array is empty */

    /*
     * Repeat advancing in the tree until:
     * - there is a byte that doesn't match,
     * - we reach the end of the tree,
     * - or we reach the end of the line.
     */
    for (;;)
    {
        if (flen <= 0 && *mip->mi_fend != NUL)
            flen = fold_more(mip);

        len = byts[arridx++];

        /* If the first possible byte is a zero the word could end here.
         * Remember this index, we first check for the longest word. */
        if (byts[arridx] == 0)
        {
            if (endidxcnt == MAXWLEN)
            {
                /* Must be a corrupted spell file. */
                EMSG(_(e_format));
                return;
            }
            endlen[endidxcnt] = wlen;
            endidx[endidxcnt++] = arridx++;
            --len;

            /* Skip over the zeros, there can be several flag/region
             * combinations. */
            while (len > 0 && byts[arridx] == 0)
            {
                ++arridx;
                --len;
            }
            if (len == 0)
                break;      /* no children, word must end here */
        }

        /* Stop looking at end of the line. */
        if (ptr[wlen] == NUL)
            break;

        /* Perform a binary search in the list of accepted bytes. */
        c = ptr[wlen];
        if (c == TAB)       /* <Tab> is handled like <Space> */
            c = ' ';
        lo = arridx;
        hi = arridx + len - 1;
        while (lo < hi)
        {
            m = (lo + hi) / 2;
            if (byts[m] > c)
                hi = m - 1;
            else if (byts[m] < c)
                lo = m + 1;
            else
            {
                lo = hi = m;
                break;
            }
        }

        /* Stop if there is no matching byte. */
        if (hi < lo || byts[lo] != c)
            break;

        /* Continue at the child (if there is one). */
        arridx = idxs[lo];
        ++wlen;
        --flen;

        /* One space in the good word may stand for several spaces in the
         * checked word. */
        if (c == ' ')
        {
            for (;;)
            {
                if (flen <= 0 && *mip->mi_fend != NUL)
                    flen = fold_more(mip);
                if (ptr[wlen] != ' ' && ptr[wlen] != TAB)
                    break;
                ++wlen;
                --flen;
            }
        }
    }

    /*
     * Verify that one of the possible endings is valid.  Try the longest
     * first.
     */
    while (endidxcnt > 0)
    {
        --endidxcnt;
        arridx = endidx[endidxcnt];
        wlen = endlen[endidxcnt];

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if ((*mb_head_off)(ptr, ptr + wlen) > 0)
            continue;       /* not at first byte of character */
#endif
        if (spell_iswordp(ptr + wlen, mip->mi_buf))
        {
            if (slang->sl_compprog == NULL && !slang->sl_nobreak)
                continue;           /* next char is a word character */
            word_ends = FALSE;
        }
        else
            word_ends = TRUE;
        /* The prefix flag is before compound flags.  Once a valid prefix flag
         * has been found we try compound flags. */
        prefix_found = FALSE;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (mode != FIND_KEEPWORD && has_mbyte)
        {
            /* Compute byte length in original word, length may change
             * when folding case.  This can be slow, take a shortcut when the
             * case-folded word is equal to the keep-case word. */
            p = mip->mi_word;
            if (STRNCMP(ptr, p, wlen) != 0)
            {
                for (s = ptr; s < ptr + wlen; mb_ptr_adv(s))
                    mb_ptr_adv(p);
                wlen = (int)(p - mip->mi_word);
            }
        }
#endif

        /* Check flags and region.  For FIND_PREFIX check the condition and
         * prefix ID.
         * Repeat this if there are more flags/region alternatives until there
         * is a match. */
        res = SP_BAD;
        for (len = byts[arridx - 1]; len > 0 && byts[arridx] == 0;
                                                              --len, ++arridx)
        {
            flags = idxs[arridx];

            /* For the fold-case tree check that the case of the checked word
             * matches with what the word in the tree requires.
             * For keep-case tree the case is always right.  For prefixes we
             * don't bother to check. */
            if (mode == FIND_FOLDWORD)
            {
                if (mip->mi_cend != mip->mi_word + wlen)
                {
                    /* mi_capflags was set for a different word length, need
                     * to do it again. */
                    mip->mi_cend = mip->mi_word + wlen;
                    mip->mi_capflags = captype(mip->mi_word, mip->mi_cend);
                }

                if (mip->mi_capflags == WF_KEEPCAP
                                || !spell_valid_case(mip->mi_capflags, flags))
                    continue;
            }

            /* When mode is FIND_PREFIX the word must support the prefix:
             * check the prefix ID and the condition.  Do that for the list at
             * mip->mi_prefarridx that find_prefix() filled. */
            else if (mode == FIND_PREFIX && !prefix_found)
            {
                c = valid_word_prefix(mip->mi_prefcnt, mip->mi_prefarridx,
                                    flags,
                                    mip->mi_word + mip->mi_cprefixlen, slang,
                                    FALSE);
                if (c == 0)
                    continue;

                /* Use the WF_RARE flag for a rare prefix. */
                if (c & WF_RAREPFX)
                    flags |= WF_RARE;
                prefix_found = TRUE;
            }

            if (slang->sl_nobreak)
            {
                if ((mode == FIND_COMPOUND || mode == FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND)
                        && (flags & WF_BANNED) == 0)
                {
                    /* NOBREAK: found a valid following word.  That's all we
                     * need to know, so return. */
                    mip->mi_result = SP_OK;
                    break;
                }
            }

            else if ((mode == FIND_COMPOUND || mode == FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND
                                                                || !word_ends))
            {
                /* If there is no compound flag or the word is shorter than
                 * COMPOUNDMIN reject it quickly.
                 * Makes you wonder why someone puts a compound flag on a word
                 * that's too short...  Myspell compatibility requires this
                 * anyway. */
                if (((unsigned)flags >> 24) == 0
                             || wlen - mip->mi_compoff < slang->sl_compminlen)
                    continue;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                /* For multi-byte chars check character length against
                 * COMPOUNDMIN. */
                if (has_mbyte
                        && slang->sl_compminlen > 0
                        && mb_charlen_len(mip->mi_word + mip->mi_compoff,
                                wlen - mip->mi_compoff) < slang->sl_compminlen)
                        continue;
#endif

                /* Limit the number of compound words to COMPOUNDWORDMAX if no
                 * maximum for syllables is specified. */
                if (!word_ends && mip->mi_complen + mip->mi_compextra + 2
                                                           > slang->sl_compmax
                                           && slang->sl_compsylmax == MAXWLEN)
                    continue;

                /* Don't allow compounding on a side where an affix was added,
                 * unless COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG was used. */
                if (mip->mi_complen > 0 && (flags & WF_NOCOMPBEF))
                    continue;
                if (!word_ends && (flags & WF_NOCOMPAFT))
                    continue;

                /* Quickly check if compounding is possible with this flag. */
                if (!byte_in_str(mip->mi_complen == 0
                                        ? slang->sl_compstartflags
                                        : slang->sl_compallflags,
                                            ((unsigned)flags >> 24)))
                    continue;

                if (mode == FIND_COMPOUND)
                {
                    int     capflags;

                    /* Need to check the caps type of the appended compound
                     * word. */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    if (has_mbyte && STRNCMP(ptr, mip->mi_word,
                                                        mip->mi_compoff) != 0)
                    {
                        /* case folding may have changed the length */
                        p = mip->mi_word;
                        for (s = ptr; s < ptr + mip->mi_compoff; mb_ptr_adv(s))
                            mb_ptr_adv(p);
                    }
                    else
#endif
                        p = mip->mi_word + mip->mi_compoff;
                    capflags = captype(p, mip->mi_word + wlen);
                    if (capflags == WF_KEEPCAP || (capflags == WF_ALLCAP
                                                 && (flags & WF_FIXCAP) != 0))
                        continue;

                    if (capflags != WF_ALLCAP)
                    {
                        /* When the character before the word is a word
                         * character we do not accept a Onecap word.  We do
                         * accept a no-caps word, even when the dictionary
                         * word specifies ONECAP. */
                        mb_ptr_back(mip->mi_word, p);
                        if (spell_iswordp_nmw(p)
                                ? capflags == WF_ONECAP
                                : (flags & WF_ONECAP) != 0
                                                     && capflags != WF_ONECAP)
                            continue;
                    }
                }

                /* If the word ends the sequence of compound flags of the
                 * words must match with one of the COMPOUNDRULE items and
                 * the number of syllables must not be too large. */
                mip->mi_compflags[mip->mi_complen] = ((unsigned)flags >> 24);
                mip->mi_compflags[mip->mi_complen + 1] = NUL;
                if (word_ends)
                {
                    char_u      fword[MAXWLEN];

                    if (slang->sl_compsylmax < MAXWLEN)
                    {
                        /* "fword" is only needed for checking syllables. */
                        if (ptr == mip->mi_word)
                            (void)spell_casefold(ptr, wlen, fword, MAXWLEN);
                        else
                            vim_strncpy(fword, ptr, endlen[endidxcnt]);
                    }
                    if (!can_compound(slang, fword, mip->mi_compflags))
                        continue;
                }
            }

            /* Check NEEDCOMPOUND: can't use word without compounding. */
            else if (flags & WF_NEEDCOMP)
                continue;

            nobreak_result = SP_OK;

            if (!word_ends)
            {
                int     save_result = mip->mi_result;
                char_u  *save_end = mip->mi_end;
                langp_T *save_lp = mip->mi_lp;
                int     lpi;

                /* Check that a valid word follows.  If there is one and we
                 * are compounding, it will set "mi_result", thus we are
                 * always finished here.  For NOBREAK we only check that a
                 * valid word follows.
                 * Recursive! */
                if (slang->sl_nobreak)
                    mip->mi_result = SP_BAD;

                /* Find following word in case-folded tree. */
                mip->mi_compoff = endlen[endidxcnt];
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                if (has_mbyte && mode == FIND_KEEPWORD)
                {
                    /* Compute byte length in case-folded word from "wlen":
                     * byte length in keep-case word.  Length may change when
                     * folding case.  This can be slow, take a shortcut when
                     * the case-folded word is equal to the keep-case word. */
                    p = mip->mi_fword;
                    if (STRNCMP(ptr, p, wlen) != 0)
                    {
                        for (s = ptr; s < ptr + wlen; mb_ptr_adv(s))
                            mb_ptr_adv(p);
                        mip->mi_compoff = (int)(p - mip->mi_fword);
                    }
                }
#endif
                c = mip->mi_compoff;
                ++mip->mi_complen;
                if (flags & WF_COMPROOT)
                    ++mip->mi_compextra;

                /* For NOBREAK we need to try all NOBREAK languages, at least
                 * to find the ".add" file(s). */
                for (lpi = 0; lpi < mip->mi_buf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
                {
                    if (slang->sl_nobreak)
                    {
                        mip->mi_lp = LANGP_ENTRY(mip->mi_buf->b_langp, lpi);
                        if (mip->mi_lp->lp_slang->sl_fidxs == NULL
                                         || !mip->mi_lp->lp_slang->sl_nobreak)
                            continue;
                    }

                    find_word(mip, FIND_COMPOUND);

                    /* When NOBREAK any word that matches is OK.  Otherwise we
                     * need to find the longest match, thus try with keep-case
                     * and prefix too. */
                    if (!slang->sl_nobreak || mip->mi_result == SP_BAD)
                    {
                        /* Find following word in keep-case tree. */
                        mip->mi_compoff = wlen;
                        find_word(mip, FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND);

#if 0       /* Disabled, a prefix must not appear halfway a compound word,
               unless the COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG is used and then it can't be a
               postponed prefix. */
                        if (!slang->sl_nobreak || mip->mi_result == SP_BAD)
                        {
                            /* Check for following word with prefix. */
                            mip->mi_compoff = c;
                            find_prefix(mip, FIND_COMPOUND);
                        }
#endif
                    }

                    if (!slang->sl_nobreak)
                        break;
                }
                --mip->mi_complen;
                if (flags & WF_COMPROOT)
                    --mip->mi_compextra;
                mip->mi_lp = save_lp;

                if (slang->sl_nobreak)
                {
                    nobreak_result = mip->mi_result;
                    mip->mi_result = save_result;
                    mip->mi_end = save_end;
                }
                else
                {
                    if (mip->mi_result == SP_OK)
                        break;
                    continue;
                }
            }

            if (flags & WF_BANNED)
                res = SP_BANNED;
            else if (flags & WF_REGION)
            {
                /* Check region. */
                if ((mip->mi_lp->lp_region & (flags >> 16)) != 0)
                    res = SP_OK;
                else
                    res = SP_LOCAL;
            }
            else if (flags & WF_RARE)
                res = SP_RARE;
            else
                res = SP_OK;

            /* Always use the longest match and the best result.  For NOBREAK
             * we separately keep the longest match without a following good
             * word as a fall-back. */
            if (nobreak_result == SP_BAD)
            {
                if (mip->mi_result2 > res)
                {
                    mip->mi_result2 = res;
                    mip->mi_end2 = mip->mi_word + wlen;
                }
                else if (mip->mi_result2 == res
                                        && mip->mi_end2 < mip->mi_word + wlen)
                    mip->mi_end2 = mip->mi_word + wlen;
            }
            else if (mip->mi_result > res)
            {
                mip->mi_result = res;
                mip->mi_end = mip->mi_word + wlen;
            }
            else if (mip->mi_result == res && mip->mi_end < mip->mi_word + wlen)
                mip->mi_end = mip->mi_word + wlen;

            if (mip->mi_result == SP_OK)
                break;
        }

        if (mip->mi_result == SP_OK)
            break;
    }
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if "flags" is a valid sequence of compound flags and "word"
 * does not have too many syllables.
 */
    static int
can_compound(slang, word, flags)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *word;
    char_u      *flags;
{
    regmatch_T  regmatch;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    char_u      uflags[MAXWLEN * 2];
    int         i;
#endif
    char_u      *p;

    if (slang->sl_compprog == NULL)
        return FALSE;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (enc_utf8)
    {
        /* Need to convert the single byte flags to utf8 characters. */
        p = uflags;
        for (i = 0; flags[i] != NUL; ++i)
            p += mb_char2bytes(flags[i], p);
        *p = NUL;
        p = uflags;
    }
    else
#endif
        p = flags;
    regmatch.regprog = slang->sl_compprog;
    regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE;
    if (!vim_regexec(&regmatch, p, 0))
        return FALSE;

    /* Count the number of syllables.  This may be slow, do it last.  If there
     * are too many syllables AND the number of compound words is above
     * COMPOUNDWORDMAX then compounding is not allowed. */
    if (slang->sl_compsylmax < MAXWLEN
                       && count_syllables(slang, word) > slang->sl_compsylmax)
        return (int)STRLEN(flags) < slang->sl_compmax;
    return TRUE;
}

/*
 * Return non-zero if the prefix indicated by "arridx" matches with the prefix
 * ID in "flags" for the word "word".
 * The WF_RAREPFX flag is included in the return value for a rare prefix.
 */
    static int
valid_word_prefix(totprefcnt, arridx, flags, word, slang, cond_req)
    int         totprefcnt;     /* nr of prefix IDs */
    int         arridx;         /* idx in sl_pidxs[] */
    int         flags;
    char_u      *word;
    slang_T     *slang;
    int         cond_req;       /* only use prefixes with a condition */
{
    int         prefcnt;
    int         pidx;
    regprog_T   *rp;
    regmatch_T  regmatch;
    int         prefid;

    prefid = (unsigned)flags >> 24;
    for (prefcnt = totprefcnt - 1; prefcnt >= 0; --prefcnt)
    {
        pidx = slang->sl_pidxs[arridx + prefcnt];

        /* Check the prefix ID. */
        if (prefid != (pidx & 0xff))
            continue;

        /* Check if the prefix doesn't combine and the word already has a
         * suffix. */
        if ((flags & WF_HAS_AFF) && (pidx & WF_PFX_NC))
            continue;

        /* Check the condition, if there is one.  The condition index is
         * stored in the two bytes above the prefix ID byte.  */
        rp = slang->sl_prefprog[((unsigned)pidx >> 8) & 0xffff];
        if (rp != NULL)
        {
            regmatch.regprog = rp;
            regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE;
            if (!vim_regexec(&regmatch, word, 0))
                continue;
        }
        else if (cond_req)
            continue;

        /* It's a match!  Return the WF_ flags. */
        return pidx;
    }
    return 0;
}

/*
 * Check if the word at "mip->mi_word" has a matching prefix.
 * If it does, then check the following word.
 *
 * If "mode" is "FIND_COMPOUND" then do the same after another word, find a
 * prefix in a compound word.
 *
 * For a match mip->mi_result is updated.
 */
    static void
find_prefix(mip, mode)
    matchinf_T  *mip;
    int         mode;
{
    idx_T       arridx = 0;
    int         len;
    int         wlen = 0;
    int         flen;
    int         c;
    char_u      *ptr;
    idx_T       lo, hi, m;
    slang_T     *slang = mip->mi_lp->lp_slang;
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;

    byts = slang->sl_pbyts;
    if (byts == NULL)
        return;                 /* array is empty */

    /* We use the case-folded word here, since prefixes are always
     * case-folded. */
    ptr = mip->mi_fword;
    flen = mip->mi_fwordlen;    /* available case-folded bytes */
    if (mode == FIND_COMPOUND)
    {
        /* Skip over the previously found word(s). */
        ptr += mip->mi_compoff;
        flen -= mip->mi_compoff;
    }
    idxs = slang->sl_pidxs;

    /*
     * Repeat advancing in the tree until:
     * - there is a byte that doesn't match,
     * - we reach the end of the tree,
     * - or we reach the end of the line.
     */
    for (;;)
    {
        if (flen == 0 && *mip->mi_fend != NUL)
            flen = fold_more(mip);

        len = byts[arridx++];

        /* If the first possible byte is a zero the prefix could end here.
         * Check if the following word matches and supports the prefix. */
        if (byts[arridx] == 0)
        {
            /* There can be several prefixes with different conditions.  We
             * try them all, since we don't know which one will give the
             * longest match.  The word is the same each time, pass the list
             * of possible prefixes to find_word(). */
            mip->mi_prefarridx = arridx;
            mip->mi_prefcnt = len;
            while (len > 0 && byts[arridx] == 0)
            {
                ++arridx;
                --len;
            }
            mip->mi_prefcnt -= len;

            /* Find the word that comes after the prefix. */
            mip->mi_prefixlen = wlen;
            if (mode == FIND_COMPOUND)
                /* Skip over the previously found word(s). */
                mip->mi_prefixlen += mip->mi_compoff;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                /* Case-folded length may differ from original length. */
                mip->mi_cprefixlen = nofold_len(mip->mi_fword,
                                             mip->mi_prefixlen, mip->mi_word);
            }
            else
                mip->mi_cprefixlen = mip->mi_prefixlen;
#endif
            find_word(mip, FIND_PREFIX);


            if (len == 0)
                break;      /* no children, word must end here */
        }

        /* Stop looking at end of the line. */
        if (ptr[wlen] == NUL)
            break;

        /* Perform a binary search in the list of accepted bytes. */
        c = ptr[wlen];
        lo = arridx;
        hi = arridx + len - 1;
        while (lo < hi)
        {
            m = (lo + hi) / 2;
            if (byts[m] > c)
                hi = m - 1;
            else if (byts[m] < c)
                lo = m + 1;
            else
            {
                lo = hi = m;
                break;
            }
        }

        /* Stop if there is no matching byte. */
        if (hi < lo || byts[lo] != c)
            break;

        /* Continue at the child (if there is one). */
        arridx = idxs[lo];
        ++wlen;
        --flen;
    }
}

/*
 * Need to fold at least one more character.  Do until next non-word character
 * for efficiency.  Include the non-word character too.
 * Return the length of the folded chars in bytes.
 */
    static int
fold_more(mip)
    matchinf_T  *mip;
{
    int         flen;
    char_u      *p;

    p = mip->mi_fend;
    do
    {
        mb_ptr_adv(mip->mi_fend);
    } while (*mip->mi_fend != NUL && spell_iswordp(mip->mi_fend, mip->mi_buf));

    /* Include the non-word character so that we can check for the word end. */
    if (*mip->mi_fend != NUL)
        mb_ptr_adv(mip->mi_fend);

    (void)spell_casefold(p, (int)(mip->mi_fend - p),
                             mip->mi_fword + mip->mi_fwordlen,
                             MAXWLEN - mip->mi_fwordlen);
    flen = (int)STRLEN(mip->mi_fword + mip->mi_fwordlen);
    mip->mi_fwordlen += flen;
    return flen;
}

/*
 * Check case flags for a word.  Return TRUE if the word has the requested
 * case.
 */
    static int
spell_valid_case(wordflags, treeflags)
    int     wordflags;      /* flags for the checked word. */
    int     treeflags;      /* flags for the word in the spell tree */
{
    return ((wordflags == WF_ALLCAP && (treeflags & WF_FIXCAP) == 0)
            || ((treeflags & (WF_ALLCAP | WF_KEEPCAP)) == 0
                && ((treeflags & WF_ONECAP) == 0
                                           || (wordflags & WF_ONECAP) != 0)));
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if spell checking is not enabled.
 */
    static int
no_spell_checking(wp)
    win_T       *wp;
{
    if (!wp->w_p_spell || *wp->w_buffer->b_p_spl == NUL
                                         || wp->w_buffer->b_langp.ga_len == 0)
    {
        EMSG(_("E756: Spell checking is not enabled"));
        return TRUE;
    }
    return FALSE;
}

/*
 * Move to next spell error.
 * "curline" is FALSE for "[s", "]s", "[S" and "]S".
 * "curline" is TRUE to find word under/after cursor in the same line.
 * For Insert mode completion "dir" is BACKWARD and "curline" is TRUE: move
 * to after badly spelled word before the cursor.
 * Return 0 if not found, length of the badly spelled word otherwise.
 */
    int
spell_move_to(wp, dir, allwords, curline, attrp)
    win_T       *wp;
    int         dir;            /* FORWARD or BACKWARD */
    int         allwords;       /* TRUE for "[s"/"]s", FALSE for "[S"/"]S" */
    int         curline;
    hlf_T       *attrp;         /* return: attributes of bad word or NULL
                                   (only when "dir" is FORWARD) */
{
    linenr_T    lnum;
    pos_T       found_pos;
    int         found_len = 0;
    char_u      *line;
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *endp;
    hlf_T       attr;
    int         len;
# ifdef FEAT_SYN_HL
    int         has_syntax = syntax_present(wp->w_buffer);
# endif
    int         col;
    int         can_spell;
    char_u      *buf = NULL;
    int         buflen = 0;
    int         skip = 0;
    int         capcol = -1;
    int         found_one = FALSE;
    int         wrapped = FALSE;

    if (no_spell_checking(wp))
        return 0;

    /*
     * Start looking for bad word at the start of the line, because we can't
     * start halfway a word, we don't know where it starts or ends.
     *
     * When searching backwards, we continue in the line to find the last
     * bad word (in the cursor line: before the cursor).
     *
     * We concatenate the start of the next line, so that wrapped words work
     * (e.g. "et<line-break>cetera").  Doesn't work when searching backwards
     * though...
     */
    lnum = wp->w_cursor.lnum;
    clearpos(&found_pos);

    while (!got_int)
    {
        line = ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum, FALSE);

        len = (int)STRLEN(line);
        if (buflen < len + MAXWLEN + 2)
        {
            vim_free(buf);
            buflen = len + MAXWLEN + 2;
            buf = alloc(buflen);
            if (buf == NULL)
                break;
        }

        /* In first line check first word for Capital. */
        if (lnum == 1)
            capcol = 0;

        /* For checking first word with a capital skip white space. */
        if (capcol == 0)
            capcol = (int)(skipwhite(line) - line);
        else if (curline && wp == curwin)
        {
            /* For spellbadword(): check if first word needs a capital. */
            col = (int)(skipwhite(line) - line);
            if (check_need_cap(lnum, col))
                capcol = col;

            /* Need to get the line again, may have looked at the previous
             * one. */
            line = ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum, FALSE);
        }

        /* Copy the line into "buf" and append the start of the next line if
         * possible. */
        STRCPY(buf, line);
        if (lnum < wp->w_buffer->b_ml.ml_line_count)
            spell_cat_line(buf + STRLEN(buf),
                          ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum + 1, FALSE), MAXWLEN);

        p = buf + skip;
        endp = buf + len;
        while (p < endp)
        {
            /* When searching backward don't search after the cursor.  Unless
             * we wrapped around the end of the buffer. */
            if (dir == BACKWARD
                    && lnum == wp->w_cursor.lnum
                    && !wrapped
                    && (colnr_T)(p - buf) >= wp->w_cursor.col)
                break;

            /* start of word */
            attr = HLF_COUNT;
            len = spell_check(wp, p, &attr, &capcol, FALSE);

            if (attr != HLF_COUNT)
            {
                /* We found a bad word.  Check the attribute. */
                if (allwords || attr == HLF_SPB)
                {
                    /* When searching forward only accept a bad word after
                     * the cursor. */
                    if (dir == BACKWARD
                            || lnum != wp->w_cursor.lnum
                            || (lnum == wp->w_cursor.lnum
                                && (wrapped
                                    || (colnr_T)(curline ? p - buf + len
                                                     : p - buf)
                                                  > wp->w_cursor.col)))
                    {
# ifdef FEAT_SYN_HL
                        if (has_syntax)
                        {
                            col = (int)(p - buf);
                            (void)syn_get_id(wp, lnum, (colnr_T)col,
                                                       FALSE, &can_spell);
                            if (!can_spell)
                                attr = HLF_COUNT;
                        }
                        else
#endif
                            can_spell = TRUE;

                        if (can_spell)
                        {
                            found_one = TRUE;
                            found_pos.lnum = lnum;
                            found_pos.col = (int)(p - buf);
#ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
                            found_pos.coladd = 0;
#endif
                            if (dir == FORWARD)
                            {
                                /* No need to search further. */
                                wp->w_cursor = found_pos;
                                vim_free(buf);
                                if (attrp != NULL)
                                    *attrp = attr;
                                return len;
                            }
                            else if (curline)
                                /* Insert mode completion: put cursor after
                                 * the bad word. */
                                found_pos.col += len;
                            found_len = len;
                        }
                    }
                    else
                        found_one = TRUE;
                }
            }

            /* advance to character after the word */
            p += len;
            capcol -= len;
        }

        if (dir == BACKWARD && found_pos.lnum != 0)
        {
            /* Use the last match in the line (before the cursor). */
            wp->w_cursor = found_pos;
            vim_free(buf);
            return found_len;
        }

        if (curline)
            break;      /* only check cursor line */

        /* Advance to next line. */
        if (dir == BACKWARD)
        {
            /* If we are back at the starting line and searched it again there
             * is no match, give up. */
            if (lnum == wp->w_cursor.lnum && wrapped)
                break;

            if (lnum > 1)
                --lnum;
            else if (!p_ws)
                break;      /* at first line and 'nowrapscan' */
            else
            {
                /* Wrap around to the end of the buffer.  May search the
                 * starting line again and accept the last match. */
                lnum = wp->w_buffer->b_ml.ml_line_count;
                wrapped = TRUE;
                if (!shortmess(SHM_SEARCH))
                    give_warning((char_u *)_(top_bot_msg), TRUE);
            }
            capcol = -1;
        }
        else
        {
            if (lnum < wp->w_buffer->b_ml.ml_line_count)
                ++lnum;
            else if (!p_ws)
                break;      /* at first line and 'nowrapscan' */
            else
            {
                /* Wrap around to the start of the buffer.  May search the
                 * starting line again and accept the first match. */
                lnum = 1;
                wrapped = TRUE;
                if (!shortmess(SHM_SEARCH))
                    give_warning((char_u *)_(bot_top_msg), TRUE);
            }

            /* If we are back at the starting line and there is no match then
             * give up. */
            if (lnum == wp->w_cursor.lnum && !found_one)
                break;

            /* Skip the characters at the start of the next line that were
             * included in a match crossing line boundaries. */
            if (attr == HLF_COUNT)
                skip = (int)(p - endp);
            else
                skip = 0;

            /* Capcol skips over the inserted space. */
            --capcol;

            /* But after empty line check first word in next line */
            if (*skipwhite(line) == NUL)
                capcol = 0;
        }

        line_breakcheck();
    }

    vim_free(buf);
    return 0;
}

/*
 * For spell checking: concatenate the start of the following line "line" into
 * "buf", blanking-out special characters.  Copy less then "maxlen" bytes.
 */
    void
spell_cat_line(buf, line, maxlen)
    char_u      *buf;
    char_u      *line;
    int         maxlen;
{
    char_u      *p;
    int         n;

    p = skipwhite(line);
    while (vim_strchr((char_u *)"*#/\"\t", *p) != NULL)
        p = skipwhite(p + 1);

    if (*p != NUL)
    {
        *buf = ' ';
        vim_strncpy(buf + 1, line, maxlen - 2);
        n = (int)(p - line);
        if (n >= maxlen)
            n = maxlen - 1;
        vim_memset(buf + 1, ' ', n);
    }
}

/*
 * Structure used for the cookie argument of do_in_runtimepath().
 */
typedef struct spelload_S
{
    char_u  sl_lang[MAXWLEN + 1];       /* language name */
    slang_T *sl_slang;                  /* resulting slang_T struct */
    int     sl_nobreak;                 /* NOBREAK language found */
} spelload_T;

/*
 * Load word list(s) for "lang" from Vim spell file(s).
 * "lang" must be the language without the region: e.g., "en".
 */
    static void
spell_load_lang(lang)
    char_u      *lang;
{
    char_u      fname_enc[85];
    int         r;
    spelload_T  sl;
#ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
    int         round;
#endif

    /* Copy the language name to pass it to spell_load_cb() as a cookie.
     * It's truncated when an error is detected. */
    STRCPY(sl.sl_lang, lang);
    sl.sl_slang = NULL;
    sl.sl_nobreak = FALSE;

#ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
    /* We may retry when no spell file is found for the language, an
     * autocommand may load it then. */
    for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round)
#endif
    {
        /*
         * Find the first spell file for "lang" in 'runtimepath' and load it.
         */
        vim_snprintf((char *)fname_enc, sizeof(fname_enc) - 5,
                                        "spell/%s.%s.spl", lang, spell_enc());
        r = do_in_runtimepath(fname_enc, FALSE, spell_load_cb, &sl);

        if (r == FAIL && *sl.sl_lang != NUL)
        {
            /* Try loading the ASCII version. */
            vim_snprintf((char *)fname_enc, sizeof(fname_enc) - 5,
                                                  "spell/%s.ascii.spl", lang);
            r = do_in_runtimepath(fname_enc, FALSE, spell_load_cb, &sl);

#ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
            if (r == FAIL && *sl.sl_lang != NUL && round == 1
                    && apply_autocmds(EVENT_SPELLFILEMISSING, lang,
                                              curbuf->b_fname, FALSE, curbuf))
                continue;
            break;
#endif
        }
#ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
        break;
#endif
    }

    if (r == FAIL)
    {
        smsg((char_u *)_("Warning: Cannot find word list \"%s.%s.spl\" or \"%s.ascii.spl\""),
                                                     lang, spell_enc(), lang);
    }
    else if (sl.sl_slang != NULL)
    {
        /* At least one file was loaded, now load ALL the additions. */
        STRCPY(fname_enc + STRLEN(fname_enc) - 3, "add.spl");
        do_in_runtimepath(fname_enc, TRUE, spell_load_cb, &sl);
    }
}

/*
 * Return the encoding used for spell checking: Use 'encoding', except that we
 * use "latin1" for "latin9".  And limit to 60 characters (just in case).
 */
    static char_u *
spell_enc()
{

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (STRLEN(p_enc) < 60 && STRCMP(p_enc, "iso-8859-15") != 0)
        return p_enc;
#endif
    return (char_u *)"latin1";
}

/*
 * Get the name of the .spl file for the internal wordlist into
 * "fname[MAXPATHL]".
 */
    static void
int_wordlist_spl(fname)
    char_u          *fname;
{
    vim_snprintf((char *)fname, MAXPATHL, "%s.%s.spl",
                                                  int_wordlist, spell_enc());
}

/*
 * Allocate a new slang_T for language "lang".  "lang" can be NULL.
 * Caller must fill "sl_next".
 */
    static slang_T *
slang_alloc(lang)
    char_u      *lang;
{
    slang_T *lp;

    lp = (slang_T *)alloc_clear(sizeof(slang_T));
    if (lp != NULL)
    {
        if (lang != NULL)
            lp->sl_name = vim_strsave(lang);
        ga_init2(&lp->sl_rep, sizeof(fromto_T), 10);
        ga_init2(&lp->sl_repsal, sizeof(fromto_T), 10);
        lp->sl_compmax = MAXWLEN;
        lp->sl_compsylmax = MAXWLEN;
        hash_init(&lp->sl_wordcount);
    }

    return lp;
}

/*
 * Free the contents of an slang_T and the structure itself.
 */
    static void
slang_free(lp)
    slang_T     *lp;
{
    vim_free(lp->sl_name);
    vim_free(lp->sl_fname);
    slang_clear(lp);
    vim_free(lp);
}

/*
 * Clear an slang_T so that the file can be reloaded.
 */
    static void
slang_clear(lp)
    slang_T     *lp;
{
    garray_T    *gap;
    fromto_T    *ftp;
    salitem_T   *smp;
    int         i;
    int         round;

    vim_free(lp->sl_fbyts);
    lp->sl_fbyts = NULL;
    vim_free(lp->sl_kbyts);
    lp->sl_kbyts = NULL;
    vim_free(lp->sl_pbyts);
    lp->sl_pbyts = NULL;

    vim_free(lp->sl_fidxs);
    lp->sl_fidxs = NULL;
    vim_free(lp->sl_kidxs);
    lp->sl_kidxs = NULL;
    vim_free(lp->sl_pidxs);
    lp->sl_pidxs = NULL;

    for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round)
    {
        gap = round == 1 ? &lp->sl_rep : &lp->sl_repsal;
        while (gap->ga_len > 0)
        {
            ftp = &((fromto_T *)gap->ga_data)[--gap->ga_len];
            vim_free(ftp->ft_from);
            vim_free(ftp->ft_to);
        }
        ga_clear(gap);
    }

    gap = &lp->sl_sal;
    if (lp->sl_sofo)
    {
        /* "ga_len" is set to 1 without adding an item for latin1 */
        if (gap->ga_data != NULL)
            /* SOFOFROM and SOFOTO items: free lists of wide characters. */
            for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; ++i)
                vim_free(((int **)gap->ga_data)[i]);
    }
    else
        /* SAL items: free salitem_T items */
        while (gap->ga_len > 0)
        {
            smp = &((salitem_T *)gap->ga_data)[--gap->ga_len];
            vim_free(smp->sm_lead);
            /* Don't free sm_oneof and sm_rules, they point into sm_lead. */
            vim_free(smp->sm_to);
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            vim_free(smp->sm_lead_w);
            vim_free(smp->sm_oneof_w);
            vim_free(smp->sm_to_w);
#endif
        }
    ga_clear(gap);

    for (i = 0; i < lp->sl_prefixcnt; ++i)
        vim_free(lp->sl_prefprog[i]);
    lp->sl_prefixcnt = 0;
    vim_free(lp->sl_prefprog);
    lp->sl_prefprog = NULL;

    vim_free(lp->sl_info);
    lp->sl_info = NULL;

    vim_free(lp->sl_midword);
    lp->sl_midword = NULL;

    vim_free(lp->sl_compprog);
    vim_free(lp->sl_compstartflags);
    vim_free(lp->sl_compallflags);
    lp->sl_compprog = NULL;
    lp->sl_compstartflags = NULL;
    lp->sl_compallflags = NULL;

    vim_free(lp->sl_syllable);
    lp->sl_syllable = NULL;
    ga_clear(&lp->sl_syl_items);

    ga_clear_strings(&lp->sl_comppat);

    hash_clear_all(&lp->sl_wordcount, WC_KEY_OFF);
    hash_init(&lp->sl_wordcount);

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    hash_clear_all(&lp->sl_map_hash, 0);
#endif

    /* Clear info from .sug file. */
    slang_clear_sug(lp);

    lp->sl_compmax = MAXWLEN;
    lp->sl_compminlen = 0;
    lp->sl_compsylmax = MAXWLEN;
    lp->sl_regions[0] = NUL;
}

/*
 * Clear the info from the .sug file in "lp".
 */
    static void
slang_clear_sug(lp)
    slang_T     *lp;
{
    vim_free(lp->sl_sbyts);
    lp->sl_sbyts = NULL;
    vim_free(lp->sl_sidxs);
    lp->sl_sidxs = NULL;
    close_spellbuf(lp->sl_sugbuf);
    lp->sl_sugbuf = NULL;
    lp->sl_sugloaded = FALSE;
    lp->sl_sugtime = 0;
}

/*
 * Load one spell file and store the info into a slang_T.
 * Invoked through do_in_runtimepath().
 */
    static void
spell_load_cb(fname, cookie)
    char_u      *fname;
    void        *cookie;
{
    spelload_T  *slp = (spelload_T *)cookie;
    slang_T     *slang;

    slang = spell_load_file(fname, slp->sl_lang, NULL, FALSE);
    if (slang != NULL)
    {
        /* When a previously loaded file has NOBREAK also use it for the
         * ".add" files. */
        if (slp->sl_nobreak && slang->sl_add)
            slang->sl_nobreak = TRUE;
        else if (slang->sl_nobreak)
            slp->sl_nobreak = TRUE;

        slp->sl_slang = slang;
    }
}

/*
 * Load one spell file and store the info into a slang_T.
 *
 * This is invoked in three ways:
 * - From spell_load_cb() to load a spell file for the first time.  "lang" is
 *   the language name, "old_lp" is NULL.  Will allocate an slang_T.
 * - To reload a spell file that was changed.  "lang" is NULL and "old_lp"
 *   points to the existing slang_T.
 * - Just after writing a .spl file; it's read back to produce the .sug file.
 *   "old_lp" is NULL and "lang" is NULL.  Will allocate an slang_T.
 *
 * Returns the slang_T the spell file was loaded into.  NULL for error.
 */
    static slang_T *
spell_load_file(fname, lang, old_lp, silent)
    char_u      *fname;
    char_u      *lang;
    slang_T     *old_lp;
    int         silent;         /* no error if file doesn't exist */
{
    FILE        *fd;
    char_u      buf[VIMSPELLMAGICL];
    char_u      *p;
    int         i;
    int         n;
    int         len;
    char_u      *save_sourcing_name = sourcing_name;
    linenr_T    save_sourcing_lnum = sourcing_lnum;
    slang_T     *lp = NULL;
    int         c = 0;
    int         res;

    fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "r");
    if (fd == NULL)
    {
        if (!silent)
            EMSG2(_(e_notopen), fname);
        else if (p_verbose > 2)
        {
            verbose_enter();
            smsg((char_u *)e_notopen, fname);
            verbose_leave();
        }
        goto endFAIL;
    }
    if (p_verbose > 2)
    {
        verbose_enter();
        smsg((char_u *)_("Reading spell file \"%s\""), fname);
        verbose_leave();
    }

    if (old_lp == NULL)
    {
        lp = slang_alloc(lang);
        if (lp == NULL)
            goto endFAIL;

        /* Remember the file name, used to reload the file when it's updated. */
        lp->sl_fname = vim_strsave(fname);
        if (lp->sl_fname == NULL)
            goto endFAIL;

        /* Check for .add.spl. */
        lp->sl_add = strstr((char *)gettail(fname), ".add.") != NULL;
    }
    else
        lp = old_lp;

    /* Set sourcing_name, so that error messages mention the file name. */
    sourcing_name = fname;
    sourcing_lnum = 0;

    /*
     * <HEADER>: <fileID>
     */
    for (i = 0; i < VIMSPELLMAGICL; ++i)
        buf[i] = getc(fd);                              /* <fileID> */
    if (STRNCMP(buf, VIMSPELLMAGIC, VIMSPELLMAGICL) != 0)
    {
        EMSG(_("E757: This does not look like a spell file"));
        goto endFAIL;
    }
    c = getc(fd);                                       /* <versionnr> */
    if (c < VIMSPELLVERSION)
    {
        EMSG(_("E771: Old spell file, needs to be updated"));
        goto endFAIL;
    }
    else if (c > VIMSPELLVERSION)
    {
        EMSG(_("E772: Spell file is for newer version of Vim"));
        goto endFAIL;
    }


    /*
     * <SECTIONS>: <section> ... <sectionend>
     * <section>: <sectionID> <sectionflags> <sectionlen> (section contents)
     */
    for (;;)
    {
        n = getc(fd);                       /* <sectionID> or <sectionend> */
        if (n == SN_END)
            break;
        c = getc(fd);                                   /* <sectionflags> */
        len = get4c(fd);                                /* <sectionlen> */
        if (len < 0)
            goto truncerr;

        res = 0;
        switch (n)
        {
            case SN_INFO:
                lp->sl_info = read_string(fd, len);     /* <infotext> */
                if (lp->sl_info == NULL)
                    goto endFAIL;
                break;

            case SN_REGION:
                res = read_region_section(fd, lp, len);
                break;

            case SN_CHARFLAGS:
                res = read_charflags_section(fd);
                break;

            case SN_MIDWORD:
                lp->sl_midword = read_string(fd, len);  /* <midword> */
                if (lp->sl_midword == NULL)
                    goto endFAIL;
                break;

            case SN_PREFCOND:
                res = read_prefcond_section(fd, lp);
                break;

            case SN_REP:
                res = read_rep_section(fd, &lp->sl_rep, lp->sl_rep_first);
                break;

            case SN_REPSAL:
                res = read_rep_section(fd, &lp->sl_repsal, lp->sl_repsal_first);
                break;

            case SN_SAL:
                res = read_sal_section(fd, lp);
                break;

            case SN_SOFO:
                res = read_sofo_section(fd, lp);
                break;

            case SN_MAP:
                p = read_string(fd, len);               /* <mapstr> */
                if (p == NULL)
                    goto endFAIL;
                set_map_str(lp, p);
                vim_free(p);
                break;

            case SN_WORDS:
                res = read_words_section(fd, lp, len);
                break;

            case SN_SUGFILE:
                lp->sl_sugtime = get8c(fd);             /* <timestamp> */
                break;

            case SN_NOSPLITSUGS:
                lp->sl_nosplitsugs = TRUE;              /* <timestamp> */
                break;

            case SN_COMPOUND:
                res = read_compound(fd, lp, len);
                break;

            case SN_NOBREAK:
                lp->sl_nobreak = TRUE;
                break;

            case SN_SYLLABLE:
                lp->sl_syllable = read_string(fd, len); /* <syllable> */
                if (lp->sl_syllable == NULL)
                    goto endFAIL;
                if (init_syl_tab(lp) == FAIL)
                    goto endFAIL;
                break;

            default:
                /* Unsupported section.  When it's required give an error
                 * message.  When it's not required skip the contents. */
                if (c & SNF_REQUIRED)
                {
                    EMSG(_("E770: Unsupported section in spell file"));
                    goto endFAIL;
                }
                while (--len >= 0)
                    if (getc(fd) < 0)
                        goto truncerr;
                break;
        }
someerror:
        if (res == SP_FORMERROR)
        {
            EMSG(_(e_format));
            goto endFAIL;
        }
        if (res == SP_TRUNCERROR)
        {
truncerr:
            EMSG(_(e_spell_trunc));
            goto endFAIL;
        }
        if (res == SP_OTHERERROR)
            goto endFAIL;
    }

    /* <LWORDTREE> */
    res = spell_read_tree(fd, &lp->sl_fbyts, &lp->sl_fidxs, FALSE, 0);
    if (res != 0)
        goto someerror;

    /* <KWORDTREE> */
    res = spell_read_tree(fd, &lp->sl_kbyts, &lp->sl_kidxs, FALSE, 0);
    if (res != 0)
        goto someerror;

    /* <PREFIXTREE> */
    res = spell_read_tree(fd, &lp->sl_pbyts, &lp->sl_pidxs, TRUE,
                                                            lp->sl_prefixcnt);
    if (res != 0)
        goto someerror;

    /* For a new file link it in the list of spell files. */
    if (old_lp == NULL && lang != NULL)
    {
        lp->sl_next = first_lang;
        first_lang = lp;
    }

    goto endOK;

endFAIL:
    if (lang != NULL)
        /* truncating the name signals the error to spell_load_lang() */
        *lang = NUL;
    if (lp != NULL && old_lp == NULL)
        slang_free(lp);
    lp = NULL;

endOK:
    if (fd != NULL)
        fclose(fd);
    sourcing_name = save_sourcing_name;
    sourcing_lnum = save_sourcing_lnum;

    return lp;
}

/*
 * Read 2 bytes from "fd" and turn them into an int, MSB first.
 */
    static int
get2c(fd)
    FILE        *fd;
{
    long        n;

    n = getc(fd);
    n = (n << 8) + getc(fd);
    return n;
}

/*
 * Read 3 bytes from "fd" and turn them into an int, MSB first.
 */
    static int
get3c(fd)
    FILE        *fd;
{
    long        n;

    n = getc(fd);
    n = (n << 8) + getc(fd);
    n = (n << 8) + getc(fd);
    return n;
}

/*
 * Read 4 bytes from "fd" and turn them into an int, MSB first.
 */
    static int
get4c(fd)
    FILE        *fd;
{
    long        n;

    n = getc(fd);
    n = (n << 8) + getc(fd);
    n = (n << 8) + getc(fd);
    n = (n << 8) + getc(fd);
    return n;
}

/*
 * Read 8 bytes from "fd" and turn them into a time_t, MSB first.
 */
    static time_t
get8c(fd)
    FILE        *fd;
{
    time_t      n = 0;
    int         i;

    for (i = 0; i < 8; ++i)
        n = (n << 8) + getc(fd);
    return n;
}

/*
 * Read a length field from "fd" in "cnt_bytes" bytes.
 * Allocate memory, read the string into it and add a NUL at the end.
 * Returns NULL when the count is zero.
 * Sets "*cntp" to SP_*ERROR when there is an error, length of the result
 * otherwise.
 */
    static char_u *
read_cnt_string(fd, cnt_bytes, cntp)
    FILE        *fd;
    int         cnt_bytes;
    int         *cntp;
{
    int         cnt = 0;
    int         i;
    char_u      *str;

    /* read the length bytes, MSB first */
    for (i = 0; i < cnt_bytes; ++i)
        cnt = (cnt << 8) + getc(fd);
    if (cnt < 0)
    {
        *cntp = SP_TRUNCERROR;
        return NULL;
    }
    *cntp = cnt;
    if (cnt == 0)
        return NULL;        /* nothing to read, return NULL */

    str = read_string(fd, cnt);
    if (str == NULL)
        *cntp = SP_OTHERERROR;
    return str;
}

/*
 * Read a string of length "cnt" from "fd" into allocated memory.
 * Returns NULL when out of memory.
 */
    static char_u *
read_string(fd, cnt)
    FILE        *fd;
    int         cnt;
{
    char_u      *str;
    int         i;

    /* allocate memory */
    str = alloc((unsigned)cnt + 1);
    if (str != NULL)
    {
        /* Read the string.  Doesn't check for truncated file. */
        for (i = 0; i < cnt; ++i)
            str[i] = getc(fd);
        str[i] = NUL;
    }
    return str;
}

/*
 * Read SN_REGION: <regionname> ...
 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
 */
    static int
read_region_section(fd, lp, len)
    FILE        *fd;
    slang_T     *lp;
    int         len;
{
    int         i;

    if (len > 16)
        return SP_FORMERROR;
    for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
        lp->sl_regions[i] = getc(fd);                   /* <regionname> */
    lp->sl_regions[len] = NUL;
    return 0;
}

/*
 * Read SN_CHARFLAGS section: <charflagslen> <charflags>
 *                              <folcharslen> <folchars>
 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
 */
    static int
read_charflags_section(fd)
    FILE        *fd;
{
    char_u      *flags;
    char_u      *fol;
    int         flagslen, follen;

    /* <charflagslen> <charflags> */
    flags = read_cnt_string(fd, 1, &flagslen);
    if (flagslen < 0)
        return flagslen;

    /* <folcharslen> <folchars> */
    fol = read_cnt_string(fd, 2, &follen);
    if (follen < 0)
    {
        vim_free(flags);
        return follen;
    }

    /* Set the word-char flags and fill SPELL_ISUPPER() table. */
    if (flags != NULL && fol != NULL)
        set_spell_charflags(flags, flagslen, fol);

    vim_free(flags);
    vim_free(fol);

    /* When <charflagslen> is zero then <fcharlen> must also be zero. */
    if ((flags == NULL) != (fol == NULL))
        return SP_FORMERROR;
    return 0;
}

/*
 * Read SN_PREFCOND section.
 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
 */
    static int
read_prefcond_section(fd, lp)
    FILE        *fd;
    slang_T     *lp;
{
    int         cnt;
    int         i;
    int         n;
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      buf[MAXWLEN + 1];

    /* <prefcondcnt> <prefcond> ... */
    cnt = get2c(fd);                                    /* <prefcondcnt> */
    if (cnt <= 0)
        return SP_FORMERROR;

    lp->sl_prefprog = (regprog_T **)alloc_clear(
                                         (unsigned)sizeof(regprog_T *) * cnt);
    if (lp->sl_prefprog == NULL)
        return SP_OTHERERROR;
    lp->sl_prefixcnt = cnt;

    for (i = 0; i < cnt; ++i)
    {
        /* <prefcond> : <condlen> <condstr> */
        n = getc(fd);                                   /* <condlen> */
        if (n < 0 || n >= MAXWLEN)
            return SP_FORMERROR;

        /* When <condlen> is zero we have an empty condition.  Otherwise
         * compile the regexp program used to check for the condition. */
        if (n > 0)
        {
            buf[0] = '^';           /* always match at one position only */
            p = buf + 1;
            while (n-- > 0)
                *p++ = getc(fd);                        /* <condstr> */
            *p = NUL;
            lp->sl_prefprog[i] = vim_regcomp(buf, RE_MAGIC + RE_STRING);
        }
    }
    return 0;
}

/*
 * Read REP or REPSAL items section from "fd": <repcount> <rep> ...
 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
 */
    static int
read_rep_section(fd, gap, first)
    FILE        *fd;
    garray_T    *gap;
    short       *first;
{
    int         cnt;
    fromto_T    *ftp;
    int         i;

    cnt = get2c(fd);                                    /* <repcount> */
    if (cnt < 0)
        return SP_TRUNCERROR;

    if (ga_grow(gap, cnt) == FAIL)
        return SP_OTHERERROR;

    /* <rep> : <repfromlen> <repfrom> <reptolen> <repto> */
    for (; gap->ga_len < cnt; ++gap->ga_len)
    {
        ftp = &((fromto_T *)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len];
        ftp->ft_from = read_cnt_string(fd, 1, &i);
        if (i < 0)
            return i;
        if (i == 0)
            return SP_FORMERROR;
        ftp->ft_to = read_cnt_string(fd, 1, &i);
        if (i <= 0)
        {
            vim_free(ftp->ft_from);
            if (i < 0)
                return i;
            return SP_FORMERROR;
        }
    }

    /* Fill the first-index table. */
    for (i = 0; i < 256; ++i)
        first[i] = -1;
    for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; ++i)
    {
        ftp = &((fromto_T *)gap->ga_data)[i];
        if (first[*ftp->ft_from] == -1)
            first[*ftp->ft_from] = i;
    }
    return 0;
}

/*
 * Read SN_SAL section: <salflags> <salcount> <sal> ...
 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
 */
    static int
read_sal_section(fd, slang)
    FILE        *fd;
    slang_T     *slang;
{
    int         i;
    int         cnt;
    garray_T    *gap;
    salitem_T   *smp;
    int         ccnt;
    char_u      *p;
    int         c = NUL;

    slang->sl_sofo = FALSE;

    i = getc(fd);                               /* <salflags> */
    if (i & SAL_F0LLOWUP)
        slang->sl_followup = TRUE;
    if (i & SAL_COLLAPSE)
        slang->sl_collapse = TRUE;
    if (i & SAL_REM_ACCENTS)
        slang->sl_rem_accents = TRUE;

    cnt = get2c(fd);                            /* <salcount> */
    if (cnt < 0)
        return SP_TRUNCERROR;

    gap = &slang->sl_sal;
    ga_init2(gap, sizeof(salitem_T), 10);
    if (ga_grow(gap, cnt + 1) == FAIL)
        return SP_OTHERERROR;

    /* <sal> : <salfromlen> <salfrom> <saltolen> <salto> */
    for (; gap->ga_len < cnt; ++gap->ga_len)
    {
        smp = &((salitem_T *)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len];
        ccnt = getc(fd);                        /* <salfromlen> */
        if (ccnt < 0)
            return SP_TRUNCERROR;
        if ((p = alloc(ccnt + 2)) == NULL)
            return SP_OTHERERROR;
        smp->sm_lead = p;

        /* Read up to the first special char into sm_lead. */
        for (i = 0; i < ccnt; ++i)
        {
            c = getc(fd);                       /* <salfrom> */
            if (vim_strchr((char_u *)"0123456789(-<^$", c) != NULL)
                break;
            *p++ = c;
        }
        smp->sm_leadlen = (int)(p - smp->sm_lead);
        *p++ = NUL;

        /* Put (abc) chars in sm_oneof, if any. */
        if (c == '(')
        {
            smp->sm_oneof = p;
            for (++i; i < ccnt; ++i)
            {
                c = getc(fd);                   /* <salfrom> */
                if (c == ')')
                    break;
                *p++ = c;
            }
            *p++ = NUL;
            if (++i < ccnt)
                c = getc(fd);
        }
        else
            smp->sm_oneof = NULL;

        /* Any following chars go in sm_rules. */
        smp->sm_rules = p;
        if (i < ccnt)
            /* store the char we got while checking for end of sm_lead */
            *p++ = c;
        for (++i; i < ccnt; ++i)
            *p++ = getc(fd);                    /* <salfrom> */
        *p++ = NUL;

        /* <saltolen> <salto> */
        smp->sm_to = read_cnt_string(fd, 1, &ccnt);
        if (ccnt < 0)
        {
            vim_free(smp->sm_lead);
            return ccnt;
        }

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (has_mbyte)
        {
            /* convert the multi-byte strings to wide char strings */
            smp->sm_lead_w = mb_str2wide(smp->sm_lead);
            smp->sm_leadlen = mb_charlen(smp->sm_lead);
            if (smp->sm_oneof == NULL)
                smp->sm_oneof_w = NULL;
            else
                smp->sm_oneof_w = mb_str2wide(smp->sm_oneof);
            if (smp->sm_to == NULL)
                smp->sm_to_w = NULL;
            else
                smp->sm_to_w = mb_str2wide(smp->sm_to);
            if (smp->sm_lead_w == NULL
                    || (smp->sm_oneof_w == NULL && smp->sm_oneof != NULL)
                    || (smp->sm_to_w == NULL && smp->sm_to != NULL))
            {
                vim_free(smp->sm_lead);
                vim_free(smp->sm_to);
                vim_free(smp->sm_lead_w);
                vim_free(smp->sm_oneof_w);
                vim_free(smp->sm_to_w);
                return SP_OTHERERROR;
            }
        }
#endif
    }

    if (gap->ga_len > 0)
    {
        /* Add one extra entry to mark the end with an empty sm_lead.  Avoids
         * that we need to check the index every time. */
        smp = &((salitem_T *)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len];
        if ((p = alloc(1)) == NULL)
            return SP_OTHERERROR;
        p[0] = NUL;
        smp->sm_lead = p;
        smp->sm_leadlen = 0;
        smp->sm_oneof = NULL;
        smp->sm_rules = p;
        smp->sm_to = NULL;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (has_mbyte)
        {
            smp->sm_lead_w = mb_str2wide(smp->sm_lead);
            smp->sm_leadlen = 0;
            smp->sm_oneof_w = NULL;
            smp->sm_to_w = NULL;
        }
#endif
        ++gap->ga_len;
    }

    /* Fill the first-index table. */
    set_sal_first(slang);

    return 0;
}

/*
 * Read SN_WORDS: <word> ...
 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
 */
    static int
read_words_section(fd, lp, len)
    FILE        *fd;
    slang_T     *lp;
    int         len;
{
    int         done = 0;
    int         i;
    char_u      word[MAXWLEN];

    while (done < len)
    {
        /* Read one word at a time. */
        for (i = 0; ; ++i)
        {
            word[i] = getc(fd);
            if (word[i] == NUL)
                break;
            if (i == MAXWLEN - 1)
                return SP_FORMERROR;
        }

        /* Init the count to 10. */
        count_common_word(lp, word, -1, 10);
        done += i + 1;
    }
    return 0;
}

/*
 * Add a word to the hashtable of common words.
 * If it's already there then the counter is increased.
 */
    static void
count_common_word(lp, word, len, count)
    slang_T     *lp;
    char_u      *word;
    int         len;        /* word length, -1 for upto NUL */
    int         count;      /* 1 to count once, 10 to init */
{
    hash_T      hash;
    hashitem_T  *hi;
    wordcount_T *wc;
    char_u      buf[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      *p;

    if (len == -1)
        p = word;
    else
    {
        vim_strncpy(buf, word, len);
        p = buf;
    }

    hash = hash_hash(p);
    hi = hash_lookup(&lp->sl_wordcount, p, hash);
    if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
    {
        wc = (wordcount_T *)alloc((unsigned)(sizeof(wordcount_T) + STRLEN(p)));
        if (wc == NULL)
            return;
        STRCPY(wc->wc_word, p);
        wc->wc_count = count;
        hash_add_item(&lp->sl_wordcount, hi, wc->wc_word, hash);
    }
    else
    {
        wc = HI2WC(hi);
        if ((wc->wc_count += count) < (unsigned)count)  /* check for overflow */
            wc->wc_count = MAXWORDCOUNT;
    }
}

/*
 * Adjust the score of common words.
 */
    static int
score_wordcount_adj(slang, score, word, split)
    slang_T     *slang;
    int         score;
    char_u      *word;
    int         split;      /* word was split, less bonus */
{
    hashitem_T  *hi;
    wordcount_T *wc;
    int         bonus;
    int         newscore;

    hi = hash_find(&slang->sl_wordcount, word);
    if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
    {
        wc = HI2WC(hi);
        if (wc->wc_count < SCORE_THRES2)
            bonus = SCORE_COMMON1;
        else if (wc->wc_count < SCORE_THRES3)
            bonus = SCORE_COMMON2;
        else
            bonus = SCORE_COMMON3;
        if (split)
            newscore = score - bonus / 2;
        else
            newscore = score - bonus;
        if (newscore < 0)
            return 0;
        return newscore;
    }
    return score;
}

/*
 * SN_SOFO: <sofofromlen> <sofofrom> <sofotolen> <sofoto>
 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
 */
    static int
read_sofo_section(fd, slang)
    FILE        *fd;
    slang_T     *slang;
{
    int         cnt;
    char_u      *from, *to;
    int         res;

    slang->sl_sofo = TRUE;

    /* <sofofromlen> <sofofrom> */
    from = read_cnt_string(fd, 2, &cnt);
    if (cnt < 0)
        return cnt;

    /* <sofotolen> <sofoto> */
    to = read_cnt_string(fd, 2, &cnt);
    if (cnt < 0)
    {
        vim_free(from);
        return cnt;
    }

    /* Store the info in slang->sl_sal and/or slang->sl_sal_first. */
    if (from != NULL && to != NULL)
        res = set_sofo(slang, from, to);
    else if (from != NULL || to != NULL)
        res = SP_FORMERROR;    /* only one of two strings is an error */
    else
        res = 0;

    vim_free(from);
    vim_free(to);
    return res;
}

/*
 * Read the compound section from the .spl file:
 *      <compmax> <compminlen> <compsylmax> <compoptions> <compflags>
 * Returns SP_*ERROR flags.
 */
    static int
read_compound(fd, slang, len)
    FILE        *fd;
    slang_T     *slang;
    int         len;
{
    int         todo = len;
    int         c;
    int         atstart;
    char_u      *pat;
    char_u      *pp;
    char_u      *cp;
    char_u      *ap;
    int         cnt;
    garray_T    *gap;

    if (todo < 2)
        return SP_FORMERROR;    /* need at least two bytes */

    --todo;
    c = getc(fd);                                       /* <compmax> */
    if (c < 2)
        c = MAXWLEN;
    slang->sl_compmax = c;

    --todo;
    c = getc(fd);                                       /* <compminlen> */
    if (c < 1)
        c = 0;
    slang->sl_compminlen = c;

    --todo;
    c = getc(fd);                                       /* <compsylmax> */
    if (c < 1)
        c = MAXWLEN;
    slang->sl_compsylmax = c;

    c = getc(fd);                                       /* <compoptions> */
    if (c != 0)
        ungetc(c, fd);      /* be backwards compatible with Vim 7.0b */
    else
    {
        --todo;
        c = getc(fd);       /* only use the lower byte for now */
        --todo;
        slang->sl_compoptions = c;

        gap = &slang->sl_comppat;
        c = get2c(fd);                                  /* <comppatcount> */
        todo -= 2;
        ga_init2(gap, sizeof(char_u *), c);
        if (ga_grow(gap, c) == OK)
            while (--c >= 0)
            {
                ((char_u **)(gap->ga_data))[gap->ga_len++] =
                                                 read_cnt_string(fd, 1, &cnt);
                                            /* <comppatlen> <comppattext> */
                if (cnt < 0)
                    return cnt;
                todo -= cnt + 1;
            }
    }
    if (todo < 0)
        return SP_FORMERROR;

    /* Turn the COMPOUNDRULE items into a regexp pattern:
     * "a[bc]/a*b+" -> "^\(a[bc]\|a*b\+\)$".
     * Inserting backslashes may double the length, "^\(\)$<Nul>" is 7 bytes.
     * Conversion to utf-8 may double the size. */
    c = todo * 2 + 7;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (enc_utf8)
        c += todo * 2;
#endif
    pat = alloc((unsigned)c);
    if (pat == NULL)
        return SP_OTHERERROR;

    /* We also need a list of all flags that can appear at the start and one
     * for all flags. */
    cp = alloc(todo + 1);
    if (cp == NULL)
    {
        vim_free(pat);
        return SP_OTHERERROR;
    }
    slang->sl_compstartflags = cp;
    *cp = NUL;

    ap = alloc(todo + 1);
    if (ap == NULL)
    {
        vim_free(pat);
        return SP_OTHERERROR;
    }
    slang->sl_compallflags = ap;
    *ap = NUL;

    pp = pat;
    *pp++ = '^';
    *pp++ = '\\';
    *pp++ = '(';

    atstart = 1;
    while (todo-- > 0)
    {
        c = getc(fd);                                   /* <compflags> */

        /* Add all flags to "sl_compallflags". */
        if (vim_strchr((char_u *)"+*[]/", c) == NULL
                && !byte_in_str(slang->sl_compallflags, c))
        {
            *ap++ = c;
            *ap = NUL;
        }

        if (atstart != 0)
        {
            /* At start of item: copy flags to "sl_compstartflags".  For a
             * [abc] item set "atstart" to 2 and copy up to the ']'. */
            if (c == '[')
                atstart = 2;
            else if (c == ']')
                atstart = 0;
            else
            {
                if (!byte_in_str(slang->sl_compstartflags, c))
                {
                    *cp++ = c;
                    *cp = NUL;
                }
                if (atstart == 1)
                    atstart = 0;
            }
        }
        if (c == '/')       /* slash separates two items */
        {
            *pp++ = '\\';
            *pp++ = '|';
            atstart = 1;
        }
        else                /* normal char, "[abc]" and '*' are copied as-is */
        {
            if (c == '+' || c == '~')
                *pp++ = '\\';       /* "a+" becomes "a\+" */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (enc_utf8)
                pp += mb_char2bytes(c, pp);
            else
#endif
                *pp++ = c;
        }
    }

    *pp++ = '\\';
    *pp++ = ')';
    *pp++ = '$';
    *pp = NUL;

    slang->sl_compprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC + RE_STRING + RE_STRICT);
    vim_free(pat);
    if (slang->sl_compprog == NULL)
        return SP_FORMERROR;

    return 0;
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if byte "n" appears in "str".
 * Like strchr() but independent of locale.
 */
    static int
byte_in_str(str, n)
    char_u      *str;
    int         n;
{
    char_u      *p;

    for (p = str; *p != NUL; ++p)
        if (*p == n)
            return TRUE;
    return FALSE;
}

#define SY_MAXLEN   30
typedef struct syl_item_S
{
    char_u      sy_chars[SY_MAXLEN];        /* the sequence of chars */
    int         sy_len;
} syl_item_T;

/*
 * Truncate "slang->sl_syllable" at the first slash and put the following items
 * in "slang->sl_syl_items".
 */
    static int
init_syl_tab(slang)
    slang_T     *slang;
{
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *s;
    int         l;
    syl_item_T  *syl;

    ga_init2(&slang->sl_syl_items, sizeof(syl_item_T), 4);
    p = vim_strchr(slang->sl_syllable, '/');
    while (p != NULL)
    {
        *p++ = NUL;
        if (*p == NUL)      /* trailing slash */
            break;
        s = p;
        p = vim_strchr(p, '/');
        if (p == NULL)
            l = (int)STRLEN(s);
        else
            l = (int)(p - s);
        if (l >= SY_MAXLEN)
            return SP_FORMERROR;
        if (ga_grow(&slang->sl_syl_items, 1) == FAIL)
            return SP_OTHERERROR;
        syl = ((syl_item_T *)slang->sl_syl_items.ga_data)
                                               + slang->sl_syl_items.ga_len++;
        vim_strncpy(syl->sy_chars, s, l);
        syl->sy_len = l;
    }
    return OK;
}

/*
 * Count the number of syllables in "word".
 * When "word" contains spaces the syllables after the last space are counted.
 * Returns zero if syllables are not defines.
 */
    static int
count_syllables(slang, word)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *word;
{
    int         cnt = 0;
    int         skip = FALSE;
    char_u      *p;
    int         len;
    int         i;
    syl_item_T  *syl;
    int         c;

    if (slang->sl_syllable == NULL)
        return 0;

    for (p = word; *p != NUL; p += len)
    {
        /* When running into a space reset counter. */
        if (*p == ' ')
        {
            len = 1;
            cnt = 0;
            continue;
        }

        /* Find longest match of syllable items. */
        len = 0;
        for (i = 0; i < slang->sl_syl_items.ga_len; ++i)
        {
            syl = ((syl_item_T *)slang->sl_syl_items.ga_data) + i;
            if (syl->sy_len > len
                               && STRNCMP(p, syl->sy_chars, syl->sy_len) == 0)
                len = syl->sy_len;
        }
        if (len != 0)   /* found a match, count syllable  */
        {
            ++cnt;
            skip = FALSE;
        }
        else
        {
            /* No recognized syllable item, at least a syllable char then? */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            c = mb_ptr2char(p);
            len = (*mb_ptr2len)(p);
#else
            c = *p;
            len = 1;
#endif
            if (vim_strchr(slang->sl_syllable, c) == NULL)
                skip = FALSE;       /* No, search for next syllable */
            else if (!skip)
            {
                ++cnt;              /* Yes, count it */
                skip = TRUE;        /* don't count following syllable chars */
            }
        }
    }
    return cnt;
}

/*
 * Set the SOFOFROM and SOFOTO items in language "lp".
 * Returns SP_*ERROR flags when there is something wrong.
 */
    static int
set_sofo(lp, from, to)
    slang_T     *lp;
    char_u      *from;
    char_u      *to;
{
    int         i;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    garray_T    *gap;
    char_u      *s;
    char_u      *p;
    int         c;
    int         *inp;

    if (has_mbyte)
    {
        /* Use "sl_sal" as an array with 256 pointers to a list of wide
         * characters.  The index is the low byte of the character.
         * The list contains from-to pairs with a terminating NUL.
         * sl_sal_first[] is used for latin1 "from" characters. */
        gap = &lp->sl_sal;
        ga_init2(gap, sizeof(int *), 1);
        if (ga_grow(gap, 256) == FAIL)
            return SP_OTHERERROR;
        vim_memset(gap->ga_data, 0, sizeof(int *) * 256);
        gap->ga_len = 256;

        /* First count the number of items for each list.  Temporarily use
         * sl_sal_first[] for this. */
        for (p = from, s = to; *p != NUL && *s != NUL; )
        {
            c = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
            mb_cptr_adv(s);
            if (c >= 256)
                ++lp->sl_sal_first[c & 0xff];
        }
        if (*p != NUL || *s != NUL)         /* lengths differ */
            return SP_FORMERROR;

        /* Allocate the lists. */
        for (i = 0; i < 256; ++i)
            if (lp->sl_sal_first[i] > 0)
            {
                p = alloc(sizeof(int) * (lp->sl_sal_first[i] * 2 + 1));
                if (p == NULL)
                    return SP_OTHERERROR;
                ((int **)gap->ga_data)[i] = (int *)p;
                *(int *)p = 0;
            }

        /* Put the characters up to 255 in sl_sal_first[] the rest in a sl_sal
         * list. */
        vim_memset(lp->sl_sal_first, 0, sizeof(salfirst_T) * 256);
        for (p = from, s = to; *p != NUL && *s != NUL; )
        {
            c = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
            i = mb_cptr2char_adv(&s);
            if (c >= 256)
            {
                /* Append the from-to chars at the end of the list with
                 * the low byte. */
                inp = ((int **)gap->ga_data)[c & 0xff];
                while (*inp != 0)
                    ++inp;
                *inp++ = c;             /* from char */
                *inp++ = i;             /* to char */
                *inp++ = NUL;           /* NUL at the end */
            }
            else
                /* mapping byte to char is done in sl_sal_first[] */
                lp->sl_sal_first[c] = i;
        }
    }
    else
#endif
    {
        /* mapping bytes to bytes is done in sl_sal_first[] */
        if (STRLEN(from) != STRLEN(to))
            return SP_FORMERROR;

        for (i = 0; to[i] != NUL; ++i)
            lp->sl_sal_first[from[i]] = to[i];
        lp->sl_sal.ga_len = 1;          /* indicates we have soundfolding */
    }

    return 0;
}

/*
 * Fill the first-index table for "lp".
 */
    static void
set_sal_first(lp)
    slang_T     *lp;
{
    salfirst_T  *sfirst;
    int         i;
    salitem_T   *smp;
    int         c;
    garray_T    *gap = &lp->sl_sal;

    sfirst = lp->sl_sal_first;
    for (i = 0; i < 256; ++i)
        sfirst[i] = -1;
    smp = (salitem_T *)gap->ga_data;
    for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; ++i)
    {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (has_mbyte)
            /* Use the lowest byte of the first character.  For latin1 it's
             * the character, for other encodings it should differ for most
             * characters. */
            c = *smp[i].sm_lead_w & 0xff;
        else
#endif
            c = *smp[i].sm_lead;
        if (sfirst[c] == -1)
        {
            sfirst[c] = i;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                int             n;

                /* Make sure all entries with this byte are following each
                 * other.  Move the ones that are in the wrong position.  Do
                 * keep the same ordering! */
                while (i + 1 < gap->ga_len
                                       && (*smp[i + 1].sm_lead_w & 0xff) == c)
                    /* Skip over entry with same index byte. */
                    ++i;

                for (n = 1; i + n < gap->ga_len; ++n)
                    if ((*smp[i + n].sm_lead_w & 0xff) == c)
                    {
                        salitem_T  tsal;

                        /* Move entry with same index byte after the entries
                         * we already found. */
                        ++i;
                        --n;
                        tsal = smp[i + n];
                        mch_memmove(smp + i + 1, smp + i,
                                                       sizeof(salitem_T) * n);
                        smp[i] = tsal;
                    }
            }
#endif
        }
    }
}

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
/*
 * Turn a multi-byte string into a wide character string.
 * Return it in allocated memory (NULL for out-of-memory)
 */
    static int *
mb_str2wide(s)
    char_u      *s;
{
    int         *res;
    char_u      *p;
    int         i = 0;

    res = (int *)alloc(sizeof(int) * (mb_charlen(s) + 1));
    if (res != NULL)
    {
        for (p = s; *p != NUL; )
            res[i++] = mb_ptr2char_adv(&p);
        res[i] = NUL;
    }
    return res;
}
#endif

/*
 * Read a tree from the .spl or .sug file.
 * Allocates the memory and stores pointers in "bytsp" and "idxsp".
 * This is skipped when the tree has zero length.
 * Returns zero when OK, SP_ value for an error.
 */
    static int
spell_read_tree(fd, bytsp, idxsp, prefixtree, prefixcnt)
    FILE        *fd;
    char_u      **bytsp;
    idx_T       **idxsp;
    int         prefixtree;     /* TRUE for the prefix tree */
    int         prefixcnt;      /* when "prefixtree" is TRUE: prefix count */
{
    int         len;
    int         idx;
    char_u      *bp;
    idx_T       *ip;

    /* The tree size was computed when writing the file, so that we can
     * allocate it as one long block. <nodecount> */
    len = get4c(fd);
    if (len < 0)
        return SP_TRUNCERROR;
    if (len > 0)
    {
        /* Allocate the byte array. */
        bp = lalloc((long_u)len, TRUE);
        if (bp == NULL)
            return SP_OTHERERROR;
        *bytsp = bp;

        /* Allocate the index array. */
        ip = (idx_T *)lalloc_clear((long_u)(len * sizeof(int)), TRUE);
        if (ip == NULL)
            return SP_OTHERERROR;
        *idxsp = ip;

        /* Recursively read the tree and store it in the array. */
        idx = read_tree_node(fd, bp, ip, len, 0, prefixtree, prefixcnt);
        if (idx < 0)
            return idx;
    }
    return 0;
}

/*
 * Read one row of siblings from the spell file and store it in the byte array
 * "byts" and index array "idxs".  Recursively read the children.
 *
 * NOTE: The code here must match put_node()!
 *
 * Returns the index (>= 0) following the siblings.
 * Returns SP_TRUNCERROR if the file is shorter than expected.
 * Returns SP_FORMERROR if there is a format error.
 */
    static idx_T
read_tree_node(fd, byts, idxs, maxidx, startidx, prefixtree, maxprefcondnr)
    FILE        *fd;
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;
    int         maxidx;             /* size of arrays */
    idx_T       startidx;           /* current index in "byts" and "idxs" */
    int         prefixtree;         /* TRUE for reading PREFIXTREE */
    int         maxprefcondnr;      /* maximum for <prefcondnr> */
{
    int         len;
    int         i;
    int         n;
    idx_T       idx = startidx;
    int         c;
    int         c2;
#define SHARED_MASK     0x8000000

    len = getc(fd);                                     /* <siblingcount> */
    if (len <= 0)
        return SP_TRUNCERROR;

    if (startidx + len >= maxidx)
        return SP_FORMERROR;
    byts[idx++] = len;

    /* Read the byte values, flag/region bytes and shared indexes. */
    for (i = 1; i <= len; ++i)
    {
        c = getc(fd);                                   /* <byte> */
        if (c < 0)
            return SP_TRUNCERROR;
        if (c <= BY_SPECIAL)
        {
            if (c == BY_NOFLAGS && !prefixtree)
            {
                /* No flags, all regions. */
                idxs[idx] = 0;
                c = 0;
            }
            else if (c != BY_INDEX)
            {
                if (prefixtree)
                {
                    /* Read the optional pflags byte, the prefix ID and the
                     * condition nr.  In idxs[] store the prefix ID in the low
                     * byte, the condition index shifted up 8 bits, the flags
                     * shifted up 24 bits. */
                    if (c == BY_FLAGS)
                        c = getc(fd) << 24;             /* <pflags> */
                    else
                        c = 0;

                    c |= getc(fd);                      /* <affixID> */

                    n = get2c(fd);                      /* <prefcondnr> */
                    if (n >= maxprefcondnr)
                        return SP_FORMERROR;
                    c |= (n << 8);
                }
                else /* c must be BY_FLAGS or BY_FLAGS2 */
                {
                    /* Read flags and optional region and prefix ID.  In
                     * idxs[] the flags go in the low two bytes, region above
                     * that and prefix ID above the region. */
                    c2 = c;
                    c = getc(fd);                       /* <flags> */
                    if (c2 == BY_FLAGS2)
                        c = (getc(fd) << 8) + c;        /* <flags2> */
                    if (c & WF_REGION)
                        c = (getc(fd) << 16) + c;       /* <region> */
                    if (c & WF_AFX)
                        c = (getc(fd) << 24) + c;       /* <affixID> */
                }

                idxs[idx] = c;
                c = 0;
            }
            else /* c == BY_INDEX */
            {
                                                        /* <nodeidx> */
                n = get3c(fd);
                if (n < 0 || n >= maxidx)
                    return SP_FORMERROR;
                idxs[idx] = n + SHARED_MASK;
                c = getc(fd);                           /* <xbyte> */
            }
        }
        byts[idx++] = c;
    }

    /* Recursively read the children for non-shared siblings.
     * Skip the end-of-word ones (zero byte value) and the shared ones (and
     * remove SHARED_MASK) */
    for (i = 1; i <= len; ++i)
        if (byts[startidx + i] != 0)
        {
            if (idxs[startidx + i] & SHARED_MASK)
                idxs[startidx + i] &= ~SHARED_MASK;
            else
            {
                idxs[startidx + i] = idx;
                idx = read_tree_node(fd, byts, idxs, maxidx, idx,
                                                     prefixtree, maxprefcondnr);
                if (idx < 0)
                    break;
            }
        }

    return idx;
}

/*
 * Parse 'spelllang' and set buf->b_langp accordingly.
 * Returns NULL if it's OK, an error message otherwise.
 */
    char_u *
did_set_spelllang(buf)
    buf_T       *buf;
{
    garray_T    ga;
    char_u      *splp;
    char_u      *region;
    char_u      region_cp[3];
    int         filename;
    int         region_mask;
    slang_T     *slang;
    int         c;
    char_u      lang[MAXWLEN + 1];
    char_u      spf_name[MAXPATHL];
    int         len;
    char_u      *p;
    int         round;
    char_u      *spf;
    char_u      *use_region = NULL;
    int         dont_use_region = FALSE;
    int         nobreak = FALSE;
    int         i, j;
    langp_T     *lp, *lp2;
    static int  recursive = FALSE;
    char_u      *ret_msg = NULL;
    char_u      *spl_copy;

    /* We don't want to do this recursively.  May happen when a language is
     * not available and the SpellFileMissing autocommand opens a new buffer
     * in which 'spell' is set. */
    if (recursive)
        return NULL;
    recursive = TRUE;

    ga_init2(&ga, sizeof(langp_T), 2);
    clear_midword(buf);

    /* Make a copy of 'spellang', the SpellFileMissing autocommands may change
     * it under our fingers. */
    spl_copy = vim_strsave(buf->b_p_spl);
    if (spl_copy == NULL)
        goto theend;

    /* loop over comma separated language names. */
    for (splp = spl_copy; *splp != NUL; )
    {
        /* Get one language name. */
        copy_option_part(&splp, lang, MAXWLEN, ",");

        region = NULL;
        len = (int)STRLEN(lang);

        /* If the name ends in ".spl" use it as the name of the spell file.
         * If there is a region name let "region" point to it and remove it
         * from the name. */
        if (len > 4 && fnamecmp(lang + len - 4, ".spl") == 0)
        {
            filename = TRUE;

            /* Locate a region and remove it from the file name. */
            p = vim_strchr(gettail(lang), '_');
            if (p != NULL && ASCII_ISALPHA(p[1]) && ASCII_ISALPHA(p[2])
                                                      && !ASCII_ISALPHA(p[3]))
            {
                vim_strncpy(region_cp, p + 1, 2);
                mch_memmove(p, p + 3, len - (p - lang) - 2);
                len -= 3;
                region = region_cp;
            }
            else
                dont_use_region = TRUE;

            /* Check if we loaded this language before. */
            for (slang = first_lang; slang != NULL; slang = slang->sl_next)
                if (fullpathcmp(lang, slang->sl_fname, FALSE) == FPC_SAME)
                    break;
        }
        else
        {
            filename = FALSE;
            if (len > 3 && lang[len - 3] == '_')
            {
                region = lang + len - 2;
                len -= 3;
                lang[len] = NUL;
            }
            else
                dont_use_region = TRUE;

            /* Check if we loaded this language before. */
            for (slang = first_lang; slang != NULL; slang = slang->sl_next)
                if (STRICMP(lang, slang->sl_name) == 0)
                    break;
        }

        if (region != NULL)
        {
            /* If the region differs from what was used before then don't
             * use it for 'spellfile'. */
            if (use_region != NULL && STRCMP(region, use_region) != 0)
                dont_use_region = TRUE;
            use_region = region;
        }

        /* If not found try loading the language now. */
        if (slang == NULL)
        {
            if (filename)
                (void)spell_load_file(lang, lang, NULL, FALSE);
            else
            {
                spell_load_lang(lang);
#ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
                /* SpellFileMissing autocommands may do anything, including
                 * destroying the buffer we are using... */
                if (!buf_valid(buf))
                {
                    ret_msg = (char_u *)"E797: SpellFileMissing autocommand deleted buffer";
                    goto theend;
                }
#endif
            }
        }

        /*
         * Loop over the languages, there can be several files for "lang".
         */
        for (slang = first_lang; slang != NULL; slang = slang->sl_next)
            if (filename ? fullpathcmp(lang, slang->sl_fname, FALSE) == FPC_SAME
                         : STRICMP(lang, slang->sl_name) == 0)
            {
                region_mask = REGION_ALL;
                if (!filename && region != NULL)
                {
                    /* find region in sl_regions */
                    c = find_region(slang->sl_regions, region);
                    if (c == REGION_ALL)
                    {
                        if (slang->sl_add)
                        {
                            if (*slang->sl_regions != NUL)
                                /* This addition file is for other regions. */
                                region_mask = 0;
                        }
                        else
                            /* This is probably an error.  Give a warning and
                             * accept the words anyway. */
                            smsg((char_u *)
                                    _("Warning: region %s not supported"),
                                                                      region);
                    }
                    else
                        region_mask = 1 << c;
                }

                if (region_mask != 0)
                {
                    if (ga_grow(&ga, 1) == FAIL)
                    {
                        ga_clear(&ga);
                        ret_msg = e_outofmem;
                        goto theend;
                    }
                    LANGP_ENTRY(ga, ga.ga_len)->lp_slang = slang;
                    LANGP_ENTRY(ga, ga.ga_len)->lp_region = region_mask;
                    ++ga.ga_len;
                    use_midword(slang, buf);
                    if (slang->sl_nobreak)
                        nobreak = TRUE;
                }
            }
    }

    /* round 0: load int_wordlist, if possible.
     * round 1: load first name in 'spellfile'.
     * round 2: load second name in 'spellfile.
     * etc. */
    spf = buf->b_p_spf;
    for (round = 0; round == 0 || *spf != NUL; ++round)
    {
        if (round == 0)
        {
            /* Internal wordlist, if there is one. */
            if (int_wordlist == NULL)
                continue;
            int_wordlist_spl(spf_name);
        }
        else
        {
            /* One entry in 'spellfile'. */
            copy_option_part(&spf, spf_name, MAXPATHL - 5, ",");
            STRCAT(spf_name, ".spl");

            /* If it was already found above then skip it. */
            for (c = 0; c < ga.ga_len; ++c)
            {
                p = LANGP_ENTRY(ga, c)->lp_slang->sl_fname;
                if (p != NULL && fullpathcmp(spf_name, p, FALSE) == FPC_SAME)
                    break;
            }
            if (c < ga.ga_len)
                continue;
        }

        /* Check if it was loaded already. */
        for (slang = first_lang; slang != NULL; slang = slang->sl_next)
            if (fullpathcmp(spf_name, slang->sl_fname, FALSE) == FPC_SAME)
                break;
        if (slang == NULL)
        {
            /* Not loaded, try loading it now.  The language name includes the
             * region name, the region is ignored otherwise.  for int_wordlist
             * use an arbitrary name. */
            if (round == 0)
                STRCPY(lang, "internal wordlist");
            else
            {
                vim_strncpy(lang, gettail(spf_name), MAXWLEN);
                p = vim_strchr(lang, '.');
                if (p != NULL)
                    *p = NUL;   /* truncate at ".encoding.add" */
            }
            slang = spell_load_file(spf_name, lang, NULL, TRUE);

            /* If one of the languages has NOBREAK we assume the addition
             * files also have this. */
            if (slang != NULL && nobreak)
                slang->sl_nobreak = TRUE;
        }
        if (slang != NULL && ga_grow(&ga, 1) == OK)
        {
            region_mask = REGION_ALL;
            if (use_region != NULL && !dont_use_region)
            {
                /* find region in sl_regions */
                c = find_region(slang->sl_regions, use_region);
                if (c != REGION_ALL)
                    region_mask = 1 << c;
                else if (*slang->sl_regions != NUL)
                    /* This spell file is for other regions. */
                    region_mask = 0;
            }

            if (region_mask != 0)
            {
                LANGP_ENTRY(ga, ga.ga_len)->lp_slang = slang;
                LANGP_ENTRY(ga, ga.ga_len)->lp_sallang = NULL;
                LANGP_ENTRY(ga, ga.ga_len)->lp_replang = NULL;
                LANGP_ENTRY(ga, ga.ga_len)->lp_region = region_mask;
                ++ga.ga_len;
                use_midword(slang, buf);
            }
        }
    }

    /* Everything is fine, store the new b_langp value. */
    ga_clear(&buf->b_langp);
    buf->b_langp = ga;

    /* For each language figure out what language to use for sound folding and
     * REP items.  If the language doesn't support it itself use another one
     * with the same name.  E.g. for "en-math" use "en". */
    for (i = 0; i < ga.ga_len; ++i)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(ga, i);

        /* sound folding */
        if (lp->lp_slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0)
            /* language does sound folding itself */
            lp->lp_sallang = lp->lp_slang;
        else
            /* find first similar language that does sound folding */
            for (j = 0; j < ga.ga_len; ++j)
            {
                lp2 = LANGP_ENTRY(ga, j);
                if (lp2->lp_slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0
                        && STRNCMP(lp->lp_slang->sl_name,
                                              lp2->lp_slang->sl_name, 2) == 0)
                {
                    lp->lp_sallang = lp2->lp_slang;
                    break;
                }
            }

        /* REP items */
        if (lp->lp_slang->sl_rep.ga_len > 0)
            /* language has REP items itself */
            lp->lp_replang = lp->lp_slang;
        else
            /* find first similar language that has REP items */
            for (j = 0; j < ga.ga_len; ++j)
            {
                lp2 = LANGP_ENTRY(ga, j);
                if (lp2->lp_slang->sl_rep.ga_len > 0
                        && STRNCMP(lp->lp_slang->sl_name,
                                              lp2->lp_slang->sl_name, 2) == 0)
                {
                    lp->lp_replang = lp2->lp_slang;
                    break;
                }
            }
    }

theend:
    vim_free(spl_copy);
    recursive = FALSE;
    return ret_msg;
}

/*
 * Clear the midword characters for buffer "buf".
 */
    static void
clear_midword(buf)
    buf_T       *buf;
{
    vim_memset(buf->b_spell_ismw, 0, 256);
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    vim_free(buf->b_spell_ismw_mb);
    buf->b_spell_ismw_mb = NULL;
#endif
}

/*
 * Use the "sl_midword" field of language "lp" for buffer "buf".
 * They add up to any currently used midword characters.
 */
    static void
use_midword(lp, buf)
    slang_T     *lp;
    buf_T       *buf;
{
    char_u      *p;

    if (lp->sl_midword == NULL)     /* there aren't any */
        return;

    for (p = lp->sl_midword; *p != NUL; )
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (has_mbyte)
        {
            int     c, l, n;
            char_u  *bp;

            c = mb_ptr2char(p);
            l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p);
            if (c < 256 && l <= 2)
                buf->b_spell_ismw[c] = TRUE;
            else if (buf->b_spell_ismw_mb == NULL)
                /* First multi-byte char in "b_spell_ismw_mb". */
                buf->b_spell_ismw_mb = vim_strnsave(p, l);
            else
            {
                /* Append multi-byte chars to "b_spell_ismw_mb". */
                n = (int)STRLEN(buf->b_spell_ismw_mb);
                bp = vim_strnsave(buf->b_spell_ismw_mb, n + l);
                if (bp != NULL)
                {
                    vim_free(buf->b_spell_ismw_mb);
                    buf->b_spell_ismw_mb = bp;
                    vim_strncpy(bp + n, p, l);
                }
            }
            p += l;
        }
        else
#endif
            buf->b_spell_ismw[*p++] = TRUE;
}

/*
 * Find the region "region[2]" in "rp" (points to "sl_regions").
 * Each region is simply stored as the two characters of it's name.
 * Returns the index if found (first is 0), REGION_ALL if not found.
 */
    static int
find_region(rp, region)
    char_u      *rp;
    char_u      *region;
{
    int         i;

    for (i = 0; ; i += 2)
    {
        if (rp[i] == NUL)
            return REGION_ALL;
        if (rp[i] == region[0] && rp[i + 1] == region[1])
            break;
    }
    return i / 2;
}

/*
 * Return case type of word:
 * w word       0
 * Word         WF_ONECAP
 * W WORD       WF_ALLCAP
 * WoRd wOrd    WF_KEEPCAP
 */
    static int
captype(word, end)
    char_u      *word;
    char_u      *end;       /* When NULL use up to NUL byte. */
{
    char_u      *p;
    int         c;
    int         firstcap;
    int         allcap;
    int         past_second = FALSE;    /* past second word char */

    /* find first letter */
    for (p = word; !spell_iswordp_nmw(p); mb_ptr_adv(p))
        if (end == NULL ? *p == NUL : p >= end)
            return 0;       /* only non-word characters, illegal word */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (has_mbyte)
        c = mb_ptr2char_adv(&p);
    else
#endif
        c = *p++;
    firstcap = allcap = SPELL_ISUPPER(c);

    /*
     * Need to check all letters to find a word with mixed upper/lower.
     * But a word with an upper char only at start is a ONECAP.
     */
    for ( ; end == NULL ? *p != NUL : p < end; mb_ptr_adv(p))
        if (spell_iswordp_nmw(p))
        {
            c = PTR2CHAR(p);
            if (!SPELL_ISUPPER(c))
            {
                /* UUl -> KEEPCAP */
                if (past_second && allcap)
                    return WF_KEEPCAP;
                allcap = FALSE;
            }
            else if (!allcap)
                /* UlU -> KEEPCAP */
                return WF_KEEPCAP;
            past_second = TRUE;
        }

    if (allcap)
        return WF_ALLCAP;
    if (firstcap)
        return WF_ONECAP;
    return 0;
}

/*
 * Like captype() but for a KEEPCAP word add ONECAP if the word starts with a
 * capital.  So that make_case_word() can turn WOrd into Word.
 * Add ALLCAP for "WOrD".
 */
    static int
badword_captype(word, end)
    char_u      *word;
    char_u      *end;
{
    int         flags = captype(word, end);
    int         c;
    int         l, u;
    int         first;
    char_u      *p;

    if (flags & WF_KEEPCAP)
    {
        /* Count the number of UPPER and lower case letters. */
        l = u = 0;
        first = FALSE;
        for (p = word; p < end; mb_ptr_adv(p))
        {
            c = PTR2CHAR(p);
            if (SPELL_ISUPPER(c))
            {
                ++u;
                if (p == word)
                    first = TRUE;
            }
            else
                ++l;
        }

        /* If there are more UPPER than lower case letters suggest an
         * ALLCAP word.  Otherwise, if the first letter is UPPER then
         * suggest ONECAP.  Exception: "ALl" most likely should be "All",
         * require three upper case letters. */
        if (u > l && u > 2)
            flags |= WF_ALLCAP;
        else if (first)
            flags |= WF_ONECAP;

        if (u >= 2 && l >= 2)   /* maCARONI maCAroni */
            flags |= WF_MIXCAP;
    }
    return flags;
}

# if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(EXITFREE) || defined(PROTO)
/*
 * Free all languages.
 */
    void
spell_free_all()
{
    slang_T     *slang;
    buf_T       *buf;
    char_u      fname[MAXPATHL];

    /* Go through all buffers and handle 'spelllang'. */
    for (buf = firstbuf; buf != NULL; buf = buf->b_next)
        ga_clear(&buf->b_langp);

    while (first_lang != NULL)
    {
        slang = first_lang;
        first_lang = slang->sl_next;
        slang_free(slang);
    }

    if (int_wordlist != NULL)
    {
        /* Delete the internal wordlist and its .spl file */
        mch_remove(int_wordlist);
        int_wordlist_spl(fname);
        mch_remove(fname);
        vim_free(int_wordlist);
        int_wordlist = NULL;
    }

    init_spell_chartab();

    vim_free(repl_to);
    repl_to = NULL;
    vim_free(repl_from);
    repl_from = NULL;
}
# endif

# if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO)
/*
 * Clear all spelling tables and reload them.
 * Used after 'encoding' is set and when ":mkspell" was used.
 */
    void
spell_reload()
{
    buf_T       *buf;
    win_T       *wp;

    /* Initialize the table for spell_iswordp(). */
    init_spell_chartab();

    /* Unload all allocated memory. */
    spell_free_all();

    /* Go through all buffers and handle 'spelllang'. */
    for (buf = firstbuf; buf != NULL; buf = buf->b_next)
    {
        /* Only load the wordlists when 'spelllang' is set and there is a
         * window for this buffer in which 'spell' is set. */
        if (*buf->b_p_spl != NUL)
        {
            FOR_ALL_WINDOWS(wp)
                if (wp->w_buffer == buf && wp->w_p_spell)
                {
                    (void)did_set_spelllang(buf);
# ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS
                    break;
# endif
                }
        }
    }
}
# endif

/*
 * Reload the spell file "fname" if it's loaded.
 */
    static void
spell_reload_one(fname, added_word)
    char_u      *fname;
    int         added_word;     /* invoked through "zg" */
{
    slang_T     *slang;
    int         didit = FALSE;

    for (slang = first_lang; slang != NULL; slang = slang->sl_next)
    {
        if (fullpathcmp(fname, slang->sl_fname, FALSE) == FPC_SAME)
        {
            slang_clear(slang);
            if (spell_load_file(fname, NULL, slang, FALSE) == NULL)
                /* reloading failed, clear the language */
                slang_clear(slang);
            redraw_all_later(SOME_VALID);
            didit = TRUE;
        }
    }

    /* When "zg" was used and the file wasn't loaded yet, should redo
     * 'spelllang' to load it now. */
    if (added_word && !didit)
        did_set_spelllang(curbuf);
}


/*
 * Functions for ":mkspell".
 */

#define MAXLINELEN  500         /* Maximum length in bytes of a line in a .aff
                                   and .dic file. */
/*
 * Main structure to store the contents of a ".aff" file.
 */
typedef struct afffile_S
{
    char_u      *af_enc;        /* "SET", normalized, alloc'ed string or NULL */
    int         af_flagtype;    /* AFT_CHAR, AFT_LONG, AFT_NUM or AFT_CAPLONG */
    unsigned    af_rare;        /* RARE ID for rare word */
    unsigned    af_keepcase;    /* KEEPCASE ID for keep-case word */
    unsigned    af_bad;         /* BAD ID for banned word */
    unsigned    af_needaffix;   /* NEEDAFFIX ID */
    unsigned    af_circumfix;   /* CIRCUMFIX ID */
    unsigned    af_needcomp;    /* NEEDCOMPOUND ID */
    unsigned    af_comproot;    /* COMPOUNDROOT ID */
    unsigned    af_compforbid;  /* COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG ID */
    unsigned    af_comppermit;  /* COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG ID */
    unsigned    af_nosuggest;   /* NOSUGGEST ID */
    int         af_pfxpostpone; /* postpone prefixes without chop string and
                                   without flags */
    hashtab_T   af_pref;        /* hashtable for prefixes, affheader_T */
    hashtab_T   af_suff;        /* hashtable for suffixes, affheader_T */
    hashtab_T   af_comp;        /* hashtable for compound flags, compitem_T */
} afffile_T;

#define AFT_CHAR        0        /* flags are one character */
#define AFT_LONG        1       /* flags are two characters */
#define AFT_CAPLONG     2       /* flags are one or two characters */
#define AFT_NUM         3       /* flags are numbers, comma separated */

typedef struct affentry_S affentry_T;
/* Affix entry from ".aff" file.  Used for prefixes and suffixes. */
struct affentry_S
{
    affentry_T  *ae_next;       /* next affix with same name/number */
    char_u      *ae_chop;       /* text to chop off basic word (can be NULL) */
    char_u      *ae_add;        /* text to add to basic word (can be NULL) */
    char_u      *ae_flags;      /* flags on the affix (can be NULL) */
    char_u      *ae_cond;       /* condition (NULL for ".") */
    regprog_T   *ae_prog;       /* regexp program for ae_cond or NULL */
    char        ae_compforbid;  /* COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG found */
    char        ae_comppermit;  /* COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG found */
};

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
# define AH_KEY_LEN 17          /* 2 x 8 bytes + NUL */
#else
# define AH_KEY_LEN 7           /* 6 digits + NUL */
#endif

/* Affix header from ".aff" file.  Used for af_pref and af_suff. */
typedef struct affheader_S
{
    char_u      ah_key[AH_KEY_LEN]; /* key for hashtab == name of affix */
    unsigned    ah_flag;        /* affix name as number, uses "af_flagtype" */
    int         ah_newID;       /* prefix ID after renumbering; 0 if not used */
    int         ah_combine;     /* suffix may combine with prefix */
    int         ah_follows;     /* another affix block should be following */
    affentry_T  *ah_first;      /* first affix entry */
} affheader_T;

#define HI2AH(hi)   ((affheader_T *)(hi)->hi_key)

/* Flag used in compound items. */
typedef struct compitem_S
{
    char_u      ci_key[AH_KEY_LEN]; /* key for hashtab == name of compound */
    unsigned    ci_flag;        /* affix name as number, uses "af_flagtype" */
    int         ci_newID;       /* affix ID after renumbering. */
} compitem_T;

#define HI2CI(hi)   ((compitem_T *)(hi)->hi_key)

/*
 * Structure that is used to store the items in the word tree.  This avoids
 * the need to keep track of each allocated thing, everything is freed all at
 * once after ":mkspell" is done.
 */
#define  SBLOCKSIZE 16000       /* size of sb_data */
typedef struct sblock_S sblock_T;
struct sblock_S
{
    sblock_T    *sb_next;       /* next block in list */
    int         sb_used;        /* nr of bytes already in use */
    char_u      sb_data[1];     /* data, actually longer */
};

/*
 * A node in the tree.
 */
typedef struct wordnode_S wordnode_T;
struct wordnode_S
{
    union   /* shared to save space */
    {
        char_u  hashkey[6];     /* the hash key, only used while compressing */
        int     index;          /* index in written nodes (valid after first
                                   round) */
    } wn_u1;
    union   /* shared to save space */
    {
        wordnode_T *next;       /* next node with same hash key */
        wordnode_T *wnode;      /* parent node that will write this node */
    } wn_u2;
    wordnode_T  *wn_child;      /* child (next byte in word) */
    wordnode_T  *wn_sibling;    /* next sibling (alternate byte in word,
                                   always sorted) */
    int         wn_refs;        /* Nr. of references to this node.  Only
                                   relevant for first node in a list of
                                   siblings, in following siblings it is
                                   always one. */
    char_u      wn_byte;        /* Byte for this node. NUL for word end */

    /* Info for when "wn_byte" is NUL.
     * In PREFIXTREE "wn_region" is used for the prefcondnr.
     * In the soundfolded word tree "wn_flags" has the MSW of the wordnr and
     * "wn_region" the LSW of the wordnr. */
    char_u      wn_affixID;     /* supported/required prefix ID or 0 */
    short_u     wn_flags;       /* WF_ flags */
    short       wn_region;      /* region mask */

#ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
    int         wn_nr;          /* sequence nr for printing */
#endif
};

#define WN_MASK  0xffff         /* mask relevant bits of "wn_flags" */

#define HI2WN(hi)    (wordnode_T *)((hi)->hi_key)

/*
 * Info used while reading the spell files.
 */
typedef struct spellinfo_S
{
    wordnode_T  *si_foldroot;   /* tree with case-folded words */
    long        si_foldwcount;  /* nr of words in si_foldroot */

    wordnode_T  *si_keeproot;   /* tree with keep-case words */
    long        si_keepwcount;  /* nr of words in si_keeproot */

    wordnode_T  *si_prefroot;   /* tree with postponed prefixes */

    long        si_sugtree;     /* creating the soundfolding trie */

    sblock_T    *si_blocks;     /* memory blocks used */
    long        si_blocks_cnt;  /* memory blocks allocated */
    long        si_compress_cnt;    /* words to add before lowering
                                       compression limit */
    wordnode_T  *si_first_free; /* List of nodes that have been freed during
                                   compression, linked by "wn_child" field. */
    long        si_free_count;  /* number of nodes in si_first_free */
#ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
    int         si_wordnode_nr; /* sequence nr for nodes */
#endif
    buf_T       *si_spellbuf;   /* buffer used to store soundfold word table */

    int         si_ascii;       /* handling only ASCII words */
    int         si_add;         /* addition file */
    int         si_clear_chartab;   /* when TRUE clear char tables */
    int         si_region;      /* region mask */
    vimconv_T   si_conv;        /* for conversion to 'encoding' */
    int         si_memtot;      /* runtime memory used */
    int         si_verbose;     /* verbose messages */
    int         si_msg_count;   /* number of words added since last message */
    char_u      *si_info;       /* info text chars or NULL  */
    int         si_region_count; /* number of regions supported (1 when there
                                    are no regions) */
    char_u      si_region_name[16]; /* region names; used only if
                                     * si_region_count > 1) */

    garray_T    si_rep;         /* list of fromto_T entries from REP lines */
    garray_T    si_repsal;      /* list of fromto_T entries from REPSAL lines */
    garray_T    si_sal;         /* list of fromto_T entries from SAL lines */
    char_u      *si_sofofr;     /* SOFOFROM text */
    char_u      *si_sofoto;     /* SOFOTO text */
    int         si_nosugfile;   /* NOSUGFILE item found */
    int         si_nosplitsugs; /* NOSPLITSUGS item found */
    int         si_followup;    /* soundsalike: ? */
    int         si_collapse;    /* soundsalike: ? */
    hashtab_T   si_commonwords; /* hashtable for common words */
    time_t      si_sugtime;     /* timestamp for .sug file */
    int         si_rem_accents; /* soundsalike: remove accents */
    garray_T    si_map;         /* MAP info concatenated */
    char_u      *si_midword;    /* MIDWORD chars or NULL  */
    int         si_compmax;     /* max nr of words for compounding */
    int         si_compminlen;  /* minimal length for compounding */
    int         si_compsylmax;  /* max nr of syllables for compounding */
    int         si_compoptions; /* COMP_ flags */
    garray_T    si_comppat;     /* CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN items, each stored as
                                   a string */
    char_u      *si_compflags;  /* flags used for compounding */
    char_u      si_nobreak;     /* NOBREAK */
    char_u      *si_syllable;   /* syllable string */
    garray_T    si_prefcond;    /* table with conditions for postponed
                                 * prefixes, each stored as a string */
    int         si_newprefID;   /* current value for ah_newID */
    int         si_newcompID;   /* current value for compound ID */
} spellinfo_T;

static afffile_T *spell_read_aff __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *fname));
static void aff_process_flags __ARGS((afffile_T *affile, affentry_T *entry));
static int spell_info_item __ARGS((char_u *s));
static unsigned affitem2flag __ARGS((int flagtype, char_u *item, char_u *fname, int lnum));
static unsigned get_affitem __ARGS((int flagtype, char_u **pp));
static void process_compflags __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, afffile_T *aff, char_u *compflags));
static void check_renumber __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin));
static int flag_in_afflist __ARGS((int flagtype, char_u *afflist, unsigned flag));
static void aff_check_number __ARGS((int spinval, int affval, char *name));
static void aff_check_string __ARGS((char_u *spinval, char_u *affval, char *name));
static int str_equal __ARGS((char_u *s1, char_u *s2));
static void add_fromto __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, garray_T *gap, char_u *from, char_u *to));
static int sal_to_bool __ARGS((char_u *s));
static int has_non_ascii __ARGS((char_u *s));
static void spell_free_aff __ARGS((afffile_T *aff));
static int spell_read_dic __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *fname, afffile_T *affile));
static int get_affix_flags __ARGS((afffile_T *affile, char_u *afflist));
static int get_pfxlist __ARGS((afffile_T *affile, char_u *afflist, char_u *store_afflist));
static void get_compflags __ARGS((afffile_T *affile, char_u *afflist, char_u *store_afflist));
static int store_aff_word __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *word, char_u *afflist, afffile_T *affile, hashtab_T *ht, hashtab_T *xht, int condit, int flags, char_u *pfxlist, int pfxlen));
static int spell_read_wordfile __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *fname));
static void *getroom __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, size_t len, int align));
static char_u *getroom_save __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *s));
static void free_blocks __ARGS((sblock_T *bl));
static wordnode_T *wordtree_alloc __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin));
static int store_word __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *word, int flags, int region, char_u *pfxlist, int need_affix));
static int tree_add_word __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *word, wordnode_T *tree, int flags, int region, int affixID));
static wordnode_T *get_wordnode __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin));
static int deref_wordnode __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, wordnode_T *node));
static void free_wordnode __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, wordnode_T *n));
static void wordtree_compress __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, wordnode_T *root));
static int node_compress __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, wordnode_T *node, hashtab_T *ht, int *tot));
static int node_equal __ARGS((wordnode_T *n1, wordnode_T *n2));
static void put_sugtime __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, FILE *fd));
static int write_vim_spell __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *fname));
static void clear_node __ARGS((wordnode_T *node));
static int put_node __ARGS((FILE *fd, wordnode_T *node, int index, int regionmask, int prefixtree));
static void spell_make_sugfile __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *wfname));
static int sug_filltree __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, slang_T *slang));
static int sug_maketable __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin));
static int sug_filltable __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, wordnode_T *node, int startwordnr, garray_T *gap));
static int offset2bytes __ARGS((int nr, char_u *buf));
static int bytes2offset __ARGS((char_u **pp));
static void sug_write __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *fname));
static void mkspell __ARGS((int fcount, char_u **fnames, int ascii, int overwrite, int added_word));
static void spell_message __ARGS((spellinfo_T *spin, char_u *str));
static void init_spellfile __ARGS((void));

/* In the postponed prefixes tree wn_flags is used to store the WFP_ flags,
 * but it must be negative to indicate the prefix tree to tree_add_word().
 * Use a negative number with the lower 8 bits zero. */
#define PFX_FLAGS       -256

/* flags for "condit" argument of store_aff_word() */
#define CONDIT_COMB     1       /* affix must combine */
#define CONDIT_CFIX     2       /* affix must have CIRCUMFIX flag */
#define CONDIT_SUF      4       /* add a suffix for matching flags */
#define CONDIT_AFF      8       /* word already has an affix */

/*
 * Tunable parameters for when the tree is compressed.  See 'mkspellmem'.
 */
static long compress_start = 30000;     /* memory / SBLOCKSIZE */
static long compress_inc = 100;         /* memory / SBLOCKSIZE */
static long compress_added = 500000;    /* word count */

#ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
/*
 * For debugging the tree code: print the current tree in a (more or less)
 * readable format, so that we can see what happens when adding a word and/or
 * compressing the tree.
 * Based on code from Olaf Seibert.
 */
#define PRINTLINESIZE   1000
#define PRINTWIDTH      6

#define PRINTSOME(l, depth, fmt, a1, a2) vim_snprintf(l + depth * PRINTWIDTH, \
            PRINTLINESIZE - PRINTWIDTH * depth, fmt, a1, a2)

static char line1[PRINTLINESIZE];
static char line2[PRINTLINESIZE];
static char line3[PRINTLINESIZE];

    static void
spell_clear_flags(wordnode_T *node)
{
    wordnode_T  *np;

    for (np = node; np != NULL; np = np->wn_sibling)
    {
        np->wn_u1.index = FALSE;
        spell_clear_flags(np->wn_child);
    }
}

    static void
spell_print_node(wordnode_T *node, int depth)
{
    if (node->wn_u1.index)
    {
        /* Done this node before, print the reference. */
        PRINTSOME(line1, depth, "(%d)", node->wn_nr, 0);
        PRINTSOME(line2, depth, "    ", 0, 0);
        PRINTSOME(line3, depth, "    ", 0, 0);
        msg(line1);
        msg(line2);
        msg(line3);
    }
    else
    {
        node->wn_u1.index = TRUE;

        if (node->wn_byte != NUL)
        {
            if (node->wn_child != NULL)
                PRINTSOME(line1, depth, " %c -> ", node->wn_byte, 0);
            else
                /* Cannot happen? */
                PRINTSOME(line1, depth, " %c ???", node->wn_byte, 0);
        }
        else
            PRINTSOME(line1, depth, " $    ", 0, 0);

        PRINTSOME(line2, depth, "%d/%d    ", node->wn_nr, node->wn_refs);

        if (node->wn_sibling != NULL)
            PRINTSOME(line3, depth, " |    ", 0, 0);
        else
            PRINTSOME(line3, depth, "      ", 0, 0);

        if (node->wn_byte == NUL)
        {
            msg(line1);
            msg(line2);
            msg(line3);
        }

        /* do the children */
        if (node->wn_byte != NUL && node->wn_child != NULL)
            spell_print_node(node->wn_child, depth + 1);

        /* do the siblings */
        if (node->wn_sibling != NULL)
        {
            /* get rid of all parent details except | */
            STRCPY(line1, line3);
            STRCPY(line2, line3);
            spell_print_node(node->wn_sibling, depth);
        }
    }
}

    static void
spell_print_tree(wordnode_T *root)
{
    if (root != NULL)
    {
        /* Clear the "wn_u1.index" fields, used to remember what has been
         * done. */
        spell_clear_flags(root);

        /* Recursively print the tree. */
        spell_print_node(root, 0);
    }
}
#endif /* SPELL_PRINTTREE */

/*
 * Read the affix file "fname".
 * Returns an afffile_T, NULL for complete failure.
 */
    static afffile_T *
spell_read_aff(spin, fname)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *fname;
{
    FILE        *fd;
    afffile_T   *aff;
    char_u      rline[MAXLINELEN];
    char_u      *line;
    char_u      *pc = NULL;
#define MAXITEMCNT  30
    char_u      *(items[MAXITEMCNT]);
    int         itemcnt;
    char_u      *p;
    int         lnum = 0;
    affheader_T *cur_aff = NULL;
    int         did_postpone_prefix = FALSE;
    int         aff_todo = 0;
    hashtab_T   *tp;
    char_u      *low = NULL;
    char_u      *fol = NULL;
    char_u      *upp = NULL;
    int         do_rep;
    int         do_repsal;
    int         do_sal;
    int         do_mapline;
    int         found_map = FALSE;
    hashitem_T  *hi;
    int         l;
    int         compminlen = 0;         /* COMPOUNDMIN value */
    int         compsylmax = 0;         /* COMPOUNDSYLMAX value */
    int         compoptions = 0;        /* COMP_ flags */
    int         compmax = 0;            /* COMPOUNDWORDMAX value */
    char_u      *compflags = NULL;      /* COMPOUNDFLAG and COMPOUNDRULE
                                           concatenated */
    char_u      *midword = NULL;        /* MIDWORD value */
    char_u      *syllable = NULL;       /* SYLLABLE value */
    char_u      *sofofrom = NULL;       /* SOFOFROM value */
    char_u      *sofoto = NULL;         /* SOFOTO value */

    /*
     * Open the file.
     */
    fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "r");
    if (fd == NULL)
    {
        EMSG2(_(e_notopen), fname);
        return NULL;
    }

    vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, _("Reading affix file %s ..."), fname);
    spell_message(spin, IObuff);

    /* Only do REP lines when not done in another .aff file already. */
    do_rep = spin->si_rep.ga_len == 0;

    /* Only do REPSAL lines when not done in another .aff file already. */
    do_repsal = spin->si_repsal.ga_len == 0;

    /* Only do SAL lines when not done in another .aff file already. */
    do_sal = spin->si_sal.ga_len == 0;

    /* Only do MAP lines when not done in another .aff file already. */
    do_mapline = spin->si_map.ga_len == 0;

    /*
     * Allocate and init the afffile_T structure.
     */
    aff = (afffile_T *)getroom(spin, sizeof(afffile_T), TRUE);
    if (aff == NULL)
    {
        fclose(fd);
        return NULL;
    }
    hash_init(&aff->af_pref);
    hash_init(&aff->af_suff);
    hash_init(&aff->af_comp);

    /*
     * Read all the lines in the file one by one.
     */
    while (!vim_fgets(rline, MAXLINELEN, fd) && !got_int)
    {
        line_breakcheck();
        ++lnum;

        /* Skip comment lines. */
        if (*rline == '#')
            continue;

        /* Convert from "SET" to 'encoding' when needed. */
        vim_free(pc);
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (spin->si_conv.vc_type != CONV_NONE)
        {
            pc = string_convert(&spin->si_conv, rline, NULL);
            if (pc == NULL)
            {
                smsg((char_u *)_("Conversion failure for word in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                           fname, lnum, rline);
                continue;
            }
            line = pc;
        }
        else
#endif
        {
            pc = NULL;
            line = rline;
        }

        /* Split the line up in white separated items.  Put a NUL after each
         * item. */
        itemcnt = 0;
        for (p = line; ; )
        {
            while (*p != NUL && *p <= ' ')  /* skip white space and CR/NL */
                ++p;
            if (*p == NUL)
                break;
            if (itemcnt == MAXITEMCNT)      /* too many items */
                break;
            items[itemcnt++] = p;
            /* A few items have arbitrary text argument, don't split them. */
            if (itemcnt == 2 && spell_info_item(items[0]))
                while (*p >= ' ' || *p == TAB)    /* skip until CR/NL */
                    ++p;
            else
                while (*p > ' ')    /* skip until white space or CR/NL */
                    ++p;
            if (*p == NUL)
                break;
            *p++ = NUL;
        }

        /* Handle non-empty lines. */
        if (itemcnt > 0)
        {
            if (STRCMP(items[0], "SET") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                       && aff->af_enc == NULL)
            {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                /* Setup for conversion from "ENC" to 'encoding'. */
                aff->af_enc = enc_canonize(items[1]);
                if (aff->af_enc != NULL && !spin->si_ascii
                        && convert_setup(&spin->si_conv, aff->af_enc,
                                                               p_enc) == FAIL)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Conversion in %s not supported: from %s to %s"),
                                               fname, aff->af_enc, p_enc);
                spin->si_conv.vc_fail = TRUE;
#else
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Conversion in %s not supported"), fname);
#endif
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "FLAG") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                              && aff->af_flagtype == AFT_CHAR)
            {
                if (STRCMP(items[1], "long") == 0)
                    aff->af_flagtype = AFT_LONG;
                else if (STRCMP(items[1], "num") == 0)
                    aff->af_flagtype = AFT_NUM;
                else if (STRCMP(items[1], "caplong") == 0)
                    aff->af_flagtype = AFT_CAPLONG;
                else
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Invalid value for FLAG in %s line %d: %s"),
                            fname, lnum, items[1]);
                if (aff->af_rare != 0
                        || aff->af_keepcase != 0
                        || aff->af_bad != 0
                        || aff->af_needaffix != 0
                        || aff->af_circumfix != 0
                        || aff->af_needcomp != 0
                        || aff->af_comproot != 0
                        || aff->af_nosuggest != 0
                        || compflags != NULL
                        || aff->af_suff.ht_used > 0
                        || aff->af_pref.ht_used > 0)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("FLAG after using flags in %s line %d: %s"),
                            fname, lnum, items[1]);
            }
            else if (spell_info_item(items[0]))
            {
                    p = (char_u *)getroom(spin,
                            (spin->si_info == NULL ? 0 : STRLEN(spin->si_info))
                            + STRLEN(items[0])
                            + STRLEN(items[1]) + 3, FALSE);
                    if (p != NULL)
                    {
                        if (spin->si_info != NULL)
                        {
                            STRCPY(p, spin->si_info);
                            STRCAT(p, "\n");
                        }
                        STRCAT(p, items[0]);
                        STRCAT(p, " ");
                        STRCAT(p, items[1]);
                        spin->si_info = p;
                    }
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "MIDWORD") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                           && midword == NULL)
            {
                midword = getroom_save(spin, items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "TRY") == 0 && itemcnt == 2)
            {
                /* ignored, we look in the tree for what chars may appear */
            }
            /* TODO: remove "RAR" later */
            else if ((STRCMP(items[0], "RAR") == 0
                        || STRCMP(items[0], "RARE") == 0) && itemcnt == 2
                                                       && aff->af_rare == 0)
            {
                aff->af_rare = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            /* TODO: remove "KEP" later */
            else if ((STRCMP(items[0], "KEP") == 0
                    || STRCMP(items[0], "KEEPCASE") == 0) && itemcnt == 2
                                                     && aff->af_keepcase == 0)
            {
                aff->af_keepcase = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "BAD") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                       && aff->af_bad == 0)
            {
                aff->af_bad = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "NEEDAFFIX") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                    && aff->af_needaffix == 0)
            {
                aff->af_needaffix = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "CIRCUMFIX") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                    && aff->af_circumfix == 0)
            {
                aff->af_circumfix = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "NOSUGGEST") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                    && aff->af_nosuggest == 0)
            {
                aff->af_nosuggest = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "NEEDCOMPOUND") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                     && aff->af_needcomp == 0)
            {
                aff->af_needcomp = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMPOUNDROOT") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                     && aff->af_comproot == 0)
            {
                aff->af_comproot = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG") == 0
                                   && itemcnt == 2 && aff->af_compforbid == 0)
            {
                aff->af_compforbid = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
                if (aff->af_pref.ht_used > 0)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Defining COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG after PFX item may give wrong results in %s line %d"),
                            fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG") == 0
                                   && itemcnt == 2 && aff->af_comppermit == 0)
            {
                aff->af_comppermit = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
                if (aff->af_pref.ht_used > 0)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Defining COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG after PFX item may give wrong results in %s line %d"),
                            fname, lnum);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMPOUNDFLAG") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                         && compflags == NULL)
            {
                /* Turn flag "c" into COMPOUNDRULE compatible string "c+",
                 * "Na" into "Na+", "1234" into "1234+". */
                p = getroom(spin, STRLEN(items[1]) + 2, FALSE);
                if (p != NULL)
                {
                    STRCPY(p, items[1]);
                    STRCAT(p, "+");
                    compflags = p;
                }
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMPOUNDRULE") == 0 && itemcnt == 2)
            {
                /* Concatenate this string to previously defined ones, using a
                 * slash to separate them. */
                l = (int)STRLEN(items[1]) + 1;
                if (compflags != NULL)
                    l += (int)STRLEN(compflags) + 1;
                p = getroom(spin, l, FALSE);
                if (p != NULL)
                {
                    if (compflags != NULL)
                    {
                        STRCPY(p, compflags);
                        STRCAT(p, "/");
                    }
                    STRCAT(p, items[1]);
                    compflags = p;
                }
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMPOUNDWORDMAX") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                              && compmax == 0)
            {
                compmax = atoi((char *)items[1]);
                if (compmax == 0)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Wrong COMPOUNDWORDMAX value in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMPOUNDMIN") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                           && compminlen == 0)
            {
                compminlen = atoi((char *)items[1]);
                if (compminlen == 0)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Wrong COMPOUNDMIN value in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMPOUNDSYLMAX") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                           && compsylmax == 0)
            {
                compsylmax = atoi((char *)items[1]);
                if (compsylmax == 0)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Wrong COMPOUNDSYLMAX value in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDDUP") == 0 && itemcnt == 1)
            {
                compoptions |= COMP_CHECKDUP;
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDREP") == 0 && itemcnt == 1)
            {
                compoptions |= COMP_CHECKREP;
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDCASE") == 0 && itemcnt == 1)
            {
                compoptions |= COMP_CHECKCASE;
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDTRIPLE") == 0
                                                              && itemcnt == 1)
            {
                compoptions |= COMP_CHECKTRIPLE;
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN") == 0
                                                              && itemcnt == 2)
            {
                if (atoi((char *)items[1]) == 0)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Wrong CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN value in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN") == 0
                                                              && itemcnt == 3)
            {
                garray_T    *gap = &spin->si_comppat;
                int         i;

                /* Only add the couple if it isn't already there. */
                for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len - 1; i += 2)
                    if (STRCMP(((char_u **)(gap->ga_data))[i], items[1]) == 0
                            && STRCMP(((char_u **)(gap->ga_data))[i + 1],
                                                               items[2]) == 0)
                        break;
                if (i >= gap->ga_len && ga_grow(gap, 2) == OK)
                {
                    ((char_u **)(gap->ga_data))[gap->ga_len++]
                                               = getroom_save(spin, items[1]);
                    ((char_u **)(gap->ga_data))[gap->ga_len++]
                                               = getroom_save(spin, items[2]);
                }
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "SYLLABLE") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                          && syllable == NULL)
            {
                syllable = getroom_save(spin, items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "NOBREAK") == 0 && itemcnt == 1)
            {
                spin->si_nobreak = TRUE;
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "NOSPLITSUGS") == 0 && itemcnt == 1)
            {
                spin->si_nosplitsugs = TRUE;
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "NOSUGFILE") == 0 && itemcnt == 1)
            {
                spin->si_nosugfile = TRUE;
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "PFXPOSTPONE") == 0 && itemcnt == 1)
            {
                aff->af_pfxpostpone = TRUE;
            }
            else if ((STRCMP(items[0], "PFX") == 0
                                              || STRCMP(items[0], "SFX") == 0)
                    && aff_todo == 0
                    && itemcnt >= 4)
            {
                int     lasti = 4;
                char_u  key[AH_KEY_LEN];

                if (*items[0] == 'P')
                    tp = &aff->af_pref;
                else
                    tp = &aff->af_suff;

                /* Myspell allows the same affix name to be used multiple
                 * times.  The affix files that do this have an undocumented
                 * "S" flag on all but the last block, thus we check for that
                 * and store it in ah_follows. */
                vim_strncpy(key, items[1], AH_KEY_LEN - 1);
                hi = hash_find(tp, key);
                if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
                {
                    cur_aff = HI2AH(hi);
                    if (cur_aff->ah_combine != (*items[2] == 'Y'))
                        smsg((char_u *)_("Different combining flag in continued affix block in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                   fname, lnum, items[1]);
                    if (!cur_aff->ah_follows)
                        smsg((char_u *)_("Duplicate affix in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[1]);
                }
                else
                {
                    /* New affix letter. */
                    cur_aff = (affheader_T *)getroom(spin,
                                                   sizeof(affheader_T), TRUE);
                    if (cur_aff == NULL)
                        break;
                    cur_aff->ah_flag = affitem2flag(aff->af_flagtype, items[1],
                                                                 fname, lnum);
                    if (cur_aff->ah_flag == 0 || STRLEN(items[1]) >= AH_KEY_LEN)
                        break;
                    if (cur_aff->ah_flag == aff->af_bad
                            || cur_aff->ah_flag == aff->af_rare
                            || cur_aff->ah_flag == aff->af_keepcase
                            || cur_aff->ah_flag == aff->af_needaffix
                            || cur_aff->ah_flag == aff->af_circumfix
                            || cur_aff->ah_flag == aff->af_nosuggest
                            || cur_aff->ah_flag == aff->af_needcomp
                            || cur_aff->ah_flag == aff->af_comproot)
                        smsg((char_u *)_("Affix also used for BAD/RARE/KEEPCASE/NEEDAFFIX/NEEDCOMPOUND/NOSUGGEST in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[1]);
                    STRCPY(cur_aff->ah_key, items[1]);
                    hash_add(tp, cur_aff->ah_key);

                    cur_aff->ah_combine = (*items[2] == 'Y');
                }

                /* Check for the "S" flag, which apparently means that another
                 * block with the same affix name is following. */
                if (itemcnt > lasti && STRCMP(items[lasti], "S") == 0)
                {
                    ++lasti;
                    cur_aff->ah_follows = TRUE;
                }
                else
                    cur_aff->ah_follows = FALSE;

                /* Myspell allows extra text after the item, but that might
                 * mean mistakes go unnoticed.  Require a comment-starter. */
                if (itemcnt > lasti && *items[lasti] != '#')
                    smsg((char_u *)_(e_afftrailing), fname, lnum, items[lasti]);

                if (STRCMP(items[2], "Y") != 0 && STRCMP(items[2], "N") != 0)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Expected Y or N in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[2]);

                if (*items[0] == 'P' && aff->af_pfxpostpone)
                {
                    if (cur_aff->ah_newID == 0)
                    {
                        /* Use a new number in the .spl file later, to be able
                         * to handle multiple .aff files. */
                        check_renumber(spin);
                        cur_aff->ah_newID = ++spin->si_newprefID;

                        /* We only really use ah_newID if the prefix is
                         * postponed.  We know that only after handling all
                         * the items. */
                        did_postpone_prefix = FALSE;
                    }
                    else
                        /* Did use the ID in a previous block. */
                        did_postpone_prefix = TRUE;
                }

                aff_todo = atoi((char *)items[3]);
            }
            else if ((STRCMP(items[0], "PFX") == 0
                                              || STRCMP(items[0], "SFX") == 0)
                    && aff_todo > 0
                    && STRCMP(cur_aff->ah_key, items[1]) == 0
                    && itemcnt >= 5)
            {
                affentry_T      *aff_entry;
                int             upper = FALSE;
                int             lasti = 5;

                /* Myspell allows extra text after the item, but that might
                 * mean mistakes go unnoticed.  Require a comment-starter.
                 * Hunspell uses a "-" item. */
                if (itemcnt > lasti && *items[lasti] != '#'
                        && (STRCMP(items[lasti], "-") != 0
                                                     || itemcnt != lasti + 1))
                    smsg((char_u *)_(e_afftrailing), fname, lnum, items[lasti]);

                /* New item for an affix letter. */
                --aff_todo;
                aff_entry = (affentry_T *)getroom(spin,
                                                    sizeof(affentry_T), TRUE);
                if (aff_entry == NULL)
                    break;

                if (STRCMP(items[2], "0") != 0)
                    aff_entry->ae_chop = getroom_save(spin, items[2]);
                if (STRCMP(items[3], "0") != 0)
                {
                    aff_entry->ae_add = getroom_save(spin, items[3]);

                    /* Recognize flags on the affix: abcd/XYZ */
                    aff_entry->ae_flags = vim_strchr(aff_entry->ae_add, '/');
                    if (aff_entry->ae_flags != NULL)
                    {
                        *aff_entry->ae_flags++ = NUL;
                        aff_process_flags(aff, aff_entry);
                    }
                }

                /* Don't use an affix entry with non-ASCII characters when
                 * "spin->si_ascii" is TRUE. */
                if (!spin->si_ascii || !(has_non_ascii(aff_entry->ae_chop)
                                          || has_non_ascii(aff_entry->ae_add)))
                {
                    aff_entry->ae_next = cur_aff->ah_first;
                    cur_aff->ah_first = aff_entry;

                    if (STRCMP(items[4], ".") != 0)
                    {
                        char_u  buf[MAXLINELEN];

                        aff_entry->ae_cond = getroom_save(spin, items[4]);
                        if (*items[0] == 'P')
                            sprintf((char *)buf, "^%s", items[4]);
                        else
                            sprintf((char *)buf, "%s$", items[4]);
                        aff_entry->ae_prog = vim_regcomp(buf,
                                            RE_MAGIC + RE_STRING + RE_STRICT);
                        if (aff_entry->ae_prog == NULL)
                            smsg((char_u *)_("Broken condition in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[4]);
                    }

                    /* For postponed prefixes we need an entry in si_prefcond
                     * for the condition.  Use an existing one if possible.
                     * Can't be done for an affix with flags, ignoring
                     * COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG and COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG. */
                    if (*items[0] == 'P' && aff->af_pfxpostpone
                                               && aff_entry->ae_flags == NULL)
                    {
                        /* When the chop string is one lower-case letter and
                         * the add string ends in the upper-case letter we set
                         * the "upper" flag, clear "ae_chop" and remove the
                         * letters from "ae_add".  The condition must either
                         * be empty or start with the same letter. */
                        if (aff_entry->ae_chop != NULL
                                && aff_entry->ae_add != NULL
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                                && aff_entry->ae_chop[(*mb_ptr2len)(
                                                   aff_entry->ae_chop)] == NUL
#else
                                && aff_entry->ae_chop[1] == NUL
#endif
                                )
                        {
                            int         c, c_up;

                            c = PTR2CHAR(aff_entry->ae_chop);
                            c_up = SPELL_TOUPPER(c);
                            if (c_up != c
                                    && (aff_entry->ae_cond == NULL
                                        || PTR2CHAR(aff_entry->ae_cond) == c))
                            {
                                p = aff_entry->ae_add
                                                  + STRLEN(aff_entry->ae_add);
                                mb_ptr_back(aff_entry->ae_add, p);
                                if (PTR2CHAR(p) == c_up)
                                {
                                    upper = TRUE;
                                    aff_entry->ae_chop = NULL;
                                    *p = NUL;

                                    /* The condition is matched with the
                                     * actual word, thus must check for the
                                     * upper-case letter. */
                                    if (aff_entry->ae_cond != NULL)
                                    {
                                        char_u  buf[MAXLINELEN];
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                                        if (has_mbyte)
                                        {
                                            onecap_copy(items[4], buf, TRUE);
                                            aff_entry->ae_cond = getroom_save(
                                                                   spin, buf);
                                        }
                                        else
#endif
                                            *aff_entry->ae_cond = c_up;
                                        if (aff_entry->ae_cond != NULL)
                                        {
                                            sprintf((char *)buf, "^%s",
                                                          aff_entry->ae_cond);
                                            vim_free(aff_entry->ae_prog);
                                            aff_entry->ae_prog = vim_regcomp(
                                                    buf, RE_MAGIC + RE_STRING);
                                        }
                                    }
                                }
                            }
                        }

                        if (aff_entry->ae_chop == NULL
                                               && aff_entry->ae_flags == NULL)
                        {
                            int         idx;
                            char_u      **pp;
                            int         n;

                            /* Find a previously used condition. */
                            for (idx = spin->si_prefcond.ga_len - 1; idx >= 0;
                                                                        --idx)
                            {
                                p = ((char_u **)spin->si_prefcond.ga_data)[idx];
                                if (str_equal(p, aff_entry->ae_cond))
                                    break;
                            }
                            if (idx < 0 && ga_grow(&spin->si_prefcond, 1) == OK)
                            {
                                /* Not found, add a new condition. */
                                idx = spin->si_prefcond.ga_len++;
                                pp = ((char_u **)spin->si_prefcond.ga_data)
                                                                        + idx;
                                if (aff_entry->ae_cond == NULL)
                                    *pp = NULL;
                                else
                                    *pp = getroom_save(spin,
                                                          aff_entry->ae_cond);
                            }

                            /* Add the prefix to the prefix tree. */
                            if (aff_entry->ae_add == NULL)
                                p = (char_u *)"";
                            else
                                p = aff_entry->ae_add;

                            /* PFX_FLAGS is a negative number, so that
                             * tree_add_word() knows this is the prefix tree. */
                            n = PFX_FLAGS;
                            if (!cur_aff->ah_combine)
                                n |= WFP_NC;
                            if (upper)
                                n |= WFP_UP;
                            if (aff_entry->ae_comppermit)
                                n |= WFP_COMPPERMIT;
                            if (aff_entry->ae_compforbid)
                                n |= WFP_COMPFORBID;
                            tree_add_word(spin, p, spin->si_prefroot, n,
                                                      idx, cur_aff->ah_newID);
                            did_postpone_prefix = TRUE;
                        }

                        /* Didn't actually use ah_newID, backup si_newprefID. */
                        if (aff_todo == 0 && !did_postpone_prefix)
                        {
                            --spin->si_newprefID;
                            cur_aff->ah_newID = 0;
                        }
                    }
                }
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "FOL") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                               && fol == NULL)
            {
                fol = vim_strsave(items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "LOW") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                               && low == NULL)
            {
                low = vim_strsave(items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "UPP") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                               && upp == NULL)
            {
                upp = vim_strsave(items[1]);
            }
            else if ((STRCMP(items[0], "REP") == 0
                        || STRCMP(items[0], "REPSAL") == 0)
                    && itemcnt == 2)
            {
                /* Ignore REP/REPSAL count */;
                if (!isdigit(*items[1]))
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Expected REP(SAL) count in %s line %d"),
                                                                 fname, lnum);
            }
            else if ((STRCMP(items[0], "REP") == 0
                        || STRCMP(items[0], "REPSAL") == 0)
                    && itemcnt >= 3)
            {
                /* REP/REPSAL item */
                /* Myspell ignores extra arguments, we require it starts with
                 * # to detect mistakes. */
                if (itemcnt > 3 && items[3][0] != '#')
                    smsg((char_u *)_(e_afftrailing), fname, lnum, items[3]);
                if (items[0][3] == 'S' ? do_repsal : do_rep)
                {
                    /* Replace underscore with space (can't include a space
                     * directly). */
                    for (p = items[1]; *p != NUL; mb_ptr_adv(p))
                        if (*p == '_')
                            *p = ' ';
                    for (p = items[2]; *p != NUL; mb_ptr_adv(p))
                        if (*p == '_')
                            *p = ' ';
                    add_fromto(spin, items[0][3] == 'S'
                                         ? &spin->si_repsal
                                         : &spin->si_rep, items[1], items[2]);
                }
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "MAP") == 0 && itemcnt == 2)
            {
                /* MAP item or count */
                if (!found_map)
                {
                    /* First line contains the count. */
                    found_map = TRUE;
                    if (!isdigit(*items[1]))
                        smsg((char_u *)_("Expected MAP count in %s line %d"),
                                                                 fname, lnum);
                }
                else if (do_mapline)
                {
                    int         c;

                    /* Check that every character appears only once. */
                    for (p = items[1]; *p != NUL; )
                    {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                        c = mb_ptr2char_adv(&p);
#else
                        c = *p++;
#endif
                        if ((spin->si_map.ga_len > 0
                                    && vim_strchr(spin->si_map.ga_data, c)
                                                                      != NULL)
                                || vim_strchr(p, c) != NULL)
                            smsg((char_u *)_("Duplicate character in MAP in %s line %d"),
                                                                 fname, lnum);
                    }

                    /* We simply concatenate all the MAP strings, separated by
                     * slashes. */
                    ga_concat(&spin->si_map, items[1]);
                    ga_append(&spin->si_map, '/');
                }
            }
            /* Accept "SAL from to" and "SAL from to # comment". */
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "SAL") == 0
                    && (itemcnt == 3 || (itemcnt > 3 && items[3][0] == '#')))
            {
                if (do_sal)
                {
                    /* SAL item (sounds-a-like)
                     * Either one of the known keys or a from-to pair. */
                    if (STRCMP(items[1], "followup") == 0)
                        spin->si_followup = sal_to_bool(items[2]);
                    else if (STRCMP(items[1], "collapse_result") == 0)
                        spin->si_collapse = sal_to_bool(items[2]);
                    else if (STRCMP(items[1], "remove_accents") == 0)
                        spin->si_rem_accents = sal_to_bool(items[2]);
                    else
                        /* when "to" is "_" it means empty */
                        add_fromto(spin, &spin->si_sal, items[1],
                                     STRCMP(items[2], "_") == 0 ? (char_u *)""
                                                                : items[2]);
                }
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "SOFOFROM") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                          && sofofrom == NULL)
            {
                sofofrom = getroom_save(spin, items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "SOFOTO") == 0 && itemcnt == 2
                                                            && sofoto == NULL)
            {
                sofoto = getroom_save(spin, items[1]);
            }
            else if (STRCMP(items[0], "COMMON") == 0)
            {
                int     i;

                for (i = 1; i < itemcnt; ++i)
                {
                    if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hash_find(&spin->si_commonwords,
                                                                   items[i])))
                    {
                        p = vim_strsave(items[i]);
                        if (p == NULL)
                            break;
                        hash_add(&spin->si_commonwords, p);
                    }
                }
            }
            else
                smsg((char_u *)_("Unrecognized or duplicate item in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, items[0]);
        }
    }

    if (fol != NULL || low != NULL || upp != NULL)
    {
        if (spin->si_clear_chartab)
        {
            /* Clear the char type tables, don't want to use any of the
             * currently used spell properties. */
            init_spell_chartab();
            spin->si_clear_chartab = FALSE;
        }

        /*
         * Don't write a word table for an ASCII file, so that we don't check
         * for conflicts with a word table that matches 'encoding'.
         * Don't write one for utf-8 either, we use utf_*() and
         * mb_get_class(), the list of chars in the file will be incomplete.
         */
        if (!spin->si_ascii
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                && !enc_utf8
#endif
                )
        {
            if (fol == NULL || low == NULL || upp == NULL)
                smsg((char_u *)_("Missing FOL/LOW/UPP line in %s"), fname);
            else
                (void)set_spell_chartab(fol, low, upp);
        }

        vim_free(fol);
        vim_free(low);
        vim_free(upp);
    }

    /* Use compound specifications of the .aff file for the spell info. */
    if (compmax != 0)
    {
        aff_check_number(spin->si_compmax, compmax, "COMPOUNDWORDMAX");
        spin->si_compmax = compmax;
    }

    if (compminlen != 0)
    {
        aff_check_number(spin->si_compminlen, compminlen, "COMPOUNDMIN");
        spin->si_compminlen = compminlen;
    }

    if (compsylmax != 0)
    {
        if (syllable == NULL)
            smsg((char_u *)_("COMPOUNDSYLMAX used without SYLLABLE"));
        aff_check_number(spin->si_compsylmax, compsylmax, "COMPOUNDSYLMAX");
        spin->si_compsylmax = compsylmax;
    }

    if (compoptions != 0)
    {
        aff_check_number(spin->si_compoptions, compoptions, "COMPOUND options");
        spin->si_compoptions |= compoptions;
    }

    if (compflags != NULL)
        process_compflags(spin, aff, compflags);

    /* Check that we didn't use too many renumbered flags. */
    if (spin->si_newcompID < spin->si_newprefID)
    {
        if (spin->si_newcompID == 127 || spin->si_newcompID == 255)
            MSG(_("Too many postponed prefixes"));
        else if (spin->si_newprefID == 0 || spin->si_newprefID == 127)
            MSG(_("Too many compound flags"));
        else
            MSG(_("Too many posponed prefixes and/or compound flags"));
    }

    if (syllable != NULL)
    {
        aff_check_string(spin->si_syllable, syllable, "SYLLABLE");
        spin->si_syllable = syllable;
    }

    if (sofofrom != NULL || sofoto != NULL)
    {
        if (sofofrom == NULL || sofoto == NULL)
            smsg((char_u *)_("Missing SOFO%s line in %s"),
                                     sofofrom == NULL ? "FROM" : "TO", fname);
        else if (spin->si_sal.ga_len > 0)
            smsg((char_u *)_("Both SAL and SOFO lines in %s"), fname);
        else
        {
            aff_check_string(spin->si_sofofr, sofofrom, "SOFOFROM");
            aff_check_string(spin->si_sofoto, sofoto, "SOFOTO");
            spin->si_sofofr = sofofrom;
            spin->si_sofoto = sofoto;
        }
    }

    if (midword != NULL)
    {
        aff_check_string(spin->si_midword, midword, "MIDWORD");
        spin->si_midword = midword;
    }

    vim_free(pc);
    fclose(fd);
    return aff;
}

/*
 * For affix "entry" move COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG and COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG from
 * ae_flags to ae_comppermit and ae_compforbid.
 */
    static void
aff_process_flags(affile, entry)
    afffile_T   *affile;
    affentry_T  *entry;
{
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *prevp;
    unsigned    flag;

    if (entry->ae_flags != NULL
                && (affile->af_compforbid != 0 || affile->af_comppermit != 0))
    {
        for (p = entry->ae_flags; *p != NUL; )
        {
            prevp = p;
            flag = get_affitem(affile->af_flagtype, &p);
            if (flag == affile->af_comppermit || flag == affile->af_compforbid)
            {
                mch_memmove(prevp, p, STRLEN(p) + 1);
                p = prevp;
                if (flag == affile->af_comppermit)
                    entry->ae_comppermit = TRUE;
                else
                    entry->ae_compforbid = TRUE;
            }
            if (affile->af_flagtype == AFT_NUM && *p == ',')
                ++p;
        }
        if (*entry->ae_flags == NUL)
            entry->ae_flags = NULL;     /* nothing left */
    }
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if "s" is the name of an info item in the affix file.
 */
    static int
spell_info_item(s)
    char_u      *s;
{
    return STRCMP(s, "NAME") == 0
        || STRCMP(s, "HOME") == 0
        || STRCMP(s, "VERSION") == 0
        || STRCMP(s, "AUTHOR") == 0
        || STRCMP(s, "EMAIL") == 0
        || STRCMP(s, "COPYRIGHT") == 0;
}

/*
 * Turn an affix flag name into a number, according to the FLAG type.
 * returns zero for failure.
 */
    static unsigned
affitem2flag(flagtype, item, fname, lnum)
    int         flagtype;
    char_u      *item;
    char_u      *fname;
    int         lnum;
{
    unsigned    res;
    char_u      *p = item;

    res = get_affitem(flagtype, &p);
    if (res == 0)
    {
        if (flagtype == AFT_NUM)
            smsg((char_u *)_("Flag is not a number in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                           fname, lnum, item);
        else
            smsg((char_u *)_("Illegal flag in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                           fname, lnum, item);
    }
    if (*p != NUL)
    {
        smsg((char_u *)_(e_affname), fname, lnum, item);
        return 0;
    }

    return res;
}

/*
 * Get one affix name from "*pp" and advance the pointer.
 * Returns zero for an error, still advances the pointer then.
 */
    static unsigned
get_affitem(flagtype, pp)
    int         flagtype;
    char_u      **pp;
{
    int         res;

    if (flagtype == AFT_NUM)
    {
        if (!VIM_ISDIGIT(**pp))
        {
            ++*pp;      /* always advance, avoid getting stuck */
            return 0;
        }
        res = getdigits(pp);
    }
    else
    {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        res = mb_ptr2char_adv(pp);
#else
        res = *(*pp)++;
#endif
        if (flagtype == AFT_LONG || (flagtype == AFT_CAPLONG
                                                 && res >= 'A' && res <= 'Z'))
        {
            if (**pp == NUL)
                return 0;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            res = mb_ptr2char_adv(pp) + (res << 16);
#else
            res = *(*pp)++ + (res << 16);
#endif
        }
    }
    return res;
}

/*
 * Process the "compflags" string used in an affix file and append it to
 * spin->si_compflags.
 * The processing involves changing the affix names to ID numbers, so that
 * they fit in one byte.
 */
    static void
process_compflags(spin, aff, compflags)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    afffile_T   *aff;
    char_u      *compflags;
{
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *prevp;
    unsigned    flag;
    compitem_T  *ci;
    int         id;
    int         len;
    char_u      *tp;
    char_u      key[AH_KEY_LEN];
    hashitem_T  *hi;

    /* Make room for the old and the new compflags, concatenated with a / in
     * between.  Processing it makes it shorter, but we don't know by how
     * much, thus allocate the maximum. */
    len = (int)STRLEN(compflags) + 1;
    if (spin->si_compflags != NULL)
        len += (int)STRLEN(spin->si_compflags) + 1;
    p = getroom(spin, len, FALSE);
    if (p == NULL)
        return;
    if (spin->si_compflags != NULL)
    {
        STRCPY(p, spin->si_compflags);
        STRCAT(p, "/");
    }
    spin->si_compflags = p;
    tp = p + STRLEN(p);

    for (p = compflags; *p != NUL; )
    {
        if (vim_strchr((char_u *)"/*+[]", *p) != NULL)
            /* Copy non-flag characters directly. */
            *tp++ = *p++;
        else
        {
            /* First get the flag number, also checks validity. */
            prevp = p;
            flag = get_affitem(aff->af_flagtype, &p);
            if (flag != 0)
            {
                /* Find the flag in the hashtable.  If it was used before, use
                 * the existing ID.  Otherwise add a new entry. */
                vim_strncpy(key, prevp, p - prevp);
                hi = hash_find(&aff->af_comp, key);
                if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
                    id = HI2CI(hi)->ci_newID;
                else
                {
                    ci = (compitem_T *)getroom(spin, sizeof(compitem_T), TRUE);
                    if (ci == NULL)
                        break;
                    STRCPY(ci->ci_key, key);
                    ci->ci_flag = flag;
                    /* Avoid using a flag ID that has a special meaning in a
                     * regexp (also inside []). */
                    do
                    {
                        check_renumber(spin);
                        id = spin->si_newcompID--;
                    } while (vim_strchr((char_u *)"/+*[]\\-^", id) != NULL);
                    ci->ci_newID = id;
                    hash_add(&aff->af_comp, ci->ci_key);
                }
                *tp++ = id;
            }
            if (aff->af_flagtype == AFT_NUM && *p == ',')
                ++p;
        }
    }

    *tp = NUL;
}

/*
 * Check that the new IDs for postponed affixes and compounding don't overrun
 * each other.  We have almost 255 available, but start at 0-127 to avoid
 * using two bytes for utf-8.  When the 0-127 range is used up go to 128-255.
 * When that is used up an error message is given.
 */
    static void
check_renumber(spin)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
{
    if (spin->si_newprefID == spin->si_newcompID && spin->si_newcompID < 128)
    {
        spin->si_newprefID = 127;
        spin->si_newcompID = 255;
    }
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if flag "flag" appears in affix list "afflist".
 */
    static int
flag_in_afflist(flagtype, afflist, flag)
    int         flagtype;
    char_u      *afflist;
    unsigned    flag;
{
    char_u      *p;
    unsigned    n;

    switch (flagtype)
    {
        case AFT_CHAR:
            return vim_strchr(afflist, flag) != NULL;

        case AFT_CAPLONG:
        case AFT_LONG:
            for (p = afflist; *p != NUL; )
            {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                n = mb_ptr2char_adv(&p);
#else
                n = *p++;
#endif
                if ((flagtype == AFT_LONG || (n >= 'A' && n <= 'Z'))
                                                                 && *p != NUL)
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    n = mb_ptr2char_adv(&p) + (n << 16);
#else
                    n = *p++ + (n << 16);
#endif
                if (n == flag)
                    return TRUE;
            }
            break;

        case AFT_NUM:
            for (p = afflist; *p != NUL; )
            {
                n = getdigits(&p);
                if (n == flag)
                    return TRUE;
                if (*p != NUL)  /* skip over comma */
                    ++p;
            }
            break;
    }
    return FALSE;
}

/*
 * Give a warning when "spinval" and "affval" numbers are set and not the same.
 */
    static void
aff_check_number(spinval, affval, name)
    int     spinval;
    int     affval;
    char    *name;
{
    if (spinval != 0 && spinval != affval)
        smsg((char_u *)_("%s value differs from what is used in another .aff file"), name);
}

/*
 * Give a warning when "spinval" and "affval" strings are set and not the same.
 */
    static void
aff_check_string(spinval, affval, name)
    char_u      *spinval;
    char_u      *affval;
    char        *name;
{
    if (spinval != NULL && STRCMP(spinval, affval) != 0)
        smsg((char_u *)_("%s value differs from what is used in another .aff file"), name);
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if strings "s1" and "s2" are equal.  Also consider both being
 * NULL as equal.
 */
    static int
str_equal(s1, s2)
    char_u      *s1;
    char_u      *s2;
{
    if (s1 == NULL || s2 == NULL)
        return s1 == s2;
    return STRCMP(s1, s2) == 0;
}

/*
 * Add a from-to item to "gap".  Used for REP and SAL items.
 * They are stored case-folded.
 */
    static void
add_fromto(spin, gap, from, to)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    garray_T    *gap;
    char_u      *from;
    char_u      *to;
{
    fromto_T    *ftp;
    char_u      word[MAXWLEN];

    if (ga_grow(gap, 1) == OK)
    {
        ftp = ((fromto_T *)gap->ga_data) + gap->ga_len;
        (void)spell_casefold(from, (int)STRLEN(from), word, MAXWLEN);
        ftp->ft_from = getroom_save(spin, word);
        (void)spell_casefold(to, (int)STRLEN(to), word, MAXWLEN);
        ftp->ft_to = getroom_save(spin, word);
        ++gap->ga_len;
    }
}

/*
 * Convert a boolean argument in a SAL line to TRUE or FALSE;
 */
    static int
sal_to_bool(s)
    char_u      *s;
{
    return STRCMP(s, "1") == 0 || STRCMP(s, "true") == 0;
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if string "s" contains a non-ASCII character (128 or higher).
 * When "s" is NULL FALSE is returned.
 */
    static int
has_non_ascii(s)
    char_u      *s;
{
    char_u      *p;

    if (s != NULL)
        for (p = s; *p != NUL; ++p)
            if (*p >= 128)
                return TRUE;
    return FALSE;
}

/*
 * Free the structure filled by spell_read_aff().
 */
    static void
spell_free_aff(aff)
    afffile_T   *aff;
{
    hashtab_T   *ht;
    hashitem_T  *hi;
    int         todo;
    affheader_T *ah;
    affentry_T  *ae;

    vim_free(aff->af_enc);

    /* All this trouble to free the "ae_prog" items... */
    for (ht = &aff->af_pref; ; ht = &aff->af_suff)
    {
        todo = (int)ht->ht_used;
        for (hi = ht->ht_array; todo > 0; ++hi)
        {
            if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
            {
                --todo;
                ah = HI2AH(hi);
                for (ae = ah->ah_first; ae != NULL; ae = ae->ae_next)
                    vim_free(ae->ae_prog);
            }
        }
        if (ht == &aff->af_suff)
            break;
    }

    hash_clear(&aff->af_pref);
    hash_clear(&aff->af_suff);
    hash_clear(&aff->af_comp);
}

/*
 * Read dictionary file "fname".
 * Returns OK or FAIL;
 */
    static int
spell_read_dic(spin, fname, affile)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *fname;
    afffile_T   *affile;
{
    hashtab_T   ht;
    char_u      line[MAXLINELEN];
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *afflist;
    char_u      store_afflist[MAXWLEN];
    int         pfxlen;
    int         need_affix;
    char_u      *dw;
    char_u      *pc;
    char_u      *w;
    int         l;
    hash_T      hash;
    hashitem_T  *hi;
    FILE        *fd;
    int         lnum = 1;
    int         non_ascii = 0;
    int         retval = OK;
    char_u      message[MAXLINELEN + MAXWLEN];
    int         flags;
    int         duplicate = 0;

    /*
     * Open the file.
     */
    fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "r");
    if (fd == NULL)
    {
        EMSG2(_(e_notopen), fname);
        return FAIL;
    }

    /* The hashtable is only used to detect duplicated words. */
    hash_init(&ht);

    vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE,
                                  _("Reading dictionary file %s ..."), fname);
    spell_message(spin, IObuff);

    /* start with a message for the first line */
    spin->si_msg_count = 999999;

    /* Read and ignore the first line: word count. */
    (void)vim_fgets(line, MAXLINELEN, fd);
    if (!vim_isdigit(*skipwhite(line)))
        EMSG2(_("E760: No word count in %s"), fname);

    /*
     * Read all the lines in the file one by one.
     * The words are converted to 'encoding' here, before being added to
     * the hashtable.
     */
    while (!vim_fgets(line, MAXLINELEN, fd) && !got_int)
    {
        line_breakcheck();
        ++lnum;
        if (line[0] == '#' || line[0] == '/')
            continue;   /* comment line */

        /* Remove CR, LF and white space from the end.  White space halfway
         * the word is kept to allow e.g., "et al.". */
        l = (int)STRLEN(line);
        while (l > 0 && line[l - 1] <= ' ')
            --l;
        if (l == 0)
            continue;   /* empty line */
        line[l] = NUL;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        /* Convert from "SET" to 'encoding' when needed. */
        if (spin->si_conv.vc_type != CONV_NONE)
        {
            pc = string_convert(&spin->si_conv, line, NULL);
            if (pc == NULL)
            {
                smsg((char_u *)_("Conversion failure for word in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, line);
                continue;
            }
            w = pc;
        }
        else
#endif
        {
            pc = NULL;
            w = line;
        }

        /* Truncate the word at the "/", set "afflist" to what follows.
         * Replace "\/" by "/" and "\\" by "\". */
        afflist = NULL;
        for (p = w; *p != NUL; mb_ptr_adv(p))
        {
            if (*p == '\\' && (p[1] == '\\' || p[1] == '/'))
                mch_memmove(p, p + 1, STRLEN(p));
            else if (*p == '/')
            {
                *p = NUL;
                afflist = p + 1;
                break;
            }
        }

        /* Skip non-ASCII words when "spin->si_ascii" is TRUE. */
        if (spin->si_ascii && has_non_ascii(w))
        {
            ++non_ascii;
            vim_free(pc);
            continue;
        }

        /* This takes time, print a message every 10000 words. */
        if (spin->si_verbose && spin->si_msg_count > 10000)
        {
            spin->si_msg_count = 0;
            vim_snprintf((char *)message, sizeof(message),
                    _("line %6d, word %6d - %s"),
                       lnum, spin->si_foldwcount + spin->si_keepwcount, w);
            msg_start();
            msg_puts_long_attr(message, 0);
            msg_clr_eos();
            msg_didout = FALSE;
            msg_col = 0;
            out_flush();
        }

        /* Store the word in the hashtable to be able to find duplicates. */
        dw = (char_u *)getroom_save(spin, w);
        if (dw == NULL)
        {
            retval = FAIL;
            vim_free(pc);
            break;
        }

        hash = hash_hash(dw);
        hi = hash_lookup(&ht, dw, hash);
        if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
        {
            if (p_verbose > 0)
                smsg((char_u *)_("Duplicate word in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                             fname, lnum, dw);
            else if (duplicate == 0)
                smsg((char_u *)_("First duplicate word in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                             fname, lnum, dw);
            ++duplicate;
        }
        else
            hash_add_item(&ht, hi, dw, hash);

        flags = 0;
        store_afflist[0] = NUL;
        pfxlen = 0;
        need_affix = FALSE;
        if (afflist != NULL)
        {
            /* Extract flags from the affix list. */
            flags |= get_affix_flags(affile, afflist);

            if (affile->af_needaffix != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                          affile->af_flagtype, afflist, affile->af_needaffix))
                need_affix = TRUE;

            if (affile->af_pfxpostpone)
                /* Need to store the list of prefix IDs with the word. */
                pfxlen = get_pfxlist(affile, afflist, store_afflist);

            if (spin->si_compflags != NULL)
                /* Need to store the list of compound flags with the word.
                 * Concatenate them to the list of prefix IDs. */
                get_compflags(affile, afflist, store_afflist + pfxlen);
        }

        /* Add the word to the word tree(s). */
        if (store_word(spin, dw, flags, spin->si_region,
                                           store_afflist, need_affix) == FAIL)
            retval = FAIL;

        if (afflist != NULL)
        {
            /* Find all matching suffixes and add the resulting words.
             * Additionally do matching prefixes that combine. */
            if (store_aff_word(spin, dw, afflist, affile,
                           &affile->af_suff, &affile->af_pref,
                            CONDIT_SUF, flags, store_afflist, pfxlen) == FAIL)
                retval = FAIL;

            /* Find all matching prefixes and add the resulting words. */
            if (store_aff_word(spin, dw, afflist, affile,
                          &affile->af_pref, NULL,
                            CONDIT_SUF, flags, store_afflist, pfxlen) == FAIL)
                retval = FAIL;
        }

        vim_free(pc);
    }

    if (duplicate > 0)
        smsg((char_u *)_("%d duplicate word(s) in %s"), duplicate, fname);
    if (spin->si_ascii && non_ascii > 0)
        smsg((char_u *)_("Ignored %d word(s) with non-ASCII characters in %s"),
                                                            non_ascii, fname);
    hash_clear(&ht);

    fclose(fd);
    return retval;
}

/*
 * Check for affix flags in "afflist" that are turned into word flags.
 * Return WF_ flags.
 */
    static int
get_affix_flags(affile, afflist)
    afffile_T   *affile;
    char_u      *afflist;
{
    int         flags = 0;

    if (affile->af_keepcase != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                           affile->af_flagtype, afflist, affile->af_keepcase))
        flags |= WF_KEEPCAP | WF_FIXCAP;
    if (affile->af_rare != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                               affile->af_flagtype, afflist, affile->af_rare))
        flags |= WF_RARE;
    if (affile->af_bad != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                                affile->af_flagtype, afflist, affile->af_bad))
        flags |= WF_BANNED;
    if (affile->af_needcomp != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                           affile->af_flagtype, afflist, affile->af_needcomp))
        flags |= WF_NEEDCOMP;
    if (affile->af_comproot != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                           affile->af_flagtype, afflist, affile->af_comproot))
        flags |= WF_COMPROOT;
    if (affile->af_nosuggest != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                          affile->af_flagtype, afflist, affile->af_nosuggest))
        flags |= WF_NOSUGGEST;
    return flags;
}

/*
 * Get the list of prefix IDs from the affix list "afflist".
 * Used for PFXPOSTPONE.
 * Put the resulting flags in "store_afflist[MAXWLEN]" with a terminating NUL
 * and return the number of affixes.
 */
    static int
get_pfxlist(affile, afflist, store_afflist)
    afffile_T   *affile;
    char_u      *afflist;
    char_u      *store_afflist;
{
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *prevp;
    int         cnt = 0;
    int         id;
    char_u      key[AH_KEY_LEN];
    hashitem_T  *hi;

    for (p = afflist; *p != NUL; )
    {
        prevp = p;
        if (get_affitem(affile->af_flagtype, &p) != 0)
        {
            /* A flag is a postponed prefix flag if it appears in "af_pref"
             * and it's ID is not zero. */
            vim_strncpy(key, prevp, p - prevp);
            hi = hash_find(&affile->af_pref, key);
            if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
            {
                id = HI2AH(hi)->ah_newID;
                if (id != 0)
                    store_afflist[cnt++] = id;
            }
        }
        if (affile->af_flagtype == AFT_NUM && *p == ',')
            ++p;
    }

    store_afflist[cnt] = NUL;
    return cnt;
}

/*
 * Get the list of compound IDs from the affix list "afflist" that are used
 * for compound words.
 * Puts the flags in "store_afflist[]".
 */
    static void
get_compflags(affile, afflist, store_afflist)
    afffile_T   *affile;
    char_u      *afflist;
    char_u      *store_afflist;
{
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *prevp;
    int         cnt = 0;
    char_u      key[AH_KEY_LEN];
    hashitem_T  *hi;

    for (p = afflist; *p != NUL; )
    {
        prevp = p;
        if (get_affitem(affile->af_flagtype, &p) != 0)
        {
            /* A flag is a compound flag if it appears in "af_comp". */
            vim_strncpy(key, prevp, p - prevp);
            hi = hash_find(&affile->af_comp, key);
            if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
                store_afflist[cnt++] = HI2CI(hi)->ci_newID;
        }
        if (affile->af_flagtype == AFT_NUM && *p == ',')
            ++p;
    }

    store_afflist[cnt] = NUL;
}

/*
 * Apply affixes to a word and store the resulting words.
 * "ht" is the hashtable with affentry_T that need to be applied, either
 * prefixes or suffixes.
 * "xht", when not NULL, is the prefix hashtable, to be used additionally on
 * the resulting words for combining affixes.
 *
 * Returns FAIL when out of memory.
 */
    static int
store_aff_word(spin, word, afflist, affile, ht, xht, condit, flags,
                                                              pfxlist, pfxlen)
    spellinfo_T *spin;          /* spell info */
    char_u      *word;          /* basic word start */
    char_u      *afflist;       /* list of names of supported affixes */
    afffile_T   *affile;
    hashtab_T   *ht;
    hashtab_T   *xht;
    int         condit;         /* CONDIT_SUF et al. */
    int         flags;          /* flags for the word */
    char_u      *pfxlist;       /* list of prefix IDs */
    int         pfxlen;         /* nr of flags in "pfxlist" for prefixes, rest
                                 * is compound flags */
{
    int         todo;
    hashitem_T  *hi;
    affheader_T *ah;
    affentry_T  *ae;
    regmatch_T  regmatch;
    char_u      newword[MAXWLEN];
    int         retval = OK;
    int         i, j;
    char_u      *p;
    int         use_flags;
    char_u      *use_pfxlist;
    int         use_pfxlen;
    int         need_affix;
    char_u      store_afflist[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      pfx_pfxlist[MAXWLEN];
    size_t      wordlen = STRLEN(word);
    int         use_condit;

    todo = (int)ht->ht_used;
    for (hi = ht->ht_array; todo > 0 && retval == OK; ++hi)
    {
        if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
        {
            --todo;
            ah = HI2AH(hi);

            /* Check that the affix combines, if required, and that the word
             * supports this affix. */
            if (((condit & CONDIT_COMB) == 0 || ah->ah_combine)
                    && flag_in_afflist(affile->af_flagtype, afflist,
                                                                 ah->ah_flag))
            {
                /* Loop over all affix entries with this name. */
                for (ae = ah->ah_first; ae != NULL; ae = ae->ae_next)
                {
                    /* Check the condition.  It's not logical to match case
                     * here, but it is required for compatibility with
                     * Myspell.
                     * Another requirement from Myspell is that the chop
                     * string is shorter than the word itself.
                     * For prefixes, when "PFXPOSTPONE" was used, only do
                     * prefixes with a chop string and/or flags.
                     * When a previously added affix had CIRCUMFIX this one
                     * must have it too, if it had not then this one must not
                     * have one either. */
                    regmatch.regprog = ae->ae_prog;
                    regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE;
                    if ((xht != NULL || !affile->af_pfxpostpone
                                || ae->ae_chop != NULL
                                || ae->ae_flags != NULL)
                            && (ae->ae_chop == NULL
                                || STRLEN(ae->ae_chop) < wordlen)
                            && (ae->ae_prog == NULL
                                || vim_regexec(&regmatch, word, (colnr_T)0))
                            && (((condit & CONDIT_CFIX) == 0)
                                == ((condit & CONDIT_AFF) == 0
                                    || ae->ae_flags == NULL
                                    || !flag_in_afflist(affile->af_flagtype,
                                        ae->ae_flags, affile->af_circumfix))))
                    {
                        /* Match.  Remove the chop and add the affix. */
                        if (xht == NULL)
                        {
                            /* prefix: chop/add at the start of the word */
                            if (ae->ae_add == NULL)
                                *newword = NUL;
                            else
                                STRCPY(newword, ae->ae_add);
                            p = word;
                            if (ae->ae_chop != NULL)
                            {
                                /* Skip chop string. */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                                if (has_mbyte)
                                {
                                    i = mb_charlen(ae->ae_chop);
                                    for ( ; i > 0; --i)
                                        mb_ptr_adv(p);
                                }
                                else
#endif
                                    p += STRLEN(ae->ae_chop);
                            }
                            STRCAT(newword, p);
                        }
                        else
                        {
                            /* suffix: chop/add at the end of the word */
                            STRCPY(newword, word);
                            if (ae->ae_chop != NULL)
                            {
                                /* Remove chop string. */
                                p = newword + STRLEN(newword);
                                i = (int)MB_CHARLEN(ae->ae_chop);
                                for ( ; i > 0; --i)
                                    mb_ptr_back(newword, p);
                                *p = NUL;
                            }
                            if (ae->ae_add != NULL)
                                STRCAT(newword, ae->ae_add);
                        }

                        use_flags = flags;
                        use_pfxlist = pfxlist;
                        use_pfxlen = pfxlen;
                        need_affix = FALSE;
                        use_condit = condit | CONDIT_COMB | CONDIT_AFF;
                        if (ae->ae_flags != NULL)
                        {
                            /* Extract flags from the affix list. */
                            use_flags |= get_affix_flags(affile, ae->ae_flags);

                            if (affile->af_needaffix != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                                        affile->af_flagtype, ae->ae_flags,
                                                        affile->af_needaffix))
                                need_affix = TRUE;

                            /* When there is a CIRCUMFIX flag the other affix
                             * must also have it and we don't add the word
                             * with one affix. */
                            if (affile->af_circumfix != 0 && flag_in_afflist(
                                        affile->af_flagtype, ae->ae_flags,
                                                        affile->af_circumfix))
                            {
                                use_condit |= CONDIT_CFIX;
                                if ((condit & CONDIT_CFIX) == 0)
                                    need_affix = TRUE;
                            }

                            if (affile->af_pfxpostpone
                                                || spin->si_compflags != NULL)
                            {
                                if (affile->af_pfxpostpone)
                                    /* Get prefix IDS from the affix list. */
                                    use_pfxlen = get_pfxlist(affile,
                                                 ae->ae_flags, store_afflist);
                                else
                                    use_pfxlen = 0;
                                use_pfxlist = store_afflist;

                                /* Combine the prefix IDs. Avoid adding the
                                 * same ID twice. */
                                for (i = 0; i < pfxlen; ++i)
                                {
                                    for (j = 0; j < use_pfxlen; ++j)
                                        if (pfxlist[i] == use_pfxlist[j])
                                            break;
                                    if (j == use_pfxlen)
                                        use_pfxlist[use_pfxlen++] = pfxlist[i];
                                }

                                if (spin->si_compflags != NULL)
                                    /* Get compound IDS from the affix list. */
                                    get_compflags(affile, ae->ae_flags,
                                                  use_pfxlist + use_pfxlen);

                                /* Combine the list of compound flags.
                                 * Concatenate them to the prefix IDs list.
                                 * Avoid adding the same ID twice. */
                                for (i = pfxlen; pfxlist[i] != NUL; ++i)
                                {
                                    for (j = use_pfxlen;
                                                   use_pfxlist[j] != NUL; ++j)
                                        if (pfxlist[i] == use_pfxlist[j])
                                            break;
                                    if (use_pfxlist[j] == NUL)
                                    {
                                        use_pfxlist[j++] = pfxlist[i];
                                        use_pfxlist[j] = NUL;
                                    }
                                }
                            }
                        }

                        /* Obey a "COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG" of the affix: don't
                         * use the compound flags. */
                        if (use_pfxlist != NULL && ae->ae_compforbid)
                        {
                            vim_strncpy(pfx_pfxlist, use_pfxlist, use_pfxlen);
                            use_pfxlist = pfx_pfxlist;
                        }

                        /* When there are postponed prefixes... */
                        if (spin->si_prefroot != NULL
                                && spin->si_prefroot->wn_sibling != NULL)
                        {
                            /* ... add a flag to indicate an affix was used. */
                            use_flags |= WF_HAS_AFF;

                            /* ... don't use a prefix list if combining
                             * affixes is not allowed.  But do use the
                             * compound flags after them. */
                            if (!ah->ah_combine && use_pfxlist != NULL)
                                use_pfxlist += use_pfxlen;
                        }

                        /* When compounding is supported and there is no
                         * "COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG" then forbid compounding on the
                         * side where the affix is applied. */
                        if (spin->si_compflags != NULL && !ae->ae_comppermit)
                        {
                            if (xht != NULL)
                                use_flags |= WF_NOCOMPAFT;
                            else
                                use_flags |= WF_NOCOMPBEF;
                        }

                        /* Store the modified word. */
                        if (store_word(spin, newword, use_flags,
                                                 spin->si_region, use_pfxlist,
                                                          need_affix) == FAIL)
                            retval = FAIL;

                        /* When added a prefix or a first suffix and the affix
                         * has flags may add a(nother) suffix.  RECURSIVE! */
                        if ((condit & CONDIT_SUF) && ae->ae_flags != NULL)
                            if (store_aff_word(spin, newword, ae->ae_flags,
                                        affile, &affile->af_suff, xht,
                                           use_condit & (xht == NULL
                                                        ? ~0 :  ~CONDIT_SUF),
                                      use_flags, use_pfxlist, pfxlen) == FAIL)
                                retval = FAIL;

                        /* When added a suffix and combining is allowed also
                         * try adding a prefix additionally.  Both for the
                         * word flags and for the affix flags.  RECURSIVE! */
                        if (xht != NULL && ah->ah_combine)
                        {
                            if (store_aff_word(spin, newword,
                                        afflist, affile,
                                        xht, NULL, use_condit,
                                        use_flags, use_pfxlist,
                                        pfxlen) == FAIL
                                    || (ae->ae_flags != NULL
                                        && store_aff_word(spin, newword,
                                            ae->ae_flags, affile,
                                            xht, NULL, use_condit,
                                            use_flags, use_pfxlist,
                                            pfxlen) == FAIL))
                                retval = FAIL;
                        }
                    }
                }
            }
        }
    }

    return retval;
}

/*
 * Read a file with a list of words.
 */
    static int
spell_read_wordfile(spin, fname)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *fname;
{
    FILE        *fd;
    long        lnum = 0;
    char_u      rline[MAXLINELEN];
    char_u      *line;
    char_u      *pc = NULL;
    char_u      *p;
    int         l;
    int         retval = OK;
    int         did_word = FALSE;
    int         non_ascii = 0;
    int         flags;
    int         regionmask;

    /*
     * Open the file.
     */
    fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "r");
    if (fd == NULL)
    {
        EMSG2(_(e_notopen), fname);
        return FAIL;
    }

    vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, _("Reading word file %s ..."), fname);
    spell_message(spin, IObuff);

    /*
     * Read all the lines in the file one by one.
     */
    while (!vim_fgets(rline, MAXLINELEN, fd) && !got_int)
    {
        line_breakcheck();
        ++lnum;

        /* Skip comment lines. */
        if (*rline == '#')
            continue;

        /* Remove CR, LF and white space from the end. */
        l = (int)STRLEN(rline);
        while (l > 0 && rline[l - 1] <= ' ')
            --l;
        if (l == 0)
            continue;   /* empty or blank line */
        rline[l] = NUL;

        /* Convert from "/encoding={encoding}" to 'encoding' when needed. */
        vim_free(pc);
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (spin->si_conv.vc_type != CONV_NONE)
        {
            pc = string_convert(&spin->si_conv, rline, NULL);
            if (pc == NULL)
            {
                smsg((char_u *)_("Conversion failure for word in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                           fname, lnum, rline);
                continue;
            }
            line = pc;
        }
        else
#endif
        {
            pc = NULL;
            line = rline;
        }

        if (*line == '/')
        {
            ++line;
            if (STRNCMP(line, "encoding=", 9) == 0)
            {
                if (spin->si_conv.vc_type != CONV_NONE)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Duplicate /encoding= line ignored in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, line - 1);
                else if (did_word)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("/encoding= line after word ignored in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, line - 1);
                else
                {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    char_u      *enc;

                    /* Setup for conversion to 'encoding'. */
                    line += 9;
                    enc = enc_canonize(line);
                    if (enc != NULL && !spin->si_ascii
                            && convert_setup(&spin->si_conv, enc,
                                                               p_enc) == FAIL)
                        smsg((char_u *)_("Conversion in %s not supported: from %s to %s"),
                                                          fname, line, p_enc);
                    vim_free(enc);
                    spin->si_conv.vc_fail = TRUE;
#else
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Conversion in %s not supported"), fname);
#endif
                }
                continue;
            }

            if (STRNCMP(line, "regions=", 8) == 0)
            {
                if (spin->si_region_count > 1)
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Duplicate /regions= line ignored in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, line);
                else
                {
                    line += 8;
                    if (STRLEN(line) > 16)
                        smsg((char_u *)_("Too many regions in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, line);
                    else
                    {
                        spin->si_region_count = (int)STRLEN(line) / 2;
                        STRCPY(spin->si_region_name, line);

                        /* Adjust the mask for a word valid in all regions. */
                        spin->si_region = (1 << spin->si_region_count) - 1;
                    }
                }
                continue;
            }

            smsg((char_u *)_("/ line ignored in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                       fname, lnum, line - 1);
            continue;
        }

        flags = 0;
        regionmask = spin->si_region;

        /* Check for flags and region after a slash. */
        p = vim_strchr(line, '/');
        if (p != NULL)
        {
            *p++ = NUL;
            while (*p != NUL)
            {
                if (*p == '=')          /* keep-case word */
                    flags |= WF_KEEPCAP | WF_FIXCAP;
                else if (*p == '!')     /* Bad, bad, wicked word. */
                    flags |= WF_BANNED;
                else if (*p == '?')     /* Rare word. */
                    flags |= WF_RARE;
                else if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p)) /* region number(s) */
                {
                    if ((flags & WF_REGION) == 0)   /* first one */
                        regionmask = 0;
                    flags |= WF_REGION;

                    l = *p - '0';
                    if (l > spin->si_region_count)
                    {
                        smsg((char_u *)_("Invalid region nr in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                          fname, lnum, p);
                        break;
                    }
                    regionmask |= 1 << (l - 1);
                }
                else
                {
                    smsg((char_u *)_("Unrecognized flags in %s line %d: %s"),
                                                              fname, lnum, p);
                    break;
                }
                ++p;
            }
        }

        /* Skip non-ASCII words when "spin->si_ascii" is TRUE. */
        if (spin->si_ascii && has_non_ascii(line))
        {
            ++non_ascii;
            continue;
        }

        /* Normal word: store it. */
        if (store_word(spin, line, flags, regionmask, NULL, FALSE) == FAIL)
        {
            retval = FAIL;
            break;
        }
        did_word = TRUE;
    }

    vim_free(pc);
    fclose(fd);

    if (spin->si_ascii && non_ascii > 0)
    {
        vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE,
                  _("Ignored %d words with non-ASCII characters"), non_ascii);
        spell_message(spin, IObuff);
    }

    return retval;
}

/*
 * Get part of an sblock_T, "len" bytes long.
 * This avoids calling free() for every little struct we use (and keeping
 * track of them).
 * The memory is cleared to all zeros.
 * Returns NULL when out of memory.
 */
    static void *
getroom(spin, len, align)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    size_t      len;            /* length needed */
    int         align;          /* align for pointer */
{
    char_u      *p;
    sblock_T    *bl = spin->si_blocks;

    if (align && bl != NULL)
        /* Round size up for alignment.  On some systems structures need to be
         * aligned to the size of a pointer (e.g., SPARC). */
        bl->sb_used = (bl->sb_used + sizeof(char *) - 1)
                                                      & ~(sizeof(char *) - 1);

    if (bl == NULL || bl->sb_used + len > SBLOCKSIZE)
    {
        /* Allocate a block of memory. This is not freed until much later. */
        bl = (sblock_T *)alloc_clear((unsigned)(sizeof(sblock_T) + SBLOCKSIZE));
        if (bl == NULL)
            return NULL;
        bl->sb_next = spin->si_blocks;
        spin->si_blocks = bl;
        bl->sb_used = 0;
        ++spin->si_blocks_cnt;
    }

    p = bl->sb_data + bl->sb_used;
    bl->sb_used += (int)len;

    return p;
}

/*
 * Make a copy of a string into memory allocated with getroom().
 */
    static char_u *
getroom_save(spin, s)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *s;
{
    char_u      *sc;

    sc = (char_u *)getroom(spin, STRLEN(s) + 1, FALSE);
    if (sc != NULL)
        STRCPY(sc, s);
    return sc;
}


/*
 * Free the list of allocated sblock_T.
 */
    static void
free_blocks(bl)
    sblock_T    *bl;
{
    sblock_T    *next;

    while (bl != NULL)
    {
        next = bl->sb_next;
        vim_free(bl);
        bl = next;
    }
}

/*
 * Allocate the root of a word tree.
 */
    static wordnode_T *
wordtree_alloc(spin)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
{
    return (wordnode_T *)getroom(spin, sizeof(wordnode_T), TRUE);
}

/*
 * Store a word in the tree(s).
 * Always store it in the case-folded tree.  For a keep-case word this is
 * useful when the word can also be used with all caps (no WF_FIXCAP flag) and
 * used to find suggestions.
 * For a keep-case word also store it in the keep-case tree.
 * When "pfxlist" is not NULL store the word for each postponed prefix ID and
 * compound flag.
 */
    static int
store_word(spin, word, flags, region, pfxlist, need_affix)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *word;
    int         flags;          /* extra flags, WF_BANNED */
    int         region;         /* supported region(s) */
    char_u      *pfxlist;       /* list of prefix IDs or NULL */
    int         need_affix;     /* only store word with affix ID */
{
    int         len = (int)STRLEN(word);
    int         ct = captype(word, word + len);
    char_u      foldword[MAXWLEN];
    int         res = OK;
    char_u      *p;

    (void)spell_casefold(word, len, foldword, MAXWLEN);
    for (p = pfxlist; res == OK; ++p)
    {
        if (!need_affix || (p != NULL && *p != NUL))
            res = tree_add_word(spin, foldword, spin->si_foldroot, ct | flags,
                                                  region, p == NULL ? 0 : *p);
        if (p == NULL || *p == NUL)
            break;
    }
    ++spin->si_foldwcount;

    if (res == OK && (ct == WF_KEEPCAP || (flags & WF_KEEPCAP)))
    {
        for (p = pfxlist; res == OK; ++p)
        {
            if (!need_affix || (p != NULL && *p != NUL))
                res = tree_add_word(spin, word, spin->si_keeproot, flags,
                                                  region, p == NULL ? 0 : *p);
            if (p == NULL || *p == NUL)
                break;
        }
        ++spin->si_keepwcount;
    }
    return res;
}

/*
 * Add word "word" to a word tree at "root".
 * When "flags" < 0 we are adding to the prefix tree where "flags" is used for
 * "rare" and "region" is the condition nr.
 * Returns FAIL when out of memory.
 */
    static int
tree_add_word(spin, word, root, flags, region, affixID)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *word;
    wordnode_T  *root;
    int         flags;
    int         region;
    int         affixID;
{
    wordnode_T  *node = root;
    wordnode_T  *np;
    wordnode_T  *copyp, **copyprev;
    wordnode_T  **prev = NULL;
    int         i;

    /* Add each byte of the word to the tree, including the NUL at the end. */
    for (i = 0; ; ++i)
    {
        /* When there is more than one reference to this node we need to make
         * a copy, so that we can modify it.  Copy the whole list of siblings
         * (we don't optimize for a partly shared list of siblings). */
        if (node != NULL && node->wn_refs > 1)
        {
            --node->wn_refs;
            copyprev = prev;
            for (copyp = node; copyp != NULL; copyp = copyp->wn_sibling)
            {
                /* Allocate a new node and copy the info. */
                np = get_wordnode(spin);
                if (np == NULL)
                    return FAIL;
                np->wn_child = copyp->wn_child;
                if (np->wn_child != NULL)
                    ++np->wn_child->wn_refs;    /* child gets extra ref */
                np->wn_byte = copyp->wn_byte;
                if (np->wn_byte == NUL)
                {
                    np->wn_flags = copyp->wn_flags;
                    np->wn_region = copyp->wn_region;
                    np->wn_affixID = copyp->wn_affixID;
                }

                /* Link the new node in the list, there will be one ref. */
                np->wn_refs = 1;
                if (copyprev != NULL)
                    *copyprev = np;
                copyprev = &np->wn_sibling;

                /* Let "node" point to the head of the copied list. */
                if (copyp == node)
                    node = np;
            }
        }

        /* Look for the sibling that has the same character.  They are sorted
         * on byte value, thus stop searching when a sibling is found with a
         * higher byte value.  For zero bytes (end of word) the sorting is
         * done on flags and then on affixID. */
        while (node != NULL
                && (node->wn_byte < word[i]
                    || (node->wn_byte == NUL
                        && (flags < 0
                            ? node->wn_affixID < (unsigned)affixID
                            : (node->wn_flags < (unsigned)(flags & WN_MASK)
                                || (node->wn_flags == (flags & WN_MASK)
                                    && (spin->si_sugtree
                                        ? (node->wn_region & 0xffff) < region
                                        : node->wn_affixID
                                                    < (unsigned)affixID)))))))
        {
            prev = &node->wn_sibling;
            node = *prev;
        }
        if (node == NULL
                || node->wn_byte != word[i]
                || (word[i] == NUL
                    && (flags < 0
                        || spin->si_sugtree
                        || node->wn_flags != (flags & WN_MASK)
                        || node->wn_affixID != affixID)))
        {
            /* Allocate a new node. */
            np = get_wordnode(spin);
            if (np == NULL)
                return FAIL;
            np->wn_byte = word[i];

            /* If "node" is NULL this is a new child or the end of the sibling
             * list: ref count is one.  Otherwise use ref count of sibling and
             * make ref count of sibling one (matters when inserting in front
             * of the list of siblings). */
            if (node == NULL)
                np->wn_refs = 1;
            else
            {
                np->wn_refs = node->wn_refs;
                node->wn_refs = 1;
            }
            *prev = np;
            np->wn_sibling = node;
            node = np;
        }

        if (word[i] == NUL)
        {
            node->wn_flags = flags;
            node->wn_region |= region;
            node->wn_affixID = affixID;
            break;
        }
        prev = &node->wn_child;
        node = *prev;
    }
#ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
    smsg("Added \"%s\"", word);
    spell_print_tree(root->wn_sibling);
#endif

    /* count nr of words added since last message */
    ++spin->si_msg_count;

    if (spin->si_compress_cnt > 1)
    {
        if (--spin->si_compress_cnt == 1)
            /* Did enough words to lower the block count limit. */
            spin->si_blocks_cnt += compress_inc;
    }

    /*
     * When we have allocated lots of memory we need to compress the word tree
     * to free up some room.  But compression is slow, and we might actually
     * need that room, thus only compress in the following situations:
     * 1. When not compressed before (si_compress_cnt == 0): when using
     *    "compress_start" blocks.
     * 2. When compressed before and used "compress_inc" blocks before
     *    adding "compress_added" words (si_compress_cnt > 1).
     * 3. When compressed before, added "compress_added" words
     *    (si_compress_cnt == 1) and the number of free nodes drops below the
     *    maximum word length.
     */
#ifndef SPELL_PRINTTREE
    if (spin->si_compress_cnt == 1
            ? spin->si_free_count < MAXWLEN
            : spin->si_blocks_cnt >= compress_start)
#endif
    {
        /* Decrement the block counter.  The effect is that we compress again
         * when the freed up room has been used and another "compress_inc"
         * blocks have been allocated.  Unless "compress_added" words have
         * been added, then the limit is put back again. */
        spin->si_blocks_cnt -= compress_inc;
        spin->si_compress_cnt = compress_added;

        if (spin->si_verbose)
        {
            msg_start();
            msg_puts((char_u *)_(msg_compressing));
            msg_clr_eos();
            msg_didout = FALSE;
            msg_col = 0;
            out_flush();
        }

        /* Compress both trees.  Either they both have many nodes, which makes
         * compression useful, or one of them is small, which means
         * compression goes fast.  But when filling the souldfold word tree
         * there is no keep-case tree. */
        wordtree_compress(spin, spin->si_foldroot);
        if (affixID >= 0)
            wordtree_compress(spin, spin->si_keeproot);
    }

    return OK;
}

/*
 * Check the 'mkspellmem' option.  Return FAIL if it's wrong.
 * Sets "sps_flags".
 */
    int
spell_check_msm()
{
    char_u      *p = p_msm;
    long        start = 0;
    long        incr = 0;
    long        added = 0;

    if (!VIM_ISDIGIT(*p))
        return FAIL;
    /* block count = (value * 1024) / SBLOCKSIZE (but avoid overflow)*/
    start = (getdigits(&p) * 10) / (SBLOCKSIZE / 102);
    if (*p != ',')
        return FAIL;
    ++p;
    if (!VIM_ISDIGIT(*p))
        return FAIL;
    incr = (getdigits(&p) * 102) / (SBLOCKSIZE / 10);
    if (*p != ',')
        return FAIL;
    ++p;
    if (!VIM_ISDIGIT(*p))
        return FAIL;
    added = getdigits(&p) * 1024;
    if (*p != NUL)
        return FAIL;

    if (start == 0 || incr == 0 || added == 0 || incr > start)
        return FAIL;

    compress_start = start;
    compress_inc = incr;
    compress_added = added;
    return OK;
}


/*
 * Get a wordnode_T, either from the list of previously freed nodes or
 * allocate a new one.
 */
    static wordnode_T *
get_wordnode(spin)
    spellinfo_T     *spin;
{
    wordnode_T *n;

    if (spin->si_first_free == NULL)
        n = (wordnode_T *)getroom(spin, sizeof(wordnode_T), TRUE);
    else
    {
        n = spin->si_first_free;
        spin->si_first_free = n->wn_child;
        vim_memset(n, 0, sizeof(wordnode_T));
        --spin->si_free_count;
    }
#ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
    n->wn_nr = ++spin->si_wordnode_nr;
#endif
    return n;
}

/*
 * Decrement the reference count on a node (which is the head of a list of
 * siblings).  If the reference count becomes zero free the node and its
 * siblings.
 * Returns the number of nodes actually freed.
 */
    static int
deref_wordnode(spin, node)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    wordnode_T  *node;
{
    wordnode_T  *np;
    int         cnt = 0;

    if (--node->wn_refs == 0)
    {
        for (np = node; np != NULL; np = np->wn_sibling)
        {
            if (np->wn_child != NULL)
                cnt += deref_wordnode(spin, np->wn_child);
            free_wordnode(spin, np);
            ++cnt;
        }
        ++cnt;      /* length field */
    }
    return cnt;
}

/*
 * Free a wordnode_T for re-use later.
 * Only the "wn_child" field becomes invalid.
 */
    static void
free_wordnode(spin, n)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    wordnode_T  *n;
{
    n->wn_child = spin->si_first_free;
    spin->si_first_free = n;
    ++spin->si_free_count;
}

/*
 * Compress a tree: find tails that are identical and can be shared.
 */
    static void
wordtree_compress(spin, root)
    spellinfo_T     *spin;
    wordnode_T      *root;
{
    hashtab_T       ht;
    int             n;
    int             tot = 0;
    int             perc;

    /* Skip the root itself, it's not actually used.  The first sibling is the
     * start of the tree. */
    if (root->wn_sibling != NULL)
    {
        hash_init(&ht);
        n = node_compress(spin, root->wn_sibling, &ht, &tot);

#ifndef SPELL_PRINTTREE
        if (spin->si_verbose || p_verbose > 2)
#endif
        {
            if (tot > 1000000)
                perc = (tot - n) / (tot / 100);
            else if (tot == 0)
                perc = 0;
            else
                perc = (tot - n) * 100 / tot;
            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE,
                          _("Compressed %d of %d nodes; %d (%d%%) remaining"),
                                                       n, tot, tot - n, perc);
            spell_message(spin, IObuff);
        }
#ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
        spell_print_tree(root->wn_sibling);
#endif
        hash_clear(&ht);
    }
}

/*
 * Compress a node, its siblings and its children, depth first.
 * Returns the number of compressed nodes.
 */
    static int
node_compress(spin, node, ht, tot)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    wordnode_T  *node;
    hashtab_T   *ht;
    int         *tot;       /* total count of nodes before compressing,
                               incremented while going through the tree */
{
    wordnode_T  *np;
    wordnode_T  *tp;
    wordnode_T  *child;
    hash_T      hash;
    hashitem_T  *hi;
    int         len = 0;
    unsigned    nr, n;
    int         compressed = 0;

    /*
     * Go through the list of siblings.  Compress each child and then try
     * finding an identical child to replace it.
     * Note that with "child" we mean not just the node that is pointed to,
     * but the whole list of siblings of which the child node is the first.
     */
    for (np = node; np != NULL && !got_int; np = np->wn_sibling)
    {
        ++len;
        if ((child = np->wn_child) != NULL)
        {
            /* Compress the child first.  This fills hashkey. */
            compressed += node_compress(spin, child, ht, tot);

            /* Try to find an identical child. */
            hash = hash_hash(child->wn_u1.hashkey);
            hi = hash_lookup(ht, child->wn_u1.hashkey, hash);
            if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
            {
                /* There are children we encountered before with a hash value
                 * identical to the current child.  Now check if there is one
                 * that is really identical. */
                for (tp = HI2WN(hi); tp != NULL; tp = tp->wn_u2.next)
                    if (node_equal(child, tp))
                    {
                        /* Found one!  Now use that child in place of the
                         * current one.  This means the current child and all
                         * its siblings is unlinked from the tree. */
                        ++tp->wn_refs;
                        compressed += deref_wordnode(spin, child);
                        np->wn_child = tp;
                        break;
                    }
                if (tp == NULL)
                {
                    /* No other child with this hash value equals the child of
                     * the node, add it to the linked list after the first
                     * item. */
                    tp = HI2WN(hi);
                    child->wn_u2.next = tp->wn_u2.next;
                    tp->wn_u2.next = child;
                }
            }
            else
                /* No other child has this hash value, add it to the
                 * hashtable. */
                hash_add_item(ht, hi, child->wn_u1.hashkey, hash);
        }
    }
    *tot += len + 1;    /* add one for the node that stores the length */

    /*
     * Make a hash key for the node and its siblings, so that we can quickly
     * find a lookalike node.  This must be done after compressing the sibling
     * list, otherwise the hash key would become invalid by the compression.
     */
    node->wn_u1.hashkey[0] = len;
    nr = 0;
    for (np = node; np != NULL; np = np->wn_sibling)
    {
        if (np->wn_byte == NUL)
            /* end node: use wn_flags, wn_region and wn_affixID */
            n = np->wn_flags + (np->wn_region << 8) + (np->wn_affixID << 16);
        else
            /* byte node: use the byte value and the child pointer */
            n = (unsigned)(np->wn_byte + ((long_u)np->wn_child << 8));
        nr = nr * 101 + n;
    }

    /* Avoid NUL bytes, it terminates the hash key. */
    n = nr & 0xff;
    node->wn_u1.hashkey[1] = n == 0 ? 1 : n;
    n = (nr >> 8) & 0xff;
    node->wn_u1.hashkey[2] = n == 0 ? 1 : n;
    n = (nr >> 16) & 0xff;
    node->wn_u1.hashkey[3] = n == 0 ? 1 : n;
    n = (nr >> 24) & 0xff;
    node->wn_u1.hashkey[4] = n == 0 ? 1 : n;
    node->wn_u1.hashkey[5] = NUL;

    /* Check for CTRL-C pressed now and then. */
    fast_breakcheck();

    return compressed;
}

/*
 * Return TRUE when two nodes have identical siblings and children.
 */
    static int
node_equal(n1, n2)
    wordnode_T  *n1;
    wordnode_T  *n2;
{
    wordnode_T  *p1;
    wordnode_T  *p2;

    for (p1 = n1, p2 = n2; p1 != NULL && p2 != NULL;
                                     p1 = p1->wn_sibling, p2 = p2->wn_sibling)
        if (p1->wn_byte != p2->wn_byte
                || (p1->wn_byte == NUL
                    ? (p1->wn_flags != p2->wn_flags
                        || p1->wn_region != p2->wn_region
                        || p1->wn_affixID != p2->wn_affixID)
                    : (p1->wn_child != p2->wn_child)))
            break;

    return p1 == NULL && p2 == NULL;
}

/*
 * Write a number to file "fd", MSB first, in "len" bytes.
 */
    void
put_bytes(fd, nr, len)
    FILE    *fd;
    long_u  nr;
    int     len;
{
    int     i;

    for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
        putc((int)(nr >> (i * 8)), fd);
}

#ifdef _MSC_VER
# if (_MSC_VER <= 1200)
/* This line is required for VC6 without the service pack.  Also see the
 * matching #pragma below. */
/* # pragma optimize("", off) */
# endif
#endif

/*
 * Write spin->si_sugtime to file "fd".
 */
    static void
put_sugtime(spin, fd)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    FILE        *fd;
{
    int         c;
    int         i;

    /* time_t can be up to 8 bytes in size, more than long_u, thus we
     * can't use put_bytes() here. */
    for (i = 7; i >= 0; --i)
        if (i + 1 > sizeof(time_t))
            /* ">>" doesn't work well when shifting more bits than avail */
            putc(0, fd);
        else
        {
            c = (unsigned)spin->si_sugtime >> (i * 8);
            putc(c, fd);
        }
}

#ifdef _MSC_VER
# if (_MSC_VER <= 1200)
/* # pragma optimize("", on) */
# endif
#endif

static int
#ifdef __BORLANDC__
_RTLENTRYF
#endif
rep_compare __ARGS((const void *s1, const void *s2));

/*
 * Function given to qsort() to sort the REP items on "from" string.
 */
    static int
#ifdef __BORLANDC__
_RTLENTRYF
#endif
rep_compare(s1, s2)
    const void  *s1;
    const void  *s2;
{
    fromto_T    *p1 = (fromto_T *)s1;
    fromto_T    *p2 = (fromto_T *)s2;

    return STRCMP(p1->ft_from, p2->ft_from);
}

/*
 * Write the Vim .spl file "fname".
 * Return FAIL or OK;
 */
    static int
write_vim_spell(spin, fname)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *fname;
{
    FILE        *fd;
    int         regionmask;
    int         round;
    wordnode_T  *tree;
    int         nodecount;
    int         i;
    int         l;
    garray_T    *gap;
    fromto_T    *ftp;
    char_u      *p;
    int         rr;
    int         retval = OK;

    fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "w");
    if (fd == NULL)
    {
        EMSG2(_(e_notopen), fname);
        return FAIL;
    }

    /* <HEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr> */
                                                            /* <fileID> */
    if (fwrite(VIMSPELLMAGIC, VIMSPELLMAGICL, (size_t)1, fd) != 1)
    {
        EMSG(_(e_write));
        retval = FAIL;
    }
    putc(VIMSPELLVERSION, fd);                              /* <versionnr> */

    /*
     * <SECTIONS>: <section> ... <sectionend>
     */

    /* SN_INFO: <infotext> */
    if (spin->si_info != NULL)
    {
        putc(SN_INFO, fd);                              /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */

        i = (int)STRLEN(spin->si_info);
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)i, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */
        fwrite(spin->si_info, (size_t)i, (size_t)1, fd); /* <infotext> */
    }

    /* SN_REGION: <regionname> ...
     * Write the region names only if there is more than one. */
    if (spin->si_region_count > 1)
    {
        putc(SN_REGION, fd);                            /* <sectionID> */
        putc(SNF_REQUIRED, fd);                         /* <sectionflags> */
        l = spin->si_region_count * 2;
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)l, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */
        fwrite(spin->si_region_name, (size_t)l, (size_t)1, fd);
                                                        /* <regionname> ... */
        regionmask = (1 << spin->si_region_count) - 1;
    }
    else
        regionmask = 0;

    /* SN_CHARFLAGS: <charflagslen> <charflags> <folcharslen> <folchars>
     *
     * The table with character flags and the table for case folding.
     * This makes sure the same characters are recognized as word characters
     * when generating an when using a spell file.
     * Skip this for ASCII, the table may conflict with the one used for
     * 'encoding'.
     * Also skip this for an .add.spl file, the main spell file must contain
     * the table (avoids that it conflicts).  File is shorter too.
     */
    if (!spin->si_ascii && !spin->si_add)
    {
        char_u  folchars[128 * 8];
        int     flags;

        putc(SN_CHARFLAGS, fd);                         /* <sectionID> */
        putc(SNF_REQUIRED, fd);                         /* <sectionflags> */

        /* Form the <folchars> string first, we need to know its length. */
        l = 0;
        for (i = 128; i < 256; ++i)
        {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
                l += mb_char2bytes(spelltab.st_fold[i], folchars + l);
            else
#endif
                folchars[l++] = spelltab.st_fold[i];
        }
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)(1 + 128 + 2 + l), 4);    /* <sectionlen> */

        fputc(128, fd);                                 /* <charflagslen> */
        for (i = 128; i < 256; ++i)
        {
            flags = 0;
            if (spelltab.st_isw[i])
                flags |= CF_WORD;
            if (spelltab.st_isu[i])
                flags |= CF_UPPER;
            fputc(flags, fd);                           /* <charflags> */
        }

        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)l, 2);                    /* <folcharslen> */
        fwrite(folchars, (size_t)l, (size_t)1, fd);     /* <folchars> */
    }

    /* SN_MIDWORD: <midword> */
    if (spin->si_midword != NULL)
    {
        putc(SN_MIDWORD, fd);                           /* <sectionID> */
        putc(SNF_REQUIRED, fd);                         /* <sectionflags> */

        i = (int)STRLEN(spin->si_midword);
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)i, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */
        fwrite(spin->si_midword, (size_t)i, (size_t)1, fd); /* <midword> */
    }

    /* SN_PREFCOND: <prefcondcnt> <prefcond> ... */
    if (spin->si_prefcond.ga_len > 0)
    {
        putc(SN_PREFCOND, fd);                          /* <sectionID> */
        putc(SNF_REQUIRED, fd);                         /* <sectionflags> */

        l = write_spell_prefcond(NULL, &spin->si_prefcond);
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)l, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */

        write_spell_prefcond(fd, &spin->si_prefcond);
    }

    /* SN_REP: <repcount> <rep> ...
     * SN_SAL: <salflags> <salcount> <sal> ...
     * SN_REPSAL: <repcount> <rep> ... */

    /* round 1: SN_REP section
     * round 2: SN_SAL section (unless SN_SOFO is used)
     * round 3: SN_REPSAL section */
    for (round = 1; round <= 3; ++round)
    {
        if (round == 1)
            gap = &spin->si_rep;
        else if (round == 2)
        {
            /* Don't write SN_SAL when using a SN_SOFO section */
            if (spin->si_sofofr != NULL && spin->si_sofoto != NULL)
                continue;
            gap = &spin->si_sal;
        }
        else
            gap = &spin->si_repsal;

        /* Don't write the section if there are no items. */
        if (gap->ga_len == 0)
            continue;

        /* Sort the REP/REPSAL items. */
        if (round != 2)
            qsort(gap->ga_data, (size_t)gap->ga_len,
                                               sizeof(fromto_T), rep_compare);

        i = round == 1 ? SN_REP : (round == 2 ? SN_SAL : SN_REPSAL);
        putc(i, fd);                                    /* <sectionID> */

        /* This is for making suggestions, section is not required. */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */

        /* Compute the length of what follows. */
        l = 2;      /* count <repcount> or <salcount> */
        for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; ++i)
        {
            ftp = &((fromto_T *)gap->ga_data)[i];
            l += 1 + (int)STRLEN(ftp->ft_from);  /* count <*fromlen> and <*from> */
            l += 1 + (int)STRLEN(ftp->ft_to);    /* count <*tolen> and <*to> */
        }
        if (round == 2)
            ++l;        /* count <salflags> */
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)l, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */

        if (round == 2)
        {
            i = 0;
            if (spin->si_followup)
                i |= SAL_F0LLOWUP;
            if (spin->si_collapse)
                i |= SAL_COLLAPSE;
            if (spin->si_rem_accents)
                i |= SAL_REM_ACCENTS;
            putc(i, fd);                        /* <salflags> */
        }

        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)gap->ga_len, 2);  /* <repcount> or <salcount> */
        for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; ++i)
        {
            /* <rep> : <repfromlen> <repfrom> <reptolen> <repto> */
            /* <sal> : <salfromlen> <salfrom> <saltolen> <salto> */
            ftp = &((fromto_T *)gap->ga_data)[i];
            for (rr = 1; rr <= 2; ++rr)
            {
                p = rr == 1 ? ftp->ft_from : ftp->ft_to;
                l = (int)STRLEN(p);
                putc(l, fd);
                fwrite(p, l, (size_t)1, fd);
            }
        }

    }

    /* SN_SOFO: <sofofromlen> <sofofrom> <sofotolen> <sofoto>
     * This is for making suggestions, section is not required. */
    if (spin->si_sofofr != NULL && spin->si_sofoto != NULL)
    {
        putc(SN_SOFO, fd);                              /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */

        l = (int)STRLEN(spin->si_sofofr);
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)(l + STRLEN(spin->si_sofoto) + 4), 4);
                                                        /* <sectionlen> */

        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)l, 2);                    /* <sofofromlen> */
        fwrite(spin->si_sofofr, l, (size_t)1, fd);      /* <sofofrom> */

        l = (int)STRLEN(spin->si_sofoto);
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)l, 2);                    /* <sofotolen> */
        fwrite(spin->si_sofoto, l, (size_t)1, fd);      /* <sofoto> */
    }

    /* SN_WORDS: <word> ...
     * This is for making suggestions, section is not required. */
    if (spin->si_commonwords.ht_used > 0)
    {
        putc(SN_WORDS, fd);                             /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */

        /* round 1: count the bytes
         * round 2: write the bytes */
        for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round)
        {
            int         todo;
            int         len = 0;
            hashitem_T  *hi;

            todo = (int)spin->si_commonwords.ht_used;
            for (hi = spin->si_commonwords.ht_array; todo > 0; ++hi)
                if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
                {
                    l = (int)STRLEN(hi->hi_key) + 1;
                    len += l;
                    if (round == 2)                     /* <word> */
                        fwrite(hi->hi_key, (size_t)l, (size_t)1, fd);
                    --todo;
                }
            if (round == 1)
                put_bytes(fd, (long_u)len, 4);          /* <sectionlen> */
        }
    }

    /* SN_MAP: <mapstr>
     * This is for making suggestions, section is not required. */
    if (spin->si_map.ga_len > 0)
    {
        putc(SN_MAP, fd);                               /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */
        l = spin->si_map.ga_len;
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)l, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */
        fwrite(spin->si_map.ga_data, (size_t)l, (size_t)1, fd);
                                                        /* <mapstr> */
    }

    /* SN_SUGFILE: <timestamp>
     * This is used to notify that a .sug file may be available and at the
     * same time allows for checking that a .sug file that is found matches
     * with this .spl file.  That's because the word numbers must be exactly
     * right. */
    if (!spin->si_nosugfile
            && (spin->si_sal.ga_len > 0
                     || (spin->si_sofofr != NULL && spin->si_sofoto != NULL)))
    {
        putc(SN_SUGFILE, fd);                           /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)8, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */

        /* Set si_sugtime and write it to the file. */
        spin->si_sugtime = time(NULL);
        put_sugtime(spin, fd);                          /* <timestamp> */
    }

    /* SN_NOSPLITSUGS: nothing
     * This is used to notify that no suggestions with word splits are to be
     * made. */
    if (spin->si_nosplitsugs)
    {
        putc(SN_NOSPLITSUGS, fd);                       /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)0, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */
    }

    /* SN_COMPOUND: compound info.
     * We don't mark it required, when not supported all compound words will
     * be bad words. */
    if (spin->si_compflags != NULL)
    {
        putc(SN_COMPOUND, fd);                          /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */

        l = (int)STRLEN(spin->si_compflags);
        for (i = 0; i < spin->si_comppat.ga_len; ++i)
            l += (int)STRLEN(((char_u **)(spin->si_comppat.ga_data))[i]) + 1;
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)(l + 7), 4);              /* <sectionlen> */

        putc(spin->si_compmax, fd);                     /* <compmax> */
        putc(spin->si_compminlen, fd);                  /* <compminlen> */
        putc(spin->si_compsylmax, fd);                  /* <compsylmax> */
        putc(0, fd);            /* for Vim 7.0b compatibility */
        putc(spin->si_compoptions, fd);                 /* <compoptions> */
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)spin->si_comppat.ga_len, 2);
                                                        /* <comppatcount> */
        for (i = 0; i < spin->si_comppat.ga_len; ++i)
        {
            p = ((char_u **)(spin->si_comppat.ga_data))[i];
            putc((int)STRLEN(p), fd);                   /* <comppatlen> */
            fwrite(p, (size_t)STRLEN(p), (size_t)1, fd);/* <comppattext> */
        }
                                                        /* <compflags> */
        fwrite(spin->si_compflags, (size_t)STRLEN(spin->si_compflags),
                                                               (size_t)1, fd);
    }

    /* SN_NOBREAK: NOBREAK flag */
    if (spin->si_nobreak)
    {
        putc(SN_NOBREAK, fd);                           /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */

        /* It's empty, the presence of the section flags the feature. */
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)0, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */
    }

    /* SN_SYLLABLE: syllable info.
     * We don't mark it required, when not supported syllables will not be
     * counted. */
    if (spin->si_syllable != NULL)
    {
        putc(SN_SYLLABLE, fd);                          /* <sectionID> */
        putc(0, fd);                                    /* <sectionflags> */

        l = (int)STRLEN(spin->si_syllable);
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)l, 4);                    /* <sectionlen> */
        fwrite(spin->si_syllable, (size_t)l, (size_t)1, fd); /* <syllable> */
    }

    /* end of <SECTIONS> */
    putc(SN_END, fd);                                   /* <sectionend> */


    /*
     * <LWORDTREE>  <KWORDTREE>  <PREFIXTREE>
     */
    spin->si_memtot = 0;
    for (round = 1; round <= 3; ++round)
    {
        if (round == 1)
            tree = spin->si_foldroot->wn_sibling;
        else if (round == 2)
            tree = spin->si_keeproot->wn_sibling;
        else
            tree = spin->si_prefroot->wn_sibling;

        /* Clear the index and wnode fields in the tree. */
        clear_node(tree);

        /* Count the number of nodes.  Needed to be able to allocate the
         * memory when reading the nodes.  Also fills in index for shared
         * nodes. */
        nodecount = put_node(NULL, tree, 0, regionmask, round == 3);

        /* number of nodes in 4 bytes */
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)nodecount, 4);    /* <nodecount> */
        spin->si_memtot += nodecount + nodecount * sizeof(int);

        /* Write the nodes. */
        (void)put_node(fd, tree, 0, regionmask, round == 3);
    }

    /* Write another byte to check for errors. */
    if (putc(0, fd) == EOF)
        retval = FAIL;

    if (fclose(fd) == EOF)
        retval = FAIL;

    return retval;
}

/*
 * Clear the index and wnode fields of "node", it siblings and its
 * children.  This is needed because they are a union with other items to save
 * space.
 */
    static void
clear_node(node)
    wordnode_T  *node;
{
    wordnode_T  *np;

    if (node != NULL)
        for (np = node; np != NULL; np = np->wn_sibling)
        {
            np->wn_u1.index = 0;
            np->wn_u2.wnode = NULL;

            if (np->wn_byte != NUL)
                clear_node(np->wn_child);
        }
}


/*
 * Dump a word tree at node "node".
 *
 * This first writes the list of possible bytes (siblings).  Then for each
 * byte recursively write the children.
 *
 * NOTE: The code here must match the code in read_tree_node(), since
 * assumptions are made about the indexes (so that we don't have to write them
 * in the file).
 *
 * Returns the number of nodes used.
 */
    static int
put_node(fd, node, idx, regionmask, prefixtree)
    FILE        *fd;            /* NULL when only counting */
    wordnode_T  *node;
    int         idx;
    int         regionmask;
    int         prefixtree;     /* TRUE for PREFIXTREE */
{
    int         newindex = idx;
    int         siblingcount = 0;
    wordnode_T  *np;
    int         flags;

    /* If "node" is zero the tree is empty. */
    if (node == NULL)
        return 0;

    /* Store the index where this node is written. */
    node->wn_u1.index = idx;

    /* Count the number of siblings. */
    for (np = node; np != NULL; np = np->wn_sibling)
        ++siblingcount;

    /* Write the sibling count. */
    if (fd != NULL)
        putc(siblingcount, fd);                         /* <siblingcount> */

    /* Write each sibling byte and optionally extra info. */
    for (np = node; np != NULL; np = np->wn_sibling)
    {
        if (np->wn_byte == 0)
        {
            if (fd != NULL)
            {
                /* For a NUL byte (end of word) write the flags etc. */
                if (prefixtree)
                {
                    /* In PREFIXTREE write the required affixID and the
                     * associated condition nr (stored in wn_region).  The
                     * byte value is misused to store the "rare" and "not
                     * combining" flags */
                    if (np->wn_flags == (short_u)PFX_FLAGS)
                        putc(BY_NOFLAGS, fd);           /* <byte> */
                    else
                    {
                        putc(BY_FLAGS, fd);             /* <byte> */
                        putc(np->wn_flags, fd);         /* <pflags> */
                    }
                    putc(np->wn_affixID, fd);           /* <affixID> */
                    put_bytes(fd, (long_u)np->wn_region, 2); /* <prefcondnr> */
                }
                else
                {
                    /* For word trees we write the flag/region items. */
                    flags = np->wn_flags;
                    if (regionmask != 0 && np->wn_region != regionmask)
                        flags |= WF_REGION;
                    if (np->wn_affixID != 0)
                        flags |= WF_AFX;
                    if (flags == 0)
                    {
                        /* word without flags or region */
                        putc(BY_NOFLAGS, fd);                   /* <byte> */
                    }
                    else
                    {
                        if (np->wn_flags >= 0x100)
                        {
                            putc(BY_FLAGS2, fd);                /* <byte> */
                            putc(flags, fd);                    /* <flags> */
                            putc((unsigned)flags >> 8, fd);     /* <flags2> */
                        }
                        else
                        {
                            putc(BY_FLAGS, fd);                 /* <byte> */
                            putc(flags, fd);                    /* <flags> */
                        }
                        if (flags & WF_REGION)
                            putc(np->wn_region, fd);            /* <region> */
                        if (flags & WF_AFX)
                            putc(np->wn_affixID, fd);           /* <affixID> */
                    }
                }
            }
        }
        else
        {
            if (np->wn_child->wn_u1.index != 0
                                         && np->wn_child->wn_u2.wnode != node)
            {
                /* The child is written elsewhere, write the reference. */
                if (fd != NULL)
                {
                    putc(BY_INDEX, fd);                 /* <byte> */
                                                        /* <nodeidx> */
                    put_bytes(fd, (long_u)np->wn_child->wn_u1.index, 3);
                }
            }
            else if (np->wn_child->wn_u2.wnode == NULL)
                /* We will write the child below and give it an index. */
                np->wn_child->wn_u2.wnode = node;

            if (fd != NULL)
                if (putc(np->wn_byte, fd) == EOF) /* <byte> or <xbyte> */
                {
                    EMSG(_(e_write));
                    return 0;
                }
        }
    }

    /* Space used in the array when reading: one for each sibling and one for
     * the count. */
    newindex += siblingcount + 1;

    /* Recursively dump the children of each sibling. */
    for (np = node; np != NULL; np = np->wn_sibling)
        if (np->wn_byte != 0 && np->wn_child->wn_u2.wnode == node)
            newindex = put_node(fd, np->wn_child, newindex, regionmask,
                                                                  prefixtree);

    return newindex;
}


/*
 * ":mkspell [-ascii] outfile  infile ..."
 * ":mkspell [-ascii] addfile"
 */
    void
ex_mkspell(eap)
    exarg_T *eap;
{
    int         fcount;
    char_u      **fnames;
    char_u      *arg = eap->arg;
    int         ascii = FALSE;

    if (STRNCMP(arg, "-ascii", 6) == 0)
    {
        ascii = TRUE;
        arg = skipwhite(arg + 6);
    }

    /* Expand all the remaining arguments (e.g., $VIMRUNTIME). */
    if (get_arglist_exp(arg, &fcount, &fnames) == OK)
    {
        mkspell(fcount, fnames, ascii, eap->forceit, FALSE);
        FreeWild(fcount, fnames);
    }
}

/*
 * Create the .sug file.
 * Uses the soundfold info in "spin".
 * Writes the file with the name "wfname", with ".spl" changed to ".sug".
 */
    static void
spell_make_sugfile(spin, wfname)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *wfname;
{
    char_u      fname[MAXPATHL];
    int         len;
    slang_T     *slang;
    int         free_slang = FALSE;

    /*
     * Read back the .spl file that was written.  This fills the required
     * info for soundfolding.  This also uses less memory than the
     * pointer-linked version of the trie.  And it avoids having two versions
     * of the code for the soundfolding stuff.
     * It might have been done already by spell_reload_one().
     */
    for (slang = first_lang; slang != NULL; slang = slang->sl_next)
        if (fullpathcmp(wfname, slang->sl_fname, FALSE) == FPC_SAME)
            break;
    if (slang == NULL)
    {
        spell_message(spin, (char_u *)_("Reading back spell file..."));
        slang = spell_load_file(wfname, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
        if (slang == NULL)
            return;
        free_slang = TRUE;
    }

    /*
     * Clear the info in "spin" that is used.
     */
    spin->si_blocks = NULL;
    spin->si_blocks_cnt = 0;
    spin->si_compress_cnt = 0;      /* will stay at 0 all the time*/
    spin->si_free_count = 0;
    spin->si_first_free = NULL;
    spin->si_foldwcount = 0;

    /*
     * Go through the trie of good words, soundfold each word and add it to
     * the soundfold trie.
     */
    spell_message(spin, (char_u *)_("Performing soundfolding..."));
    if (sug_filltree(spin, slang) == FAIL)
        goto theend;

    /*
     * Create the table which links each soundfold word with a list of the
     * good words it may come from.  Creates buffer "spin->si_spellbuf".
     * This also removes the wordnr from the NUL byte entries to make
     * compression possible.
     */
    if (sug_maketable(spin) == FAIL)
        goto theend;

    smsg((char_u *)_("Number of words after soundfolding: %ld"),
                                 (long)spin->si_spellbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count);

    /*
     * Compress the soundfold trie.
     */
    spell_message(spin, (char_u *)_(msg_compressing));
    wordtree_compress(spin, spin->si_foldroot);

    /*
     * Write the .sug file.
     * Make the file name by changing ".spl" to ".sug".
     */
    STRCPY(fname, wfname);
    len = (int)STRLEN(fname);
    fname[len - 2] = 'u';
    fname[len - 1] = 'g';
    sug_write(spin, fname);

theend:
    if (free_slang)
        slang_free(slang);
    free_blocks(spin->si_blocks);
    close_spellbuf(spin->si_spellbuf);
}

/*
 * Build the soundfold trie for language "slang".
 */
    static int
sug_filltree(spin, slang)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    slang_T     *slang;
{
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;
    int         depth;
    idx_T       arridx[MAXWLEN];
    int         curi[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      tword[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      tsalword[MAXWLEN];
    int         c;
    idx_T       n;
    unsigned    words_done = 0;
    int         wordcount[MAXWLEN];

    /* We use si_foldroot for the souldfolded trie. */
    spin->si_foldroot = wordtree_alloc(spin);
    if (spin->si_foldroot == NULL)
        return FAIL;

    /* let tree_add_word() know we're adding to the soundfolded tree */
    spin->si_sugtree = TRUE;

    /*
     * Go through the whole case-folded tree, soundfold each word and put it
     * in the trie.
     */
    byts = slang->sl_fbyts;
    idxs = slang->sl_fidxs;

    arridx[0] = 0;
    curi[0] = 1;
    wordcount[0] = 0;

    depth = 0;
    while (depth >= 0 && !got_int)
    {
        if (curi[depth] > byts[arridx[depth]])
        {
            /* Done all bytes at this node, go up one level. */
            idxs[arridx[depth]] = wordcount[depth];
            if (depth > 0)
                wordcount[depth - 1] += wordcount[depth];

            --depth;
            line_breakcheck();
        }
        else
        {

            /* Do one more byte at this node. */
            n = arridx[depth] + curi[depth];
            ++curi[depth];

            c = byts[n];
            if (c == 0)
            {
                /* Sound-fold the word. */
                tword[depth] = NUL;
                spell_soundfold(slang, tword, TRUE, tsalword);

                /* We use the "flags" field for the MSB of the wordnr,
                 * "region" for the LSB of the wordnr.  */
                if (tree_add_word(spin, tsalword, spin->si_foldroot,
                                words_done >> 16, words_done & 0xffff,
                                                           0) == FAIL)
                    return FAIL;

                ++words_done;
                ++wordcount[depth];

                /* Reset the block count each time to avoid compression
                 * kicking in. */
                spin->si_blocks_cnt = 0;

                /* Skip over any other NUL bytes (same word with different
                 * flags). */
                while (byts[n + 1] == 0)
                {
                    ++n;
                    ++curi[depth];
                }
            }
            else
            {
                /* Normal char, go one level deeper. */
                tword[depth++] = c;
                arridx[depth] = idxs[n];
                curi[depth] = 1;
                wordcount[depth] = 0;
            }
        }
    }

    smsg((char_u *)_("Total number of words: %d"), words_done);

    return OK;
}

/*
 * Make the table that links each word in the soundfold trie to the words it
 * can be produced from.
 * This is not unlike lines in a file, thus use a memfile to be able to access
 * the table efficiently.
 * Returns FAIL when out of memory.
 */
    static int
sug_maketable(spin)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
{
    garray_T    ga;
    int         res = OK;

    /* Allocate a buffer, open a memline for it and create the swap file
     * (uses a temp file, not a .swp file). */
    spin->si_spellbuf = open_spellbuf();
    if (spin->si_spellbuf == NULL)
        return FAIL;

    /* Use a buffer to store the line info, avoids allocating many small
     * pieces of memory. */
    ga_init2(&ga, 1, 100);

    /* recursively go through the tree */
    if (sug_filltable(spin, spin->si_foldroot->wn_sibling, 0, &ga) == -1)
        res = FAIL;

    ga_clear(&ga);
    return res;
}

/*
 * Fill the table for one node and its children.
 * Returns the wordnr at the start of the node.
 * Returns -1 when out of memory.
 */
    static int
sug_filltable(spin, node, startwordnr, gap)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    wordnode_T  *node;
    int         startwordnr;
    garray_T    *gap;       /* place to store line of numbers */
{
    wordnode_T  *p, *np;
    int         wordnr = startwordnr;
    int         nr;
    int         prev_nr;

    for (p = node; p != NULL; p = p->wn_sibling)
    {
        if (p->wn_byte == NUL)
        {
            gap->ga_len = 0;
            prev_nr = 0;
            for (np = p; np != NULL && np->wn_byte == NUL; np = np->wn_sibling)
            {
                if (ga_grow(gap, 10) == FAIL)
                    return -1;

                nr = (np->wn_flags << 16) + (np->wn_region & 0xffff);
                /* Compute the offset from the previous nr and store the
                 * offset in a way that it takes a minimum number of bytes.
                 * It's a bit like utf-8, but without the need to mark
                 * following bytes. */
                nr -= prev_nr;
                prev_nr += nr;
                gap->ga_len += offset2bytes(nr,
                                         (char_u *)gap->ga_data + gap->ga_len);
            }

            /* add the NUL byte */
            ((char_u *)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len++] = NUL;

            if (ml_append_buf(spin->si_spellbuf, (linenr_T)wordnr,
                                     gap->ga_data, gap->ga_len, TRUE) == FAIL)
                return -1;
            ++wordnr;

            /* Remove extra NUL entries, we no longer need them. We don't
             * bother freeing the nodes, the won't be reused anyway. */
            while (p->wn_sibling != NULL && p->wn_sibling->wn_byte == NUL)
                p->wn_sibling = p->wn_sibling->wn_sibling;

            /* Clear the flags on the remaining NUL node, so that compression
             * works a lot better. */
            p->wn_flags = 0;
            p->wn_region = 0;
        }
        else
        {
            wordnr = sug_filltable(spin, p->wn_child, wordnr, gap);
            if (wordnr == -1)
                return -1;
        }
    }
    return wordnr;
}

/*
 * Convert an offset into a minimal number of bytes.
 * Similar to utf_char2byters, but use 8 bits in followup bytes and avoid NUL
 * bytes.
 */
    static int
offset2bytes(nr, buf)
    int     nr;
    char_u  *buf;
{
    int     rem;
    int     b1, b2, b3, b4;

    /* Split the number in parts of base 255.  We need to avoid NUL bytes. */
    b1 = nr % 255 + 1;
    rem = nr / 255;
    b2 = rem % 255 + 1;
    rem = rem / 255;
    b3 = rem % 255 + 1;
    b4 = rem / 255 + 1;

    if (b4 > 1 || b3 > 0x1f)    /* 4 bytes */
    {
        buf[0] = 0xe0 + b4;
        buf[1] = b3;
        buf[2] = b2;
        buf[3] = b1;
        return 4;
    }
    if (b3 > 1 || b2 > 0x3f )   /* 3 bytes */
    {
        buf[0] = 0xc0 + b3;
        buf[1] = b2;
        buf[2] = b1;
        return 3;
    }
    if (b2 > 1 || b1 > 0x7f )   /* 2 bytes */
    {
        buf[0] = 0x80 + b2;
        buf[1] = b1;
        return 2;
    }
                                /* 1 byte */
    buf[0] = b1;
    return 1;
}

/*
 * Opposite of offset2bytes().
 * "pp" points to the bytes and is advanced over it.
 * Returns the offset.
 */
    static int
bytes2offset(pp)
    char_u      **pp;
{
    char_u      *p = *pp;
    int         nr;
    int         c;

    c = *p++;
    if ((c & 0x80) == 0x00)             /* 1 byte */
    {
        nr = c - 1;
    }
    else if ((c & 0xc0) == 0x80)        /* 2 bytes */
    {
        nr = (c & 0x3f) - 1;
        nr = nr * 255 + (*p++ - 1);
    }
    else if ((c & 0xe0) == 0xc0)        /* 3 bytes */
    {
        nr = (c & 0x1f) - 1;
        nr = nr * 255 + (*p++ - 1);
        nr = nr * 255 + (*p++ - 1);
    }
    else                                /* 4 bytes */
    {
        nr = (c & 0x0f) - 1;
        nr = nr * 255 + (*p++ - 1);
        nr = nr * 255 + (*p++ - 1);
        nr = nr * 255 + (*p++ - 1);
    }

    *pp = p;
    return nr;
}

/*
 * Write the .sug file in "fname".
 */
    static void
sug_write(spin, fname)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *fname;
{
    FILE        *fd;
    wordnode_T  *tree;
    int         nodecount;
    int         wcount;
    char_u      *line;
    linenr_T    lnum;
    int         len;

    /* Create the file.  Note that an existing file is silently overwritten! */
    fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "w");
    if (fd == NULL)
    {
        EMSG2(_(e_notopen), fname);
        return;
    }

    vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE,
                                  _("Writing suggestion file %s ..."), fname);
    spell_message(spin, IObuff);

    /*
     * <SUGHEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr> <timestamp>
     */
    if (fwrite(VIMSUGMAGIC, VIMSUGMAGICL, (size_t)1, fd) != 1) /* <fileID> */
    {
        EMSG(_(e_write));
        goto theend;
    }
    putc(VIMSUGVERSION, fd);                            /* <versionnr> */

    /* Write si_sugtime to the file. */
    put_sugtime(spin, fd);                              /* <timestamp> */

    /*
     * <SUGWORDTREE>
     */
    spin->si_memtot = 0;
    tree = spin->si_foldroot->wn_sibling;

    /* Clear the index and wnode fields in the tree. */
    clear_node(tree);

    /* Count the number of nodes.  Needed to be able to allocate the
     * memory when reading the nodes.  Also fills in index for shared
     * nodes. */
    nodecount = put_node(NULL, tree, 0, 0, FALSE);

    /* number of nodes in 4 bytes */
    put_bytes(fd, (long_u)nodecount, 4);        /* <nodecount> */
    spin->si_memtot += nodecount + nodecount * sizeof(int);

    /* Write the nodes. */
    (void)put_node(fd, tree, 0, 0, FALSE);

    /*
     * <SUGTABLE>: <sugwcount> <sugline> ...
     */
    wcount = spin->si_spellbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count;
    put_bytes(fd, (long_u)wcount, 4);   /* <sugwcount> */

    for (lnum = 1; lnum <= (linenr_T)wcount; ++lnum)
    {
        /* <sugline>: <sugnr> ... NUL */
        line = ml_get_buf(spin->si_spellbuf, lnum, FALSE);
        len = (int)STRLEN(line) + 1;
        if (fwrite(line, (size_t)len, (size_t)1, fd) == 0)
        {
            EMSG(_(e_write));
            goto theend;
        }
        spin->si_memtot += len;
    }

    /* Write another byte to check for errors. */
    if (putc(0, fd) == EOF)
        EMSG(_(e_write));

    vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE,
                 _("Estimated runtime memory use: %d bytes"), spin->si_memtot);
    spell_message(spin, IObuff);

theend:
    /* close the file */
    fclose(fd);
}

/*
 * Open a spell buffer.  This is a nameless buffer that is not in the buffer
 * list and only contains text lines.  Can use a swapfile to reduce memory
 * use.
 * Most other fields are invalid!  Esp. watch out for string options being
 * NULL and there is no undo info.
 * Returns NULL when out of memory.
 */
    static buf_T *
open_spellbuf()
{
    buf_T       *buf;

    buf = (buf_T *)alloc_clear(sizeof(buf_T));
    if (buf != NULL)
    {
        buf->b_spell = TRUE;
        buf->b_p_swf = TRUE;    /* may create a swap file */
        ml_open(buf);
        ml_open_file(buf);      /* create swap file now */
    }
    return buf;
}

/*
 * Close the buffer used for spell info.
 */
    static void
close_spellbuf(buf)
    buf_T       *buf;
{
    if (buf != NULL)
    {
        ml_close(buf, TRUE);
        vim_free(buf);
    }
}


/*
 * Create a Vim spell file from one or more word lists.
 * "fnames[0]" is the output file name.
 * "fnames[fcount - 1]" is the last input file name.
 * Exception: when "fnames[0]" ends in ".add" it's used as the input file name
 * and ".spl" is appended to make the output file name.
 */
    static void
mkspell(fcount, fnames, ascii, overwrite, added_word)
    int         fcount;
    char_u      **fnames;
    int         ascii;              /* -ascii argument given */
    int         overwrite;          /* overwrite existing output file */
    int         added_word;         /* invoked through "zg" */
{
    char_u      fname[MAXPATHL];
    char_u      wfname[MAXPATHL];
    char_u      **innames;
    int         incount;
    afffile_T   *(afile[8]);
    int         i;
    int         len;
    struct stat st;
    int         error = FALSE;
    spellinfo_T spin;

    vim_memset(&spin, 0, sizeof(spin));
    spin.si_verbose = !added_word;
    spin.si_ascii = ascii;
    spin.si_followup = TRUE;
    spin.si_rem_accents = TRUE;
    ga_init2(&spin.si_rep, (int)sizeof(fromto_T), 20);
    ga_init2(&spin.si_repsal, (int)sizeof(fromto_T), 20);
    ga_init2(&spin.si_sal, (int)sizeof(fromto_T), 20);
    ga_init2(&spin.si_map, (int)sizeof(char_u), 100);
    ga_init2(&spin.si_comppat, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 20);
    ga_init2(&spin.si_prefcond, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 50);
    hash_init(&spin.si_commonwords);
    spin.si_newcompID = 127;    /* start compound ID at first maximum */

    /* default: fnames[0] is output file, following are input files */
    innames = &fnames[1];
    incount = fcount - 1;

    if (fcount >= 1)
    {
        len = (int)STRLEN(fnames[0]);
        if (fcount == 1 && len > 4 && STRCMP(fnames[0] + len - 4, ".add") == 0)
        {
            /* For ":mkspell path/en.latin1.add" output file is
             * "path/en.latin1.add.spl". */
            innames = &fnames[0];
            incount = 1;
            vim_snprintf((char *)wfname, sizeof(wfname), "%s.spl", fnames[0]);
        }
        else if (fcount == 1)
        {
            /* For ":mkspell path/vim" output file is "path/vim.latin1.spl". */
            innames = &fnames[0];
            incount = 1;
            vim_snprintf((char *)wfname, sizeof(wfname), "%s.%s.spl", fnames[0],
                             spin.si_ascii ? (char_u *)"ascii" : spell_enc());
        }
        else if (len > 4 && STRCMP(fnames[0] + len - 4, ".spl") == 0)
        {
            /* Name ends in ".spl", use as the file name. */
            vim_strncpy(wfname, fnames[0], sizeof(wfname) - 1);
        }
        else
            /* Name should be language, make the file name from it. */
            vim_snprintf((char *)wfname, sizeof(wfname), "%s.%s.spl", fnames[0],
                             spin.si_ascii ? (char_u *)"ascii" : spell_enc());

        /* Check for .ascii.spl. */
        if (strstr((char *)gettail(wfname), ".ascii.") != NULL)
            spin.si_ascii = TRUE;

        /* Check for .add.spl. */
        if (strstr((char *)gettail(wfname), ".add.") != NULL)
            spin.si_add = TRUE;
    }

    if (incount <= 0)
        EMSG(_(e_invarg));      /* need at least output and input names */
    else if (vim_strchr(gettail(wfname), '_') != NULL)
        EMSG(_("E751: Output file name must not have region name"));
    else if (incount > 8)
        EMSG(_("E754: Only up to 8 regions supported"));
    else
    {
        /* Check for overwriting before doing things that may take a lot of
         * time. */
        if (!overwrite && mch_stat((char *)wfname, &st) >= 0)
        {
            EMSG(_(e_exists));
            return;
        }
        if (mch_isdir(wfname))
        {
            EMSG2(_(e_isadir2), wfname);
            return;
        }

        /*
         * Init the aff and dic pointers.
         * Get the region names if there are more than 2 arguments.
         */
        for (i = 0; i < incount; ++i)
        {
            afile[i] = NULL;

            if (incount > 1)
            {
                len = (int)STRLEN(innames[i]);
                if (STRLEN(gettail(innames[i])) < 5
                                                || innames[i][len - 3] != '_')
                {
                    EMSG2(_("E755: Invalid region in %s"), innames[i]);
                    return;
                }
                spin.si_region_name[i * 2] = TOLOWER_ASC(innames[i][len - 2]);
                spin.si_region_name[i * 2 + 1] =
                                             TOLOWER_ASC(innames[i][len - 1]);
            }
        }
        spin.si_region_count = incount;

        spin.si_foldroot = wordtree_alloc(&spin);
        spin.si_keeproot = wordtree_alloc(&spin);
        spin.si_prefroot = wordtree_alloc(&spin);
        if (spin.si_foldroot == NULL
                || spin.si_keeproot == NULL
                || spin.si_prefroot == NULL)
        {
            free_blocks(spin.si_blocks);
            return;
        }

        /* When not producing a .add.spl file clear the character table when
         * we encounter one in the .aff file.  This means we dump the current
         * one in the .spl file if the .aff file doesn't define one.  That's
         * better than guessing the contents, the table will match a
         * previously loaded spell file. */
        if (!spin.si_add)
            spin.si_clear_chartab = TRUE;

        /*
         * Read all the .aff and .dic files.
         * Text is converted to 'encoding'.
         * Words are stored in the case-folded and keep-case trees.
         */
        for (i = 0; i < incount && !error; ++i)
        {
            spin.si_conv.vc_type = CONV_NONE;
            spin.si_region = 1 << i;

            vim_snprintf((char *)fname, sizeof(fname), "%s.aff", innames[i]);
            if (mch_stat((char *)fname, &st) >= 0)
            {
                /* Read the .aff file.  Will init "spin->si_conv" based on the
                 * "SET" line. */
                afile[i] = spell_read_aff(&spin, fname);
                if (afile[i] == NULL)
                    error = TRUE;
                else
                {
                    /* Read the .dic file and store the words in the trees. */
                    vim_snprintf((char *)fname, sizeof(fname), "%s.dic",
                                                                  innames[i]);
                    if (spell_read_dic(&spin, fname, afile[i]) == FAIL)
                        error = TRUE;
                }
            }
            else
            {
                /* No .aff file, try reading the file as a word list.  Store
                 * the words in the trees. */
                if (spell_read_wordfile(&spin, innames[i]) == FAIL)
                    error = TRUE;
            }

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            /* Free any conversion stuff. */
            convert_setup(&spin.si_conv, NULL, NULL);
#endif
        }

        if (spin.si_compflags != NULL && spin.si_nobreak)
            MSG(_("Warning: both compounding and NOBREAK specified"));

        if (!error && !got_int)
        {
            /*
             * Combine tails in the tree.
             */
            spell_message(&spin, (char_u *)_(msg_compressing));
            wordtree_compress(&spin, spin.si_foldroot);
            wordtree_compress(&spin, spin.si_keeproot);
            wordtree_compress(&spin, spin.si_prefroot);
        }

        if (!error && !got_int)
        {
            /*
             * Write the info in the spell file.
             */
            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE,
                                      _("Writing spell file %s ..."), wfname);
            spell_message(&spin, IObuff);

            error = write_vim_spell(&spin, wfname) == FAIL;

            spell_message(&spin, (char_u *)_("Done!"));
            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE,
                 _("Estimated runtime memory use: %d bytes"), spin.si_memtot);
            spell_message(&spin, IObuff);

            /*
             * If the file is loaded need to reload it.
             */
            if (!error)
                spell_reload_one(wfname, added_word);
        }

        /* Free the allocated memory. */
        ga_clear(&spin.si_rep);
        ga_clear(&spin.si_repsal);
        ga_clear(&spin.si_sal);
        ga_clear(&spin.si_map);
        ga_clear(&spin.si_comppat);
        ga_clear(&spin.si_prefcond);
        hash_clear_all(&spin.si_commonwords, 0);

        /* Free the .aff file structures. */
        for (i = 0; i < incount; ++i)
            if (afile[i] != NULL)
                spell_free_aff(afile[i]);

        /* Free all the bits and pieces at once. */
        free_blocks(spin.si_blocks);

        /*
         * If there is soundfolding info and no NOSUGFILE item create the
         * .sug file with the soundfolded word trie.
         */
        if (spin.si_sugtime != 0 && !error && !got_int)
            spell_make_sugfile(&spin, wfname);

    }
}

/*
 * Display a message for spell file processing when 'verbose' is set or using
 * ":mkspell".  "str" can be IObuff.
 */
    static void
spell_message(spin, str)
    spellinfo_T *spin;
    char_u      *str;
{
    if (spin->si_verbose || p_verbose > 2)
    {
        if (!spin->si_verbose)
            verbose_enter();
        MSG(str);
        out_flush();
        if (!spin->si_verbose)
            verbose_leave();
    }
}

/*
 * ":[count]spellgood  {word}"
 * ":[count]spellwrong  {word}"
 * ":[count]spellundo  {word}"
 */
    void
ex_spell(eap)
    exarg_T *eap;
{
    spell_add_word(eap->arg, (int)STRLEN(eap->arg), eap->cmdidx == CMD_spellwrong,
                                   eap->forceit ? 0 : (int)eap->line2,
                                   eap->cmdidx == CMD_spellundo);
}

/*
 * Add "word[len]" to 'spellfile' as a good or bad word.
 */
    void
spell_add_word(word, len, bad, idx, undo)
    char_u      *word;
    int         len;
    int         bad;
    int         idx;        /* "zG" and "zW": zero, otherwise index in
                               'spellfile' */
    int         undo;       /* TRUE for "zug", "zuG", "zuw" and "zuW" */
{
    FILE        *fd = NULL;
    buf_T       *buf = NULL;
    int         new_spf = FALSE;
    char_u      *fname;
    char_u      fnamebuf[MAXPATHL];
    char_u      line[MAXWLEN * 2];
    long        fpos, fpos_next = 0;
    int         i;
    char_u      *spf;

    if (idx == 0)           /* use internal wordlist */
    {
        if (int_wordlist == NULL)
        {
            int_wordlist = vim_tempname('s');
            if (int_wordlist == NULL)
                return;
        }
        fname = int_wordlist;
    }
    else
    {
        /* If 'spellfile' isn't set figure out a good default value. */
        if (*curbuf->b_p_spf == NUL)
        {
            init_spellfile();
            new_spf = TRUE;
        }

        if (*curbuf->b_p_spf == NUL)
        {
            EMSG2(_(e_notset), "spellfile");
            return;
        }

        for (spf = curbuf->b_p_spf, i = 1; *spf != NUL; ++i)
        {
            copy_option_part(&spf, fnamebuf, MAXPATHL, ",");
            if (i == idx)
                break;
            if (*spf == NUL)
            {
                EMSGN(_("E765: 'spellfile' does not have %ld entries"), idx);
                return;
            }
        }

        /* Check that the user isn't editing the .add file somewhere. */
        buf = buflist_findname_exp(fnamebuf);
        if (buf != NULL && buf->b_ml.ml_mfp == NULL)
            buf = NULL;
        if (buf != NULL && bufIsChanged(buf))
        {
            EMSG(_(e_bufloaded));
            return;
        }

        fname = fnamebuf;
    }

    if (bad || undo)
    {
        /* When the word appears as good word we need to remove that one,
         * since its flags sort before the one with WF_BANNED. */
        fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "r");
        if (fd != NULL)
        {
            while (!vim_fgets(line, MAXWLEN * 2, fd))
            {
                fpos = fpos_next;
                fpos_next = ftell(fd);
                if (STRNCMP(word, line, len) == 0
                        && (line[len] == '/' || line[len] < ' '))
                {
                    /* Found duplicate word.  Remove it by writing a '#' at
                     * the start of the line.  Mixing reading and writing
                     * doesn't work for all systems, close the file first. */
                    fclose(fd);
                    fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "r+");
                    if (fd == NULL)
                        break;
                    if (fseek(fd, fpos, SEEK_SET) == 0)
                    {
                        fputc('#', fd);
                        if (undo)
                        {
                            home_replace(NULL, fname, NameBuff, MAXPATHL, TRUE);
                            smsg((char_u *)_("Word removed from %s"), NameBuff);
                        }
                    }
                    fseek(fd, fpos_next, SEEK_SET);
                }
            }
            fclose(fd);
        }
    }

    if (!undo)
    {
        fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "a");
        if (fd == NULL && new_spf)
        {
            char_u *p;

            /* We just initialized the 'spellfile' option and can't open the
             * file.  We may need to create the "spell" directory first.  We
             * already checked the runtime directory is writable in
             * init_spellfile(). */
            if (!dir_of_file_exists(fname) && (p = gettail_sep(fname)) != fname)
            {
                int c = *p;

                /* The directory doesn't exist.  Try creating it and opening
                 * the file again. */
                *p = NUL;
                vim_mkdir(fname, 0755);
                *p = c;
                fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "a");
            }
        }

        if (fd == NULL)
            EMSG2(_(e_notopen), fname);
        else
        {
            if (bad)
                fprintf(fd, "%.*s/!\n", len, word);
            else
                fprintf(fd, "%.*s\n", len, word);
            fclose(fd);

            home_replace(NULL, fname, NameBuff, MAXPATHL, TRUE);
            smsg((char_u *)_("Word added to %s"), NameBuff);
        }
    }

    if (fd != NULL)
    {
        /* Update the .add.spl file. */
        mkspell(1, &fname, FALSE, TRUE, TRUE);

        /* If the .add file is edited somewhere, reload it. */
        if (buf != NULL)
            buf_reload(buf, buf->b_orig_mode);

        redraw_all_later(SOME_VALID);
    }
}

/*
 * Initialize 'spellfile' for the current buffer.
 */
    static void
init_spellfile()
{
    char_u      buf[MAXPATHL];
    int         l;
    char_u      *fname;
    char_u      *rtp;
    char_u      *lend;
    int         aspath = FALSE;
    char_u      *lstart = curbuf->b_p_spl;

    if (*curbuf->b_p_spl != NUL && curbuf->b_langp.ga_len > 0)
    {
        /* Find the end of the language name.  Exclude the region.  If there
         * is a path separator remember the start of the tail. */
        for (lend = curbuf->b_p_spl; *lend != NUL
                        && vim_strchr((char_u *)",._", *lend) == NULL; ++lend)
            if (vim_ispathsep(*lend))
            {
                aspath = TRUE;
                lstart = lend + 1;
            }

        /* Loop over all entries in 'runtimepath'.  Use the first one where we
         * are allowed to write. */
        rtp = p_rtp;
        while (*rtp != NUL)
        {
            if (aspath)
                /* Use directory of an entry with path, e.g., for
                 * "/dir/lg.utf-8.spl" use "/dir". */
                vim_strncpy(buf, curbuf->b_p_spl, lstart - curbuf->b_p_spl - 1);
            else
                /* Copy the path from 'runtimepath' to buf[]. */
                copy_option_part(&rtp, buf, MAXPATHL, ",");
            if (filewritable(buf) == 2)
            {
                /* Use the first language name from 'spelllang' and the
                 * encoding used in the first loaded .spl file. */
                if (aspath)
                    vim_strncpy(buf, curbuf->b_p_spl, lend - curbuf->b_p_spl);
                else
                {
                    /* Create the "spell" directory if it doesn't exist yet. */
                    l = (int)STRLEN(buf);
                    vim_snprintf((char *)buf + l, MAXPATHL - l, "/spell");
                    if (!filewritable(buf) != 2)
                        vim_mkdir(buf, 0755);

                    l = (int)STRLEN(buf);
                    vim_snprintf((char *)buf + l, MAXPATHL - l,
                                 "/%.*s", (int)(lend - lstart), lstart);
                }
                l = (int)STRLEN(buf);
                fname = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, 0)->lp_slang->sl_fname;
                vim_snprintf((char *)buf + l, MAXPATHL - l, ".%s.add",
                        fname != NULL
                          && strstr((char *)gettail(fname), ".ascii.") != NULL
                                       ? (char_u *)"ascii" : spell_enc());
                set_option_value((char_u *)"spellfile", 0L, buf, OPT_LOCAL);
                break;
            }
            aspath = FALSE;
        }
    }
}


/*
 * Init the chartab used for spelling for ASCII.
 * EBCDIC is not supported!
 */
    static void
clear_spell_chartab(sp)
    spelltab_T  *sp;
{
    int         i;

    /* Init everything to FALSE. */
    vim_memset(sp->st_isw, FALSE, sizeof(sp->st_isw));
    vim_memset(sp->st_isu, FALSE, sizeof(sp->st_isu));
    for (i = 0; i < 256; ++i)
    {
        sp->st_fold[i] = i;
        sp->st_upper[i] = i;
    }

    /* We include digits.  A word shouldn't start with a digit, but handling
     * that is done separately. */
    for (i = '0'; i <= '9'; ++i)
        sp->st_isw[i] = TRUE;
    for (i = 'A'; i <= 'Z'; ++i)
    {
        sp->st_isw[i] = TRUE;
        sp->st_isu[i] = TRUE;
        sp->st_fold[i] = i + 0x20;
    }
    for (i = 'a'; i <= 'z'; ++i)
    {
        sp->st_isw[i] = TRUE;
        sp->st_upper[i] = i - 0x20;
    }
}

/*
 * Init the chartab used for spelling.  Only depends on 'encoding'.
 * Called once while starting up and when 'encoding' changes.
 * The default is to use isalpha(), but the spell file should define the word
 * characters to make it possible that 'encoding' differs from the current
 * locale.  For utf-8 we don't use isalpha() but our own functions.
 */
    void
init_spell_chartab()
{
    int     i;

    did_set_spelltab = FALSE;
    clear_spell_chartab(&spelltab);
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (enc_dbcs)
    {
        /* DBCS: assume double-wide characters are word characters. */
        for (i = 128; i <= 255; ++i)
            if (MB_BYTE2LEN(i) == 2)
                spelltab.st_isw[i] = TRUE;
    }
    else if (enc_utf8)
    {
        for (i = 128; i < 256; ++i)
        {
            spelltab.st_isu[i] = utf_isupper(i);
            spelltab.st_isw[i] = spelltab.st_isu[i] || utf_islower(i);
            spelltab.st_fold[i] = utf_fold(i);
            spelltab.st_upper[i] = utf_toupper(i);
        }
    }
    else
#endif
    {
        /* Rough guess: use locale-dependent library functions. */
        for (i = 128; i < 256; ++i)
        {
            if (MB_ISUPPER(i))
            {
                spelltab.st_isw[i] = TRUE;
                spelltab.st_isu[i] = TRUE;
                spelltab.st_fold[i] = MB_TOLOWER(i);
            }
            else if (MB_ISLOWER(i))
            {
                spelltab.st_isw[i] = TRUE;
                spelltab.st_upper[i] = MB_TOUPPER(i);
            }
        }
    }
}

/*
 * Set the spell character tables from strings in the affix file.
 */
    static int
set_spell_chartab(fol, low, upp)
    char_u      *fol;
    char_u      *low;
    char_u      *upp;
{
    /* We build the new tables here first, so that we can compare with the
     * previous one. */
    spelltab_T  new_st;
    char_u      *pf = fol, *pl = low, *pu = upp;
    int         f, l, u;

    clear_spell_chartab(&new_st);

    while (*pf != NUL)
    {
        if (*pl == NUL || *pu == NUL)
        {
            EMSG(_(e_affform));
            return FAIL;
        }
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        f = mb_ptr2char_adv(&pf);
        l = mb_ptr2char_adv(&pl);
        u = mb_ptr2char_adv(&pu);
#else
        f = *pf++;
        l = *pl++;
        u = *pu++;
#endif
        /* Every character that appears is a word character. */
        if (f < 256)
            new_st.st_isw[f] = TRUE;
        if (l < 256)
            new_st.st_isw[l] = TRUE;
        if (u < 256)
            new_st.st_isw[u] = TRUE;

        /* if "LOW" and "FOL" are not the same the "LOW" char needs
         * case-folding */
        if (l < 256 && l != f)
        {
            if (f >= 256)
            {
                EMSG(_(e_affrange));
                return FAIL;
            }
            new_st.st_fold[l] = f;
        }

        /* if "UPP" and "FOL" are not the same the "UPP" char needs
         * case-folding, it's upper case and the "UPP" is the upper case of
         * "FOL" . */
        if (u < 256 && u != f)
        {
            if (f >= 256)
            {
                EMSG(_(e_affrange));
                return FAIL;
            }
            new_st.st_fold[u] = f;
            new_st.st_isu[u] = TRUE;
            new_st.st_upper[f] = u;
        }
    }

    if (*pl != NUL || *pu != NUL)
    {
        EMSG(_(e_affform));
        return FAIL;
    }

    return set_spell_finish(&new_st);
}

/*
 * Set the spell character tables from strings in the .spl file.
 */
    static void
set_spell_charflags(flags, cnt, fol)
    char_u      *flags;
    int         cnt;        /* length of "flags" */
    char_u      *fol;
{
    /* We build the new tables here first, so that we can compare with the
     * previous one. */
    spelltab_T  new_st;
    int         i;
    char_u      *p = fol;
    int         c;

    clear_spell_chartab(&new_st);

    for (i = 0; i < 128; ++i)
    {
        if (i < cnt)
        {
            new_st.st_isw[i + 128] = (flags[i] & CF_WORD) != 0;
            new_st.st_isu[i + 128] = (flags[i] & CF_UPPER) != 0;
        }

        if (*p != NUL)
        {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            c = mb_ptr2char_adv(&p);
#else
            c = *p++;
#endif
            new_st.st_fold[i + 128] = c;
            if (i + 128 != c && new_st.st_isu[i + 128] && c < 256)
                new_st.st_upper[c] = i + 128;
        }
    }

    (void)set_spell_finish(&new_st);
}

    static int
set_spell_finish(new_st)
    spelltab_T  *new_st;
{
    int         i;

    if (did_set_spelltab)
    {
        /* check that it's the same table */
        for (i = 0; i < 256; ++i)
        {
            if (spelltab.st_isw[i] != new_st->st_isw[i]
                    || spelltab.st_isu[i] != new_st->st_isu[i]
                    || spelltab.st_fold[i] != new_st->st_fold[i]
                    || spelltab.st_upper[i] != new_st->st_upper[i])
            {
                EMSG(_("E763: Word characters differ between spell files"));
                return FAIL;
            }
        }
    }
    else
    {
        /* copy the new spelltab into the one being used */
        spelltab = *new_st;
        did_set_spelltab = TRUE;
    }

    return OK;
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if "p" points to a word character.
 * As a special case we see "midword" characters as word character when it is
 * followed by a word character.  This finds they'there but not 'they there'.
 * Thus this only works properly when past the first character of the word.
 */
    static int
spell_iswordp(p, buf)
    char_u      *p;
    buf_T       *buf;       /* buffer used */
{
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    char_u      *s;
    int         l;
    int         c;

    if (has_mbyte)
    {
        l = MB_BYTE2LEN(*p);
        s = p;
        if (l == 1)
        {
            /* be quick for ASCII */
            if (buf->b_spell_ismw[*p])
            {
                s = p + 1;              /* skip a mid-word character */
                l = MB_BYTE2LEN(*s);
            }
        }
        else
        {
            c = mb_ptr2char(p);
            if (c < 256 ? buf->b_spell_ismw[c]
                    : (buf->b_spell_ismw_mb != NULL
                           && vim_strchr(buf->b_spell_ismw_mb, c) != NULL))
            {
                s = p + l;
                l = MB_BYTE2LEN(*s);
            }
        }

        c = mb_ptr2char(s);
        if (c > 255)
            return mb_get_class(s) >= 2;
        return spelltab.st_isw[c];
    }
#endif

    return spelltab.st_isw[buf->b_spell_ismw[*p] ? p[1] : p[0]];
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if "p" points to a word character.
 * Unlike spell_iswordp() this doesn't check for "midword" characters.
 */
    static int
spell_iswordp_nmw(p)
    char_u      *p;
{
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    int         c;

    if (has_mbyte)
    {
        c = mb_ptr2char(p);
        if (c > 255)
            return mb_get_class(p) >= 2;
        return spelltab.st_isw[c];
    }
#endif
    return spelltab.st_isw[*p];
}

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
/*
 * Return TRUE if "p" points to a word character.
 * Wide version of spell_iswordp().
 */
    static int
spell_iswordp_w(p, buf)
    int         *p;
    buf_T       *buf;
{
    int         *s;

    if (*p < 256 ? buf->b_spell_ismw[*p]
                 : (buf->b_spell_ismw_mb != NULL
                             && vim_strchr(buf->b_spell_ismw_mb, *p) != NULL))
        s = p + 1;
    else
        s = p;

    if (*s > 255)
    {
        if (enc_utf8)
            return utf_class(*s) >= 2;
        if (enc_dbcs)
            return dbcs_class((unsigned)*s >> 8, *s & 0xff) >= 2;
        return 0;
    }
    return spelltab.st_isw[*s];
}
#endif

/*
 * Write the table with prefix conditions to the .spl file.
 * When "fd" is NULL only count the length of what is written.
 */
    static int
write_spell_prefcond(fd, gap)
    FILE        *fd;
    garray_T    *gap;
{
    int         i;
    char_u      *p;
    int         len;
    int         totlen;

    if (fd != NULL)
        put_bytes(fd, (long_u)gap->ga_len, 2);      /* <prefcondcnt> */

    totlen = 2 + gap->ga_len; /* length of <prefcondcnt> and <condlen> bytes */

    for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; ++i)
    {
        /* <prefcond> : <condlen> <condstr> */
        p = ((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[i];
        if (p != NULL)
        {
            len = (int)STRLEN(p);
            if (fd != NULL)
            {
                fputc(len, fd);
                fwrite(p, (size_t)len, (size_t)1, fd);
            }
            totlen += len;
        }
        else if (fd != NULL)
            fputc(0, fd);
    }

    return totlen;
}

/*
 * Case-fold "str[len]" into "buf[buflen]".  The result is NUL terminated.
 * Uses the character definitions from the .spl file.
 * When using a multi-byte 'encoding' the length may change!
 * Returns FAIL when something wrong.
 */
    static int
spell_casefold(str, len, buf, buflen)
    char_u      *str;
    int         len;
    char_u      *buf;
    int         buflen;
{
    int         i;

    if (len >= buflen)
    {
        buf[0] = NUL;
        return FAIL;            /* result will not fit */
    }

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (has_mbyte)
    {
        int     outi = 0;
        char_u  *p;
        int     c;

        /* Fold one character at a time. */
        for (p = str; p < str + len; )
        {
            if (outi + MB_MAXBYTES > buflen)
            {
                buf[outi] = NUL;
                return FAIL;
            }
            c = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
            outi += mb_char2bytes(SPELL_TOFOLD(c), buf + outi);
        }
        buf[outi] = NUL;
    }
    else
#endif
    {
        /* Be quick for non-multibyte encodings. */
        for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
            buf[i] = spelltab.st_fold[str[i]];
        buf[i] = NUL;
    }

    return OK;
}

/* values for sps_flags */
#define SPS_BEST    1
#define SPS_FAST    2
#define SPS_DOUBLE  4

static int sps_flags = SPS_BEST;        /* flags from 'spellsuggest' */
static int sps_limit = 9999;            /* max nr of suggestions given */

/*
 * Check the 'spellsuggest' option.  Return FAIL if it's wrong.
 * Sets "sps_flags" and "sps_limit".
 */
    int
spell_check_sps()
{
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *s;
    char_u      buf[MAXPATHL];
    int         f;

    sps_flags = 0;
    sps_limit = 9999;

    for (p = p_sps; *p != NUL; )
    {
        copy_option_part(&p, buf, MAXPATHL, ",");

        f = 0;
        if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*buf))
        {
            s = buf;
            sps_limit = getdigits(&s);
            if (*s != NUL && !VIM_ISDIGIT(*s))
                f = -1;
        }
        else if (STRCMP(buf, "best") == 0)
            f = SPS_BEST;
        else if (STRCMP(buf, "fast") == 0)
            f = SPS_FAST;
        else if (STRCMP(buf, "double") == 0)
            f = SPS_DOUBLE;
        else if (STRNCMP(buf, "expr:", 5) != 0
                && STRNCMP(buf, "file:", 5) != 0)
            f = -1;

        if (f == -1 || (sps_flags != 0 && f != 0))
        {
            sps_flags = SPS_BEST;
            sps_limit = 9999;
            return FAIL;
        }
        if (f != 0)
            sps_flags = f;
    }

    if (sps_flags == 0)
        sps_flags = SPS_BEST;

    return OK;
}

/*
 * "z?": Find badly spelled word under or after the cursor.
 * Give suggestions for the properly spelled word.
 * In Visual mode use the highlighted word as the bad word.
 * When "count" is non-zero use that suggestion.
 */
    void
spell_suggest(count)
    int         count;
{
    char_u      *line;
    pos_T       prev_cursor = curwin->w_cursor;
    char_u      wcopy[MAXWLEN + 2];
    char_u      *p;
    int         i;
    int         c;
    suginfo_T   sug;
    suggest_T   *stp;
    int         mouse_used;
    int         need_cap;
    int         limit;
    int         selected = count;
    int         badlen = 0;

    if (no_spell_checking(curwin))
        return;

#ifdef FEAT_VISUAL
    if (VIsual_active)
    {
        /* Use the Visually selected text as the bad word.  But reject
         * a multi-line selection. */
        if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum != VIsual.lnum)
        {
            vim_beep();
            return;
        }
        badlen = (int)curwin->w_cursor.col - (int)VIsual.col;
        if (badlen < 0)
            badlen = -badlen;
        else
            curwin->w_cursor.col = VIsual.col;
        ++badlen;
        end_visual_mode();
    }
    else
#endif
        /* Find the start of the badly spelled word. */
        if (spell_move_to(curwin, FORWARD, TRUE, TRUE, NULL) == 0
            || curwin->w_cursor.col > prev_cursor.col)
    {
        /* No bad word or it starts after the cursor: use the word under the
         * cursor. */
        curwin->w_cursor = prev_cursor;
        line = ml_get_curline();
        p = line + curwin->w_cursor.col;
        /* Backup to before start of word. */
        while (p > line && spell_iswordp_nmw(p))
            mb_ptr_back(line, p);
        /* Forward to start of word. */
        while (*p != NUL && !spell_iswordp_nmw(p))
            mb_ptr_adv(p);

        if (!spell_iswordp_nmw(p))              /* No word found. */
        {
            beep_flush();
            return;
        }
        curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(p - line);
    }

    /* Get the word and its length. */

    /* Figure out if the word should be capitalised. */
    need_cap = check_need_cap(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col);

    line = ml_get_curline();

    /* Get the list of suggestions.  Limit to 'lines' - 2 or the number in
     * 'spellsuggest', whatever is smaller. */
    if (sps_limit > (int)Rows - 2)
        limit = (int)Rows - 2;
    else
        limit = sps_limit;
    spell_find_suggest(line + curwin->w_cursor.col, badlen, &sug, limit,
                                                        TRUE, need_cap, TRUE);

    if (sug.su_ga.ga_len == 0)
        MSG(_("Sorry, no suggestions"));
    else if (count > 0)
    {
        if (count > sug.su_ga.ga_len)
            smsg((char_u *)_("Sorry, only %ld suggestions"),
                                                      (long)sug.su_ga.ga_len);
    }
    else
    {
        vim_free(repl_from);
        repl_from = NULL;
        vim_free(repl_to);
        repl_to = NULL;

#ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
        /* When 'rightleft' is set the list is drawn right-left. */
        cmdmsg_rl = curwin->w_p_rl;
        if (cmdmsg_rl)
            msg_col = Columns - 1;
#endif

        /* List the suggestions. */
        msg_start();
        msg_row = Rows - 1;     /* for when 'cmdheight' > 1 */
        lines_left = Rows;      /* avoid more prompt */
        vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, _("Change \"%.*s\" to:"),
                                                sug.su_badlen, sug.su_badptr);
#ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
        if (cmdmsg_rl && STRNCMP(IObuff, "Change", 6) == 0)
        {
            /* And now the rabbit from the high hat: Avoid showing the
             * untranslated message rightleft. */
            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, ":ot \"%.*s\" egnahC",
                                                sug.su_badlen, sug.su_badptr);
        }
#endif
        msg_puts(IObuff);
        msg_clr_eos();
        msg_putchar('\n');

        msg_scroll = TRUE;
        for (i = 0; i < sug.su_ga.ga_len; ++i)
        {
            stp = &SUG(sug.su_ga, i);

            /* The suggested word may replace only part of the bad word, add
             * the not replaced part. */
            STRCPY(wcopy, stp->st_word);
            if (sug.su_badlen > stp->st_orglen)
                vim_strncpy(wcopy + stp->st_wordlen,
                                               sug.su_badptr + stp->st_orglen,
                                              sug.su_badlen - stp->st_orglen);
            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, "%2d", i + 1);
#ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
            if (cmdmsg_rl)
                rl_mirror(IObuff);
#endif
            msg_puts(IObuff);

            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, " \"%s\"", wcopy);
            msg_puts(IObuff);

            /* The word may replace more than "su_badlen". */
            if (sug.su_badlen < stp->st_orglen)
            {
                vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, _(" < \"%.*s\""),
                                               stp->st_orglen, sug.su_badptr);
                msg_puts(IObuff);
            }

            if (p_verbose > 0)
            {
                /* Add the score. */
                if (sps_flags & (SPS_DOUBLE | SPS_BEST))
                    vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, " (%s%d - %d)",
                        stp->st_salscore ? "s " : "",
                        stp->st_score, stp->st_altscore);
                else
                    vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, " (%d)",
                            stp->st_score);
#ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
                if (cmdmsg_rl)
                    /* Mirror the numbers, but keep the leading space. */
                    rl_mirror(IObuff + 1);
#endif
                msg_advance(30);
                msg_puts(IObuff);
            }
            msg_putchar('\n');
        }

#ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
        cmdmsg_rl = FALSE;
        msg_col = 0;
#endif
        /* Ask for choice. */
        selected = prompt_for_number(&mouse_used);
        if (mouse_used)
            selected -= lines_left;
        lines_left = Rows;      /* avoid more prompt */
    }

    if (selected > 0 && selected <= sug.su_ga.ga_len && u_save_cursor() == OK)
    {
        /* Save the from and to text for :spellrepall. */
        stp = &SUG(sug.su_ga, selected - 1);
        if (sug.su_badlen > stp->st_orglen)
        {
            /* Replacing less than "su_badlen", append the remainder to
             * repl_to. */
            repl_from = vim_strnsave(sug.su_badptr, sug.su_badlen);
            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, "%s%.*s", stp->st_word,
                    sug.su_badlen - stp->st_orglen,
                                              sug.su_badptr + stp->st_orglen);
            repl_to = vim_strsave(IObuff);
        }
        else
        {
            /* Replacing su_badlen or more, use the whole word. */
            repl_from = vim_strnsave(sug.su_badptr, stp->st_orglen);
            repl_to = vim_strsave(stp->st_word);
        }

        /* Replace the word. */
        p = alloc((unsigned)STRLEN(line) - stp->st_orglen + stp->st_wordlen + 1);
        if (p != NULL)
        {
            c = (int)(sug.su_badptr - line);
            mch_memmove(p, line, c);
            STRCPY(p + c, stp->st_word);
            STRCAT(p, sug.su_badptr + stp->st_orglen);
            ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, p, FALSE);
            curwin->w_cursor.col = c;

            /* For redo we use a change-word command. */
            ResetRedobuff();
            AppendToRedobuff((char_u *)"ciw");
            AppendToRedobuffLit(p + c,
                            stp->st_wordlen + sug.su_badlen - stp->st_orglen);
            AppendCharToRedobuff(ESC);

            /* After this "p" may be invalid. */
            changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, c);
        }
    }
    else
        curwin->w_cursor = prev_cursor;

    spell_find_cleanup(&sug);
}

/*
 * Check if the word at line "lnum" column "col" is required to start with a
 * capital.  This uses 'spellcapcheck' of the current buffer.
 */
    static int
check_need_cap(lnum, col)
    linenr_T    lnum;
    colnr_T     col;
{
    int         need_cap = FALSE;
    char_u      *line;
    char_u      *line_copy = NULL;
    char_u      *p;
    colnr_T     endcol;
    regmatch_T  regmatch;

    if (curbuf->b_cap_prog == NULL)
        return FALSE;

    line = ml_get_curline();
    endcol = 0;
    if ((int)(skipwhite(line) - line) >= (int)col)
    {
        /* At start of line, check if previous line is empty or sentence
         * ends there. */
        if (lnum == 1)
            need_cap = TRUE;
        else
        {
            line = ml_get(lnum - 1);
            if (*skipwhite(line) == NUL)
                need_cap = TRUE;
            else
            {
                /* Append a space in place of the line break. */
                line_copy = concat_str(line, (char_u *)" ");
                line = line_copy;
                endcol = (colnr_T)STRLEN(line);
            }
        }
    }
    else
        endcol = col;

    if (endcol > 0)
    {
        /* Check if sentence ends before the bad word. */
        regmatch.regprog = curbuf->b_cap_prog;
        regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE;
        p = line + endcol;
        for (;;)
        {
            mb_ptr_back(line, p);
            if (p == line || spell_iswordp_nmw(p))
                break;
            if (vim_regexec(&regmatch, p, 0)
                                         && regmatch.endp[0] == line + endcol)
            {
                need_cap = TRUE;
                break;
            }
        }
    }

    vim_free(line_copy);

    return need_cap;
}


/*
 * ":spellrepall"
 */
/*ARGSUSED*/
    void
ex_spellrepall(eap)
    exarg_T *eap;
{
    pos_T       pos = curwin->w_cursor;
    char_u      *frompat;
    int         addlen;
    char_u      *line;
    char_u      *p;
    int         save_ws = p_ws;
    linenr_T    prev_lnum = 0;

    if (repl_from == NULL || repl_to == NULL)
    {
        EMSG(_("E752: No previous spell replacement"));
        return;
    }
    addlen = (int)(STRLEN(repl_to) - STRLEN(repl_from));

    frompat = alloc((unsigned)STRLEN(repl_from) + 7);
    if (frompat == NULL)
        return;
    sprintf((char *)frompat, "\\V\\<%s\\>", repl_from);
    p_ws = FALSE;

    sub_nsubs = 0;
    sub_nlines = 0;
    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = 0;
    while (!got_int)
    {
        if (do_search(NULL, '/', frompat, 1L, SEARCH_KEEP) == 0
                                                   || u_save_cursor() == FAIL)
            break;

        /* Only replace when the right word isn't there yet.  This happens
         * when changing "etc" to "etc.". */
        line = ml_get_curline();
        if (addlen <= 0 || STRNCMP(line + curwin->w_cursor.col,
                                               repl_to, STRLEN(repl_to)) != 0)
        {
            p = alloc((unsigned)STRLEN(line) + addlen + 1);
            if (p == NULL)
                break;
            mch_memmove(p, line, curwin->w_cursor.col);
            STRCPY(p + curwin->w_cursor.col, repl_to);
            STRCAT(p, line + curwin->w_cursor.col + STRLEN(repl_from));
            ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, p, FALSE);
            changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col);

            if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum != prev_lnum)
            {
                ++sub_nlines;
                prev_lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
            }
            ++sub_nsubs;
        }
        curwin->w_cursor.col += (colnr_T)STRLEN(repl_to);
    }

    p_ws = save_ws;
    curwin->w_cursor = pos;
    vim_free(frompat);

    if (sub_nsubs == 0)
        EMSG2(_("E753: Not found: %s"), repl_from);
    else
        do_sub_msg(FALSE);
}

/*
 * Find spell suggestions for "word".  Return them in the growarray "*gap" as
 * a list of allocated strings.
 */
    void
spell_suggest_list(gap, word, maxcount, need_cap, interactive)
    garray_T    *gap;
    char_u      *word;
    int         maxcount;       /* maximum nr of suggestions */
    int         need_cap;       /* 'spellcapcheck' matched */
    int         interactive;
{
    suginfo_T   sug;
    int         i;
    suggest_T   *stp;
    char_u      *wcopy;

    spell_find_suggest(word, 0, &sug, maxcount, FALSE, need_cap, interactive);

    /* Make room in "gap". */
    ga_init2(gap, sizeof(char_u *), sug.su_ga.ga_len + 1);
    if (ga_grow(gap, sug.su_ga.ga_len) == OK)
    {
        for (i = 0; i < sug.su_ga.ga_len; ++i)
        {
            stp = &SUG(sug.su_ga, i);

            /* The suggested word may replace only part of "word", add the not
             * replaced part. */
            wcopy = alloc(stp->st_wordlen
                      + (unsigned)STRLEN(sug.su_badptr + stp->st_orglen) + 1);
            if (wcopy == NULL)
                break;
            STRCPY(wcopy, stp->st_word);
            STRCPY(wcopy + stp->st_wordlen, sug.su_badptr + stp->st_orglen);
            ((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len++] = wcopy;
        }
    }

    spell_find_cleanup(&sug);
}

/*
 * Find spell suggestions for the word at the start of "badptr".
 * Return the suggestions in "su->su_ga".
 * The maximum number of suggestions is "maxcount".
 * Note: does use info for the current window.
 * This is based on the mechanisms of Aspell, but completely reimplemented.
 */
    static void
spell_find_suggest(badptr, badlen, su, maxcount, banbadword, need_cap, interactive)
    char_u      *badptr;
    int         badlen;         /* length of bad word or 0 if unknown */
    suginfo_T   *su;
    int         maxcount;
    int         banbadword;     /* don't include badword in suggestions */
    int         need_cap;       /* word should start with capital */
    int         interactive;
{
    hlf_T       attr = HLF_COUNT;
    char_u      buf[MAXPATHL];
    char_u      *p;
    int         do_combine = FALSE;
    char_u      *sps_copy;
#ifdef FEAT_EVAL
    static int  expr_busy = FALSE;
#endif
    int         c;
    int         i;
    langp_T     *lp;

    /*
     * Set the info in "*su".
     */
    vim_memset(su, 0, sizeof(suginfo_T));
    ga_init2(&su->su_ga, (int)sizeof(suggest_T), 10);
    ga_init2(&su->su_sga, (int)sizeof(suggest_T), 10);
    if (*badptr == NUL)
        return;
    hash_init(&su->su_banned);

    su->su_badptr = badptr;
    if (badlen != 0)
        su->su_badlen = badlen;
    else
        su->su_badlen = spell_check(curwin, su->su_badptr, &attr, NULL, FALSE);
    su->su_maxcount = maxcount;
    su->su_maxscore = SCORE_MAXINIT;

    if (su->su_badlen >= MAXWLEN)
        su->su_badlen = MAXWLEN - 1;    /* just in case */
    vim_strncpy(su->su_badword, su->su_badptr, su->su_badlen);
    (void)spell_casefold(su->su_badptr, su->su_badlen,
                                                    su->su_fbadword, MAXWLEN);
    /* get caps flags for bad word */
    su->su_badflags = badword_captype(su->su_badptr,
                                               su->su_badptr + su->su_badlen);
    if (need_cap)
        su->su_badflags |= WF_ONECAP;

    /* Find the default language for sound folding.  We simply use the first
     * one in 'spelllang' that supports sound folding.  That's good for when
     * using multiple files for one language, it's not that bad when mixing
     * languages (e.g., "pl,en"). */
    for (i = 0; i < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++i)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, i);
        if (lp->lp_sallang != NULL)
        {
            su->su_sallang = lp->lp_sallang;
            break;
        }
    }

    /* Soundfold the bad word with the default sound folding, so that we don't
     * have to do this many times. */
    if (su->su_sallang != NULL)
        spell_soundfold(su->su_sallang, su->su_fbadword, TRUE,
                                                          su->su_sal_badword);

    /* If the word is not capitalised and spell_check() doesn't consider the
     * word to be bad then it might need to be capitalised.  Add a suggestion
     * for that. */
    c = PTR2CHAR(su->su_badptr);
    if (!SPELL_ISUPPER(c) && attr == HLF_COUNT)
    {
        make_case_word(su->su_badword, buf, WF_ONECAP);
        add_suggestion(su, &su->su_ga, buf, su->su_badlen, SCORE_ICASE,
                                              0, TRUE, su->su_sallang, FALSE);
    }

    /* Ban the bad word itself.  It may appear in another region. */
    if (banbadword)
        add_banned(su, su->su_badword);

    /* Make a copy of 'spellsuggest', because the expression may change it. */
    sps_copy = vim_strsave(p_sps);
    if (sps_copy == NULL)
        return;

    /* Loop over the items in 'spellsuggest'. */
    for (p = sps_copy; *p != NUL; )
    {
        copy_option_part(&p, buf, MAXPATHL, ",");

        if (STRNCMP(buf, "expr:", 5) == 0)
        {
#ifdef FEAT_EVAL
            /* Evaluate an expression.  Skip this when called recursively,
             * when using spellsuggest() in the expression. */
            if (!expr_busy)
            {
                expr_busy = TRUE;
                spell_suggest_expr(su, buf + 5);
                expr_busy = FALSE;
            }
#endif
        }
        else if (STRNCMP(buf, "file:", 5) == 0)
            /* Use list of suggestions in a file. */
            spell_suggest_file(su, buf + 5);
        else
        {
            /* Use internal method. */
            spell_suggest_intern(su, interactive);
            if (sps_flags & SPS_DOUBLE)
                do_combine = TRUE;
        }
    }

    vim_free(sps_copy);

    if (do_combine)
        /* Combine the two list of suggestions.  This must be done last,
         * because sorting changes the order again. */
        score_combine(su);
}

#ifdef FEAT_EVAL
/*
 * Find suggestions by evaluating expression "expr".
 */
    static void
spell_suggest_expr(su, expr)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    char_u      *expr;
{
    list_T      *list;
    listitem_T  *li;
    int         score;
    char_u      *p;

    /* The work is split up in a few parts to avoid having to export
     * suginfo_T.
     * First evaluate the expression and get the resulting list. */
    list = eval_spell_expr(su->su_badword, expr);
    if (list != NULL)
    {
        /* Loop over the items in the list. */
        for (li = list->lv_first; li != NULL; li = li->li_next)
            if (li->li_tv.v_type == VAR_LIST)
            {
                /* Get the word and the score from the items. */
                score = get_spellword(li->li_tv.vval.v_list, &p);
                if (score >= 0 && score <= su->su_maxscore)
                    add_suggestion(su, &su->su_ga, p, su->su_badlen,
                                       score, 0, TRUE, su->su_sallang, FALSE);
            }
        list_unref(list);
    }

    /* Remove bogus suggestions, sort and truncate at "maxcount". */
    check_suggestions(su, &su->su_ga);
    (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su->su_ga, su->su_maxscore, su->su_maxcount);
}
#endif

/*
 * Find suggestions in file "fname".  Used for "file:" in 'spellsuggest'.
 */
    static void
spell_suggest_file(su, fname)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    char_u      *fname;
{
    FILE        *fd;
    char_u      line[MAXWLEN * 2];
    char_u      *p;
    int         len;
    char_u      cword[MAXWLEN];

    /* Open the file. */
    fd = mch_fopen((char *)fname, "r");
    if (fd == NULL)
    {
        EMSG2(_(e_notopen), fname);
        return;
    }

    /* Read it line by line. */
    while (!vim_fgets(line, MAXWLEN * 2, fd) && !got_int)
    {
        line_breakcheck();

        p = vim_strchr(line, '/');
        if (p == NULL)
            continue;       /* No Tab found, just skip the line. */
        *p++ = NUL;
        if (STRICMP(su->su_badword, line) == 0)
        {
            /* Match!  Isolate the good word, until CR or NL. */
            for (len = 0; p[len] >= ' '; ++len)
                ;
            p[len] = NUL;

            /* If the suggestion doesn't have specific case duplicate the case
             * of the bad word. */
            if (captype(p, NULL) == 0)
            {
                make_case_word(p, cword, su->su_badflags);
                p = cword;
            }

            add_suggestion(su, &su->su_ga, p, su->su_badlen,
                                  SCORE_FILE, 0, TRUE, su->su_sallang, FALSE);
        }
    }

    fclose(fd);

    /* Remove bogus suggestions, sort and truncate at "maxcount". */
    check_suggestions(su, &su->su_ga);
    (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su->su_ga, su->su_maxscore, su->su_maxcount);
}

/*
 * Find suggestions for the internal method indicated by "sps_flags".
 */
    static void
spell_suggest_intern(su, interactive)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    int         interactive;
{
    /*
     * Load the .sug file(s) that are available and not done yet.
     */
    suggest_load_files();

    /*
     * 1. Try special cases, such as repeating a word: "the the" -> "the".
     *
     * Set a maximum score to limit the combination of operations that is
     * tried.
     */
    suggest_try_special(su);

    /*
     * 2. Try inserting/deleting/swapping/changing a letter, use REP entries
     *    from the .aff file and inserting a space (split the word).
     */
    suggest_try_change(su);

    /* For the resulting top-scorers compute the sound-a-like score. */
    if (sps_flags & SPS_DOUBLE)
        score_comp_sal(su);

    /*
     * 3. Try finding sound-a-like words.
     */
    if ((sps_flags & SPS_FAST) == 0)
    {
        if (sps_flags & SPS_BEST)
            /* Adjust the word score for the suggestions found so far for how
             * they sounds like. */
            rescore_suggestions(su);

        /*
         * While going throught the soundfold tree "su_maxscore" is the score
         * for the soundfold word, limits the changes that are being tried,
         * and "su_sfmaxscore" the rescored score, which is set by
         * cleanup_suggestions().
         * First find words with a small edit distance, because this is much
         * faster and often already finds the top-N suggestions.  If we didn't
         * find many suggestions try again with a higher edit distance.
         * "sl_sounddone" is used to avoid doing the same word twice.
         */
        suggest_try_soundalike_prep();
        su->su_maxscore = SCORE_SFMAX1;
        su->su_sfmaxscore = SCORE_MAXINIT * 3;
        suggest_try_soundalike(su);
        if (su->su_ga.ga_len < SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su))
        {
            /* We didn't find enough matches, try again, allowing more
             * changes to the soundfold word. */
            su->su_maxscore = SCORE_SFMAX2;
            suggest_try_soundalike(su);
            if (su->su_ga.ga_len < SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su))
            {
                /* Still didn't find enough matches, try again, allowing even
                 * more changes to the soundfold word. */
                su->su_maxscore = SCORE_SFMAX3;
                suggest_try_soundalike(su);
            }
        }
        su->su_maxscore = su->su_sfmaxscore;
        suggest_try_soundalike_finish();
    }

    /* When CTRL-C was hit while searching do show the results.  Only clear
     * got_int when using a command, not for spellsuggest(). */
    ui_breakcheck();
    if (interactive && got_int)
    {
        (void)vgetc();
        got_int = FALSE;
    }

    if ((sps_flags & SPS_DOUBLE) == 0 && su->su_ga.ga_len != 0)
    {
        if (sps_flags & SPS_BEST)
            /* Adjust the word score for how it sounds like. */
            rescore_suggestions(su);

        /* Remove bogus suggestions, sort and truncate at "maxcount". */
        check_suggestions(su, &su->su_ga);
        (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su->su_ga, su->su_maxscore, su->su_maxcount);
    }
}

/*
 * Load the .sug files for languages that have one and weren't loaded yet.
 */
    static void
suggest_load_files()
{
    langp_T     *lp;
    int         lpi;
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *dotp;
    FILE        *fd;
    char_u      buf[MAXWLEN];
    int         i;
    time_t      timestamp;
    int         wcount;
    int         wordnr;
    garray_T    ga;
    int         c;

    /* Do this for all languages that support sound folding. */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);
        slang = lp->lp_slang;
        if (slang->sl_sugtime != 0 && !slang->sl_sugloaded)
        {
            /* Change ".spl" to ".sug" and open the file.  When the file isn't
             * found silently skip it.  Do set "sl_sugloaded" so that we
             * don't try again and again. */
            slang->sl_sugloaded = TRUE;

            dotp = vim_strrchr(slang->sl_fname, '.');
            if (dotp == NULL || fnamecmp(dotp, ".spl") != 0)
                continue;
            STRCPY(dotp, ".sug");
            fd = mch_fopen((char *)slang->sl_fname, "r");
            if (fd == NULL)
                goto nextone;

            /*
             * <SUGHEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr> <timestamp>
             */
            for (i = 0; i < VIMSUGMAGICL; ++i)
                buf[i] = getc(fd);                      /* <fileID> */
            if (STRNCMP(buf, VIMSUGMAGIC, VIMSUGMAGICL) != 0)
            {
                EMSG2(_("E778: This does not look like a .sug file: %s"),
                                                             slang->sl_fname);
                goto nextone;
            }
            c = getc(fd);                               /* <versionnr> */
            if (c < VIMSUGVERSION)
            {
                EMSG2(_("E779: Old .sug file, needs to be updated: %s"),
                                                             slang->sl_fname);
                goto nextone;
            }
            else if (c > VIMSUGVERSION)
            {
                EMSG2(_("E780: .sug file is for newer version of Vim: %s"),
                                                             slang->sl_fname);
                goto nextone;
            }

            /* Check the timestamp, it must be exactly the same as the one in
             * the .spl file.  Otherwise the word numbers won't match. */
            timestamp = get8c(fd);                      /* <timestamp> */
            if (timestamp != slang->sl_sugtime)
            {
                EMSG2(_("E781: .sug file doesn't match .spl file: %s"),
                                                             slang->sl_fname);
                goto nextone;
            }

            /*
             * <SUGWORDTREE>: <wordtree>
             * Read the trie with the soundfolded words.
             */
            if (spell_read_tree(fd, &slang->sl_sbyts, &slang->sl_sidxs,
                                                               FALSE, 0) != 0)
            {
someerror:
                EMSG2(_("E782: error while reading .sug file: %s"),
                                                             slang->sl_fname);
                slang_clear_sug(slang);
                goto nextone;
            }

            /*
             * <SUGTABLE>: <sugwcount> <sugline> ...
             *
             * Read the table with word numbers.  We use a file buffer for
             * this, because it's so much like a file with lines.  Makes it
             * possible to swap the info and save on memory use.
             */
            slang->sl_sugbuf = open_spellbuf();
            if (slang->sl_sugbuf == NULL)
                goto someerror;
                                                            /* <sugwcount> */
            wcount = get4c(fd);
            if (wcount < 0)
                goto someerror;

            /* Read all the wordnr lists into the buffer, one NUL terminated
             * list per line. */
            ga_init2(&ga, 1, 100);
            for (wordnr = 0; wordnr < wcount; ++wordnr)
            {
                ga.ga_len = 0;
                for (;;)
                {
                    c = getc(fd);                           /* <sugline> */
                    if (c < 0 || ga_grow(&ga, 1) == FAIL)
                        goto someerror;
                    ((char_u *)ga.ga_data)[ga.ga_len++] = c;
                    if (c == NUL)
                        break;
                }
                if (ml_append_buf(slang->sl_sugbuf, (linenr_T)wordnr,
                                         ga.ga_data, ga.ga_len, TRUE) == FAIL)
                    goto someerror;
            }
            ga_clear(&ga);

            /*
             * Need to put word counts in the word tries, so that we can find
             * a word by its number.
             */
            tree_count_words(slang->sl_fbyts, slang->sl_fidxs);
            tree_count_words(slang->sl_sbyts, slang->sl_sidxs);

nextone:
            if (fd != NULL)
                fclose(fd);
            STRCPY(dotp, ".spl");
        }
    }
}


/*
 * Fill in the wordcount fields for a trie.
 * Returns the total number of words.
 */
    static void
tree_count_words(byts, idxs)
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;
{
    int         depth;
    idx_T       arridx[MAXWLEN];
    int         curi[MAXWLEN];
    int         c;
    idx_T       n;
    int         wordcount[MAXWLEN];

    arridx[0] = 0;
    curi[0] = 1;
    wordcount[0] = 0;
    depth = 0;
    while (depth >= 0 && !got_int)
    {
        if (curi[depth] > byts[arridx[depth]])
        {
            /* Done all bytes at this node, go up one level. */
            idxs[arridx[depth]] = wordcount[depth];
            if (depth > 0)
                wordcount[depth - 1] += wordcount[depth];

            --depth;
            fast_breakcheck();
        }
        else
        {
            /* Do one more byte at this node. */
            n = arridx[depth] + curi[depth];
            ++curi[depth];

            c = byts[n];
            if (c == 0)
            {
                /* End of word, count it. */
                ++wordcount[depth];

                /* Skip over any other NUL bytes (same word with different
                 * flags). */
                while (byts[n + 1] == 0)
                {
                    ++n;
                    ++curi[depth];
                }
            }
            else
            {
                /* Normal char, go one level deeper to count the words. */
                ++depth;
                arridx[depth] = idxs[n];
                curi[depth] = 1;
                wordcount[depth] = 0;
            }
        }
    }
}

/*
 * Free the info put in "*su" by spell_find_suggest().
 */
    static void
spell_find_cleanup(su)
    suginfo_T   *su;
{
    int         i;

    /* Free the suggestions. */
    for (i = 0; i < su->su_ga.ga_len; ++i)
        vim_free(SUG(su->su_ga, i).st_word);
    ga_clear(&su->su_ga);
    for (i = 0; i < su->su_sga.ga_len; ++i)
        vim_free(SUG(su->su_sga, i).st_word);
    ga_clear(&su->su_sga);

    /* Free the banned words. */
    hash_clear_all(&su->su_banned, 0);
}

/*
 * Make a copy of "word", with the first letter upper or lower cased, to
 * "wcopy[MAXWLEN]".  "word" must not be empty.
 * The result is NUL terminated.
 */
    static void
onecap_copy(word, wcopy, upper)
    char_u      *word;
    char_u      *wcopy;
    int         upper;      /* TRUE: first letter made upper case */
{
    char_u      *p;
    int         c;
    int         l;

    p = word;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (has_mbyte)
        c = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
    else
#endif
        c = *p++;
    if (upper)
        c = SPELL_TOUPPER(c);
    else
        c = SPELL_TOFOLD(c);
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (has_mbyte)
        l = mb_char2bytes(c, wcopy);
    else
#endif
    {
        l = 1;
        wcopy[0] = c;
    }
    vim_strncpy(wcopy + l, p, MAXWLEN - l - 1);
}

/*
 * Make a copy of "word" with all the letters upper cased into
 * "wcopy[MAXWLEN]".  The result is NUL terminated.
 */
    static void
allcap_copy(word, wcopy)
    char_u      *word;
    char_u      *wcopy;
{
    char_u      *s;
    char_u      *d;
    int         c;

    d = wcopy;
    for (s = word; *s != NUL; )
    {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (has_mbyte)
            c = mb_cptr2char_adv(&s);
        else
#endif
            c = *s++;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        /* We only change ß to SS when we are certain latin1 is used.  It
         * would cause weird errors in other 8-bit encodings. */
        if (enc_latin1like && c == 0xdf)
        {
            c = 'S';
            if (d - wcopy >= MAXWLEN - 1)
                break;
            *d++ = c;
        }
        else
#endif
            c = SPELL_TOUPPER(c);

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (has_mbyte)
        {
            if (d - wcopy >= MAXWLEN - MB_MAXBYTES)
                break;
            d += mb_char2bytes(c, d);
        }
        else
#endif
        {
            if (d - wcopy >= MAXWLEN - 1)
                break;
            *d++ = c;
        }
    }
    *d = NUL;
}

/*
 * Try finding suggestions by recognizing specific situations.
 */
    static void
suggest_try_special(su)
    suginfo_T   *su;
{
    char_u      *p;
    size_t      len;
    int         c;
    char_u      word[MAXWLEN];

    /*
     * Recognize a word that is repeated: "the the".
     */
    p = skiptowhite(su->su_fbadword);
    len = p - su->su_fbadword;
    p = skipwhite(p);
    if (STRLEN(p) == len && STRNCMP(su->su_fbadword, p, len) == 0)
    {
        /* Include badflags: if the badword is onecap or allcap
         * use that for the goodword too: "The the" -> "The". */
        c = su->su_fbadword[len];
        su->su_fbadword[len] = NUL;
        make_case_word(su->su_fbadword, word, su->su_badflags);
        su->su_fbadword[len] = c;

        /* Give a soundalike score of 0, compute the score as if deleting one
         * character. */
        add_suggestion(su, &su->su_ga, word, su->su_badlen,
                       RESCORE(SCORE_REP, 0), 0, TRUE, su->su_sallang, FALSE);
    }
}

/*
 * Try finding suggestions by adding/removing/swapping letters.
 */
    static void
suggest_try_change(su)
    suginfo_T   *su;
{
    char_u      fword[MAXWLEN];     /* copy of the bad word, case-folded */
    int         n;
    char_u      *p;
    int         lpi;
    langp_T     *lp;

    /* We make a copy of the case-folded bad word, so that we can modify it
     * to find matches (esp. REP items).  Append some more text, changing
     * chars after the bad word may help. */
    STRCPY(fword, su->su_fbadword);
    n = (int)STRLEN(fword);
    p = su->su_badptr + su->su_badlen;
    (void)spell_casefold(p, (int)STRLEN(p), fword + n, MAXWLEN - n);

    for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);

        /* If reloading a spell file fails it's still in the list but
         * everything has been cleared. */
        if (lp->lp_slang->sl_fbyts == NULL)
            continue;

        /* Try it for this language.  Will add possible suggestions. */
        suggest_trie_walk(su, lp, fword, FALSE);
    }
}

/* Check the maximum score, if we go over it we won't try this change. */
#define TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, add) \
                (stack[depth].ts_score + (add) < su->su_maxscore)

/*
 * Try finding suggestions by adding/removing/swapping letters.
 *
 * This uses a state machine.  At each node in the tree we try various
 * operations.  When trying if an operation works "depth" is increased and the
 * stack[] is used to store info.  This allows combinations, thus insert one
 * character, replace one and delete another.  The number of changes is
 * limited by su->su_maxscore.
 *
 * After implementing this I noticed an article by Kemal Oflazer that
 * describes something similar: "Error-tolerant Finite State Recognition with
 * Applications to Morphological Analysis and Spelling Correction" (1996).
 * The implementation in the article is simplified and requires a stack of
 * unknown depth.  The implementation here only needs a stack depth equal to
 * the length of the word.
 *
 * This is also used for the sound-folded word, "soundfold" is TRUE then.
 * The mechanism is the same, but we find a match with a sound-folded word
 * that comes from one or more original words.  Each of these words may be
 * added, this is done by add_sound_suggest().
 * Don't use:
 *      the prefix tree or the keep-case tree
 *      "su->su_badlen"
 *      anything to do with upper and lower case
 *      anything to do with word or non-word characters ("spell_iswordp()")
 *      banned words
 *      word flags (rare, region, compounding)
 *      word splitting for now
 *      "similar_chars()"
 *      use "slang->sl_repsal" instead of "lp->lp_replang->sl_rep"
 */
    static void
suggest_trie_walk(su, lp, fword, soundfold)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    langp_T     *lp;
    char_u      *fword;
    int         soundfold;
{
    char_u      tword[MAXWLEN];     /* good word collected so far */
    trystate_T  stack[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      preword[MAXWLEN * 3]; /* word found with proper case;
                                       * concatanation of prefix compound
                                       * words and split word.  NUL terminated
                                       * when going deeper but not when coming
                                       * back. */
    char_u      compflags[MAXWLEN];     /* compound flags, one for each word */
    trystate_T  *sp;
    int         newscore;
    int         score;
    char_u      *byts, *fbyts, *pbyts;
    idx_T       *idxs, *fidxs, *pidxs;
    int         depth;
    int         c, c2, c3;
    int         n = 0;
    int         flags;
    garray_T    *gap;
    idx_T       arridx;
    int         len;
    char_u      *p;
    fromto_T    *ftp;
    int         fl = 0, tl;
    int         repextra = 0;       /* extra bytes in fword[] from REP item */
    slang_T     *slang = lp->lp_slang;
    int         fword_ends;
    int         goodword_ends;
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
    /* Stores the name of the change made at each level. */
    char_u      changename[MAXWLEN][80];
#endif
    int         breakcheckcount = 1000;
    int         compound_ok;

    /*
     * Go through the whole case-fold tree, try changes at each node.
     * "tword[]" contains the word collected from nodes in the tree.
     * "fword[]" the word we are trying to match with (initially the bad
     * word).
     */
    depth = 0;
    sp = &stack[0];
    vim_memset(sp, 0, sizeof(trystate_T));
    sp->ts_curi = 1;

    if (soundfold)
    {
        /* Going through the soundfold tree. */
        byts = fbyts = slang->sl_sbyts;
        idxs = fidxs = slang->sl_sidxs;
        pbyts = NULL;
        pidxs = NULL;
        sp->ts_prefixdepth = PFD_NOPREFIX;
        sp->ts_state = STATE_START;
    }
    else
    {
        /*
         * When there are postponed prefixes we need to use these first.  At
         * the end of the prefix we continue in the case-fold tree.
         */
        fbyts = slang->sl_fbyts;
        fidxs = slang->sl_fidxs;
        pbyts = slang->sl_pbyts;
        pidxs = slang->sl_pidxs;
        if (pbyts != NULL)
        {
            byts = pbyts;
            idxs = pidxs;
            sp->ts_prefixdepth = PFD_PREFIXTREE;
            sp->ts_state = STATE_NOPREFIX;      /* try without prefix first */
        }
        else
        {
            byts = fbyts;
            idxs = fidxs;
            sp->ts_prefixdepth = PFD_NOPREFIX;
            sp->ts_state = STATE_START;
        }
    }

    /*
     * Loop to find all suggestions.  At each round we either:
     * - For the current state try one operation, advance "ts_curi",
     *   increase "depth".
     * - When a state is done go to the next, set "ts_state".
     * - When all states are tried decrease "depth".
     */
    while (depth >= 0 && !got_int)
    {
        sp = &stack[depth];
        switch (sp->ts_state)
        {
        case STATE_START:
        case STATE_NOPREFIX:
            /*
             * Start of node: Deal with NUL bytes, which means
             * tword[] may end here.
             */
            arridx = sp->ts_arridx;         /* current node in the tree */
            len = byts[arridx];             /* bytes in this node */
            arridx += sp->ts_curi;          /* index of current byte */

            if (sp->ts_prefixdepth == PFD_PREFIXTREE)
            {
                /* Skip over the NUL bytes, we use them later. */
                for (n = 0; n < len && byts[arridx + n] == 0; ++n)
                    ;
                sp->ts_curi += n;

                /* Always past NUL bytes now. */
                n = (int)sp->ts_state;
                sp->ts_state = STATE_ENDNUL;
                sp->ts_save_badflags = su->su_badflags;

                /* At end of a prefix or at start of prefixtree: check for
                 * following word. */
                if (byts[arridx] == 0 || n == (int)STATE_NOPREFIX)
                {
                    /* Set su->su_badflags to the caps type at this position.
                     * Use the caps type until here for the prefix itself. */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    if (has_mbyte)
                        n = nofold_len(fword, sp->ts_fidx, su->su_badptr);
                    else
#endif
                        n = sp->ts_fidx;
                    flags = badword_captype(su->su_badptr, su->su_badptr + n);
                    su->su_badflags = badword_captype(su->su_badptr + n,
                                               su->su_badptr + su->su_badlen);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                    sprintf(changename[depth], "prefix");
#endif
                    go_deeper(stack, depth, 0);
                    ++depth;
                    sp = &stack[depth];
                    sp->ts_prefixdepth = depth - 1;
                    byts = fbyts;
                    idxs = fidxs;
                    sp->ts_arridx = 0;

                    /* Move the prefix to preword[] with the right case
                     * and make find_keepcap_word() works. */
                    tword[sp->ts_twordlen] = NUL;
                    make_case_word(tword + sp->ts_splitoff,
                                          preword + sp->ts_prewordlen, flags);
                    sp->ts_prewordlen = (char_u)STRLEN(preword);
                    sp->ts_splitoff = sp->ts_twordlen;
                }
                break;
            }

            if (sp->ts_curi > len || byts[arridx] != 0)
            {
                /* Past bytes in node and/or past NUL bytes. */
                sp->ts_state = STATE_ENDNUL;
                sp->ts_save_badflags = su->su_badflags;
                break;
            }

            /*
             * End of word in tree.
             */
            ++sp->ts_curi;              /* eat one NUL byte */

            flags = (int)idxs[arridx];

            /* Skip words with the NOSUGGEST flag. */
            if (flags & WF_NOSUGGEST)
                break;

            fword_ends = (fword[sp->ts_fidx] == NUL
                           || (soundfold
                               ? vim_iswhite(fword[sp->ts_fidx])
                               : !spell_iswordp(fword + sp->ts_fidx, curbuf)));
            tword[sp->ts_twordlen] = NUL;

            if (sp->ts_prefixdepth <= PFD_NOTSPECIAL
                                        && (sp->ts_flags & TSF_PREFIXOK) == 0)
            {
                /* There was a prefix before the word.  Check that the prefix
                 * can be used with this word. */
                /* Count the length of the NULs in the prefix.  If there are
                 * none this must be the first try without a prefix.  */
                n = stack[sp->ts_prefixdepth].ts_arridx;
                len = pbyts[n++];
                for (c = 0; c < len && pbyts[n + c] == 0; ++c)
                    ;
                if (c > 0)
                {
                    c = valid_word_prefix(c, n, flags,
                                       tword + sp->ts_splitoff, slang, FALSE);
                    if (c == 0)
                        break;

                    /* Use the WF_RARE flag for a rare prefix. */
                    if (c & WF_RAREPFX)
                        flags |= WF_RARE;

                    /* Tricky: when checking for both prefix and compounding
                     * we run into the prefix flag first.
                     * Remember that it's OK, so that we accept the prefix
                     * when arriving at a compound flag. */
                    sp->ts_flags |= TSF_PREFIXOK;
                }
            }

            /* Check NEEDCOMPOUND: can't use word without compounding.  Do try
             * appending another compound word below. */
            if (sp->ts_complen == sp->ts_compsplit && fword_ends
                                                     && (flags & WF_NEEDCOMP))
                goodword_ends = FALSE;
            else
                goodword_ends = TRUE;

            p = NULL;
            compound_ok = TRUE;
            if (sp->ts_complen > sp->ts_compsplit)
            {
                if (slang->sl_nobreak)
                {
                    /* There was a word before this word.  When there was no
                     * change in this word (it was correct) add the first word
                     * as a suggestion.  If this word was corrected too, we
                     * need to check if a correct word follows. */
                    if (sp->ts_fidx - sp->ts_splitfidx
                                          == sp->ts_twordlen - sp->ts_splitoff
                            && STRNCMP(fword + sp->ts_splitfidx,
                                        tword + sp->ts_splitoff,
                                         sp->ts_fidx - sp->ts_splitfidx) == 0)
                    {
                        preword[sp->ts_prewordlen] = NUL;
                        newscore = score_wordcount_adj(slang, sp->ts_score,
                                                 preword + sp->ts_prewordlen,
                                                 sp->ts_prewordlen > 0);
                        /* Add the suggestion if the score isn't too bad. */
                        if (newscore <= su->su_maxscore)
                            add_suggestion(su, &su->su_ga, preword,
                                    sp->ts_splitfidx - repextra,
                                    newscore, 0, FALSE,
                                    lp->lp_sallang, FALSE);
                        break;
                    }
                }
                else
                {
                    /* There was a compound word before this word.  If this
                     * word does not support compounding then give up
                     * (splitting is tried for the word without compound
                     * flag). */
                    if (((unsigned)flags >> 24) == 0
                            || sp->ts_twordlen - sp->ts_splitoff
                                                       < slang->sl_compminlen)
                        break;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    /* For multi-byte chars check character length against
                     * COMPOUNDMIN. */
                    if (has_mbyte
                            && slang->sl_compminlen > 0
                            && mb_charlen(tword + sp->ts_splitoff)
                                                       < slang->sl_compminlen)
                        break;
#endif

                    compflags[sp->ts_complen] = ((unsigned)flags >> 24);
                    compflags[sp->ts_complen + 1] = NUL;
                    vim_strncpy(preword + sp->ts_prewordlen,
                            tword + sp->ts_splitoff,
                            sp->ts_twordlen - sp->ts_splitoff);
                    p = preword;
                    while (*skiptowhite(p) != NUL)
                        p = skipwhite(skiptowhite(p));
                    if (fword_ends && !can_compound(slang, p,
                                                compflags + sp->ts_compsplit))
                        /* Compound is not allowed.  But it may still be
                         * possible if we add another (short) word. */
                        compound_ok = FALSE;

                    /* Get pointer to last char of previous word. */
                    p = preword + sp->ts_prewordlen;
                    mb_ptr_back(preword, p);
                }
            }

            /*
             * Form the word with proper case in preword.
             * If there is a word from a previous split, append.
             * For the soundfold tree don't change the case, simply append.
             */
            if (soundfold)
                STRCPY(preword + sp->ts_prewordlen, tword + sp->ts_splitoff);
            else if (flags & WF_KEEPCAP)
                /* Must find the word in the keep-case tree. */
                find_keepcap_word(slang, tword + sp->ts_splitoff,
                                                 preword + sp->ts_prewordlen);
            else
            {
                /* Include badflags: If the badword is onecap or allcap
                 * use that for the goodword too.  But if the badword is
                 * allcap and it's only one char long use onecap. */
                c = su->su_badflags;
                if ((c & WF_ALLCAP)
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                        && su->su_badlen == (*mb_ptr2len)(su->su_badptr)
#else
                        && su->su_badlen == 1
#endif
                        )
                    c = WF_ONECAP;
                c |= flags;

                /* When appending a compound word after a word character don't
                 * use Onecap. */
                if (p != NULL && spell_iswordp_nmw(p))
                    c &= ~WF_ONECAP;
                make_case_word(tword + sp->ts_splitoff,
                                              preword + sp->ts_prewordlen, c);
            }

            if (!soundfold)
            {
                /* Don't use a banned word.  It may appear again as a good
                 * word, thus remember it. */
                if (flags & WF_BANNED)
                {
                    add_banned(su, preword + sp->ts_prewordlen);
                    break;
                }
                if ((sp->ts_complen == sp->ts_compsplit
                            && WAS_BANNED(su, preword + sp->ts_prewordlen))
                                                   || WAS_BANNED(su, preword))
                {
                    if (slang->sl_compprog == NULL)
                        break;
                    /* the word so far was banned but we may try compounding */
                    goodword_ends = FALSE;
                }
            }

            newscore = 0;
            if (!soundfold)     /* soundfold words don't have flags */
            {
                if ((flags & WF_REGION)
                            && (((unsigned)flags >> 16) & lp->lp_region) == 0)
                    newscore += SCORE_REGION;
                if (flags & WF_RARE)
                    newscore += SCORE_RARE;

                if (!spell_valid_case(su->su_badflags,
                                  captype(preword + sp->ts_prewordlen, NULL)))
                    newscore += SCORE_ICASE;
            }

            /* TODO: how about splitting in the soundfold tree? */
            if (fword_ends
                    && goodword_ends
                    && sp->ts_fidx >= sp->ts_fidxtry
                    && compound_ok)
            {
                /* The badword also ends: add suggestions. */
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                if (soundfold && STRCMP(preword, "smwrd") == 0)
                {
                    int     j;

                    /* print the stack of changes that brought us here */
                    smsg("------ %s -------", fword);
                    for (j = 0; j < depth; ++j)
                        smsg("%s", changename[j]);
                }
#endif
                if (soundfold)
                {
                    /* For soundfolded words we need to find the original
                     * words, the edit distance and then add them. */
                    add_sound_suggest(su, preword, sp->ts_score, lp);
                }
                else
                {
                    /* Give a penalty when changing non-word char to word
                     * char, e.g., "thes," -> "these". */
                    p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
                    mb_ptr_back(fword, p);
                    if (!spell_iswordp(p, curbuf))
                    {
                        p = preword + STRLEN(preword);
                        mb_ptr_back(preword, p);
                        if (spell_iswordp(p, curbuf))
                            newscore += SCORE_NONWORD;
                    }

                    /* Give a bonus to words seen before. */
                    score = score_wordcount_adj(slang,
                                                sp->ts_score + newscore,
                                                preword + sp->ts_prewordlen,
                                                sp->ts_prewordlen > 0);

                    /* Add the suggestion if the score isn't too bad. */
                    if (score <= su->su_maxscore)
                    {
                        add_suggestion(su, &su->su_ga, preword,
                                    sp->ts_fidx - repextra,
                                    score, 0, FALSE, lp->lp_sallang, FALSE);

                        if (su->su_badflags & WF_MIXCAP)
                        {
                            /* We really don't know if the word should be
                             * upper or lower case, add both. */
                            c = captype(preword, NULL);
                            if (c == 0 || c == WF_ALLCAP)
                            {
                                make_case_word(tword + sp->ts_splitoff,
                                              preword + sp->ts_prewordlen,
                                                      c == 0 ? WF_ALLCAP : 0);

                                add_suggestion(su, &su->su_ga, preword,
                                        sp->ts_fidx - repextra,
                                        score + SCORE_ICASE, 0, FALSE,
                                        lp->lp_sallang, FALSE);
                            }
                        }
                    }
                }
            }

            /*
             * Try word split and/or compounding.
             */
            if ((sp->ts_fidx >= sp->ts_fidxtry || fword_ends)
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    /* Don't split halfway a character. */
                    && (!has_mbyte || sp->ts_tcharlen == 0)
#endif
                    )
            {
                int     try_compound;
                int     try_split;

                /* If past the end of the bad word don't try a split.
                 * Otherwise try changing the next word.  E.g., find
                 * suggestions for "the the" where the second "the" is
                 * different.  It's done like a split.
                 * TODO: word split for soundfold words */
                try_split = (sp->ts_fidx - repextra < su->su_badlen)
                                                                && !soundfold;

                /* Get here in several situations:
                 * 1. The word in the tree ends:
                 *    If the word allows compounding try that.  Otherwise try
                 *    a split by inserting a space.  For both check that a
                 *    valid words starts at fword[sp->ts_fidx].
                 *    For NOBREAK do like compounding to be able to check if
                 *    the next word is valid.
                 * 2. The badword does end, but it was due to a change (e.g.,
                 *    a swap).  No need to split, but do check that the
                 *    following word is valid.
                 * 3. The badword and the word in the tree end.  It may still
                 *    be possible to compound another (short) word.
                 */
                try_compound = FALSE;
                if (!soundfold
                        && slang->sl_compprog != NULL
                        && ((unsigned)flags >> 24) != 0
                        && sp->ts_twordlen - sp->ts_splitoff
                                                       >= slang->sl_compminlen
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                        && (!has_mbyte
                            || slang->sl_compminlen == 0
                            || mb_charlen(tword + sp->ts_splitoff)
                                                      >= slang->sl_compminlen)
#endif
                        && (slang->sl_compsylmax < MAXWLEN
                            || sp->ts_complen + 1 - sp->ts_compsplit
                                                          < slang->sl_compmax)
                        && (byte_in_str(sp->ts_complen == sp->ts_compsplit
                                            ? slang->sl_compstartflags
                                            : slang->sl_compallflags,
                                                    ((unsigned)flags >> 24))))
                {
                    try_compound = TRUE;
                    compflags[sp->ts_complen] = ((unsigned)flags >> 24);
                    compflags[sp->ts_complen + 1] = NUL;
                }

                /* For NOBREAK we never try splitting, it won't make any word
                 * valid. */
                if (slang->sl_nobreak)
                    try_compound = TRUE;

                /* If we could add a compound word, and it's also possible to
                 * split at this point, do the split first and set
                 * TSF_DIDSPLIT to avoid doing it again. */
                else if (!fword_ends
                        && try_compound
                        && (sp->ts_flags & TSF_DIDSPLIT) == 0)
                {
                    try_compound = FALSE;
                    sp->ts_flags |= TSF_DIDSPLIT;
                    --sp->ts_curi;          /* do the same NUL again */
                    compflags[sp->ts_complen] = NUL;
                }
                else
                    sp->ts_flags &= ~TSF_DIDSPLIT;

                if (try_split || try_compound)
                {
                    if (!try_compound && (!fword_ends || !goodword_ends))
                    {
                        /* If we're going to split need to check that the
                         * words so far are valid for compounding.  If there
                         * is only one word it must not have the NEEDCOMPOUND
                         * flag. */
                        if (sp->ts_complen == sp->ts_compsplit
                                                     && (flags & WF_NEEDCOMP))
                            break;
                        p = preword;
                        while (*skiptowhite(p) != NUL)
                            p = skipwhite(skiptowhite(p));
                        if (sp->ts_complen > sp->ts_compsplit
                                && !can_compound(slang, p,
                                                compflags + sp->ts_compsplit))
                            break;

                        if (slang->sl_nosplitsugs)
                            newscore += SCORE_SPLIT_NO;
                        else
                            newscore += SCORE_SPLIT;

                        /* Give a bonus to words seen before. */
                        newscore = score_wordcount_adj(slang, newscore,
                                           preword + sp->ts_prewordlen, TRUE);
                    }

                    if (TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, newscore))
                    {
                        go_deeper(stack, depth, newscore);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                        if (!try_compound && !fword_ends)
                            sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: split",
                                 sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx);
                        else
                            sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: compound",
                                 sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx);
#endif
                        /* Save things to be restored at STATE_SPLITUNDO. */
                        sp->ts_save_badflags = su->su_badflags;
                        sp->ts_state = STATE_SPLITUNDO;

                        ++depth;
                        sp = &stack[depth];

                        /* Append a space to preword when splitting. */
                        if (!try_compound && !fword_ends)
                            STRCAT(preword, " ");
                        sp->ts_prewordlen = (char_u)STRLEN(preword);
                        sp->ts_splitoff = sp->ts_twordlen;
                        sp->ts_splitfidx = sp->ts_fidx;

                        /* If the badword has a non-word character at this
                         * position skip it.  That means replacing the
                         * non-word character with a space.  Always skip a
                         * character when the word ends.  But only when the
                         * good word can end. */
                        if (((!try_compound && !spell_iswordp_nmw(fword
                                                               + sp->ts_fidx))
                                    || fword_ends)
                                && fword[sp->ts_fidx] != NUL
                                && goodword_ends)
                        {
                            int     l;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                            if (has_mbyte)
                                l = MB_BYTE2LEN(fword[sp->ts_fidx]);
                            else
#endif
                                l = 1;
                            if (fword_ends)
                            {
                                /* Copy the skipped character to preword. */
                                mch_memmove(preword + sp->ts_prewordlen,
                                                      fword + sp->ts_fidx, l);
                                sp->ts_prewordlen += l;
                                preword[sp->ts_prewordlen] = NUL;
                            }
                            else
                                sp->ts_score -= SCORE_SPLIT - SCORE_SUBST;
                            sp->ts_fidx += l;
                        }

                        /* When compounding include compound flag in
                         * compflags[] (already set above).  When splitting we
                         * may start compounding over again.  */
                        if (try_compound)
                            ++sp->ts_complen;
                        else
                            sp->ts_compsplit = sp->ts_complen;
                        sp->ts_prefixdepth = PFD_NOPREFIX;

                        /* set su->su_badflags to the caps type at this
                         * position */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                        if (has_mbyte)
                            n = nofold_len(fword, sp->ts_fidx, su->su_badptr);
                        else
#endif
                            n = sp->ts_fidx;
                        su->su_badflags = badword_captype(su->su_badptr + n,
                                               su->su_badptr + su->su_badlen);

                        /* Restart at top of the tree. */
                        sp->ts_arridx = 0;

                        /* If there are postponed prefixes, try these too. */
                        if (pbyts != NULL)
                        {
                            byts = pbyts;
                            idxs = pidxs;
                            sp->ts_prefixdepth = PFD_PREFIXTREE;
                            sp->ts_state = STATE_NOPREFIX;
                        }
                    }
                }
            }
            break;

        case STATE_SPLITUNDO:
            /* Undo the changes done for word split or compound word. */
            su->su_badflags = sp->ts_save_badflags;

            /* Continue looking for NUL bytes. */
            sp->ts_state = STATE_START;

            /* In case we went into the prefix tree. */
            byts = fbyts;
            idxs = fidxs;
            break;

        case STATE_ENDNUL:
            /* Past the NUL bytes in the node. */
            su->su_badflags = sp->ts_save_badflags;
            if (fword[sp->ts_fidx] == NUL
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    && sp->ts_tcharlen == 0
#endif
               )
            {
                /* The badword ends, can't use STATE_PLAIN. */
                sp->ts_state = STATE_DEL;
                break;
            }
            sp->ts_state = STATE_PLAIN;
            /*FALLTHROUGH*/

        case STATE_PLAIN:
            /*
             * Go over all possible bytes at this node, add each to tword[]
             * and use child node.  "ts_curi" is the index.
             */
            arridx = sp->ts_arridx;
            if (sp->ts_curi > byts[arridx])
            {
                /* Done all bytes at this node, do next state.  When still at
                 * already changed bytes skip the other tricks. */
                if (sp->ts_fidx >= sp->ts_fidxtry)
                    sp->ts_state = STATE_DEL;
                else
                    sp->ts_state = STATE_FINAL;
            }
            else
            {
                arridx += sp->ts_curi++;
                c = byts[arridx];

                /* Normal byte, go one level deeper.  If it's not equal to the
                 * byte in the bad word adjust the score.  But don't even try
                 * when the byte was already changed.  And don't try when we
                 * just deleted this byte, accepting it is always cheaper then
                 * delete + substitute. */
                if (c == fword[sp->ts_fidx]
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                        || (sp->ts_tcharlen > 0 && sp->ts_isdiff != DIFF_NONE)
#endif
                        )
                    newscore = 0;
                else
                    newscore = SCORE_SUBST;
                if ((newscore == 0
                            || (sp->ts_fidx >= sp->ts_fidxtry
                                && ((sp->ts_flags & TSF_DIDDEL) == 0
                                    || c != fword[sp->ts_delidx])))
                        && TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, newscore))
                {
                    go_deeper(stack, depth, newscore);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                    if (newscore > 0)
                        sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: subst %c to %c",
                                sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                                fword[sp->ts_fidx], c);
                    else
                        sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: accept %c",
                                sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                                fword[sp->ts_fidx]);
#endif
                    ++depth;
                    sp = &stack[depth];
                    ++sp->ts_fidx;
                    tword[sp->ts_twordlen++] = c;
                    sp->ts_arridx = idxs[arridx];
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    if (newscore == SCORE_SUBST)
                        sp->ts_isdiff = DIFF_YES;
                    if (has_mbyte)
                    {
                        /* Multi-byte characters are a bit complicated to
                         * handle: They differ when any of the bytes differ
                         * and then their length may also differ. */
                        if (sp->ts_tcharlen == 0)
                        {
                            /* First byte. */
                            sp->ts_tcharidx = 0;
                            sp->ts_tcharlen = MB_BYTE2LEN(c);
                            sp->ts_fcharstart = sp->ts_fidx - 1;
                            sp->ts_isdiff = (newscore != 0)
                                                       ? DIFF_YES : DIFF_NONE;
                        }
                        else if (sp->ts_isdiff == DIFF_INSERT)
                            /* When inserting trail bytes don't advance in the
                             * bad word. */
                            --sp->ts_fidx;
                        if (++sp->ts_tcharidx == sp->ts_tcharlen)
                        {
                            /* Last byte of character. */
                            if (sp->ts_isdiff == DIFF_YES)
                            {
                                /* Correct ts_fidx for the byte length of the
                                 * character (we didn't check that before). */
                                sp->ts_fidx = sp->ts_fcharstart
                                            + MB_BYTE2LEN(
                                                    fword[sp->ts_fcharstart]);

                                /* For changing a composing character adjust
                                 * the score from SCORE_SUBST to
                                 * SCORE_SUBCOMP. */
                                if (enc_utf8
                                        && utf_iscomposing(
                                            mb_ptr2char(tword
                                                + sp->ts_twordlen
                                                           - sp->ts_tcharlen))
                                        && utf_iscomposing(
                                            mb_ptr2char(fword
                                                        + sp->ts_fcharstart)))
                                    sp->ts_score -=
                                                  SCORE_SUBST - SCORE_SUBCOMP;

                                /* For a similar character adjust score from
                                 * SCORE_SUBST to SCORE_SIMILAR. */
                                else if (!soundfold
                                        && slang->sl_has_map
                                        && similar_chars(slang,
                                            mb_ptr2char(tword
                                                + sp->ts_twordlen
                                                           - sp->ts_tcharlen),
                                            mb_ptr2char(fword
                                                        + sp->ts_fcharstart)))
                                    sp->ts_score -=
                                                  SCORE_SUBST - SCORE_SIMILAR;
                            }
                            else if (sp->ts_isdiff == DIFF_INSERT
                                         && sp->ts_twordlen > sp->ts_tcharlen)
                            {
                                p = tword + sp->ts_twordlen - sp->ts_tcharlen;
                                c = mb_ptr2char(p);
                                if (enc_utf8 && utf_iscomposing(c))
                                {
                                    /* Inserting a composing char doesn't
                                     * count that much. */
                                    sp->ts_score -= SCORE_INS - SCORE_INSCOMP;
                                }
                                else
                                {
                                    /* If the previous character was the same,
                                     * thus doubling a character, give a bonus
                                     * to the score.  Also for the soundfold
                                     * tree (might seem illogical but does
                                     * give better scores). */
                                    mb_ptr_back(tword, p);
                                    if (c == mb_ptr2char(p))
                                        sp->ts_score -= SCORE_INS
                                                               - SCORE_INSDUP;
                                }
                            }

                            /* Starting a new char, reset the length. */
                            sp->ts_tcharlen = 0;
                        }
                    }
                    else
#endif
                    {
                        /* If we found a similar char adjust the score.
                         * We do this after calling go_deeper() because
                         * it's slow. */
                        if (newscore != 0
                                && !soundfold
                                && slang->sl_has_map
                                && similar_chars(slang,
                                                   c, fword[sp->ts_fidx - 1]))
                            sp->ts_score -= SCORE_SUBST - SCORE_SIMILAR;
                    }
                }
            }
            break;

        case STATE_DEL:
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            /* When past the first byte of a multi-byte char don't try
             * delete/insert/swap a character. */
            if (has_mbyte && sp->ts_tcharlen > 0)
            {
                sp->ts_state = STATE_FINAL;
                break;
            }
#endif
            /*
             * Try skipping one character in the bad word (delete it).
             */
            sp->ts_state = STATE_INS_PREP;
            sp->ts_curi = 1;
            if (soundfold && sp->ts_fidx == 0 && fword[sp->ts_fidx] == '*')
                /* Deleting a vowel at the start of a word counts less, see
                 * soundalike_score(). */
                newscore = 2 * SCORE_DEL / 3;
            else
                newscore = SCORE_DEL;
            if (fword[sp->ts_fidx] != NUL
                                    && TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, newscore))
            {
                go_deeper(stack, depth, newscore);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: delete %c",
                        sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                        fword[sp->ts_fidx]);
#endif
                ++depth;

                /* Remember what character we deleted, so that we can avoid
                 * inserting it again. */
                stack[depth].ts_flags |= TSF_DIDDEL;
                stack[depth].ts_delidx = sp->ts_fidx;

                /* Advance over the character in fword[].  Give a bonus to the
                 * score if the same character is following "nn" -> "n".  It's
                 * a bit illogical for soundfold tree but it does give better
                 * results. */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                if (has_mbyte)
                {
                    c = mb_ptr2char(fword + sp->ts_fidx);
                    stack[depth].ts_fidx += MB_BYTE2LEN(fword[sp->ts_fidx]);
                    if (enc_utf8 && utf_iscomposing(c))
                        stack[depth].ts_score -= SCORE_DEL - SCORE_DELCOMP;
                    else if (c == mb_ptr2char(fword + stack[depth].ts_fidx))
                        stack[depth].ts_score -= SCORE_DEL - SCORE_DELDUP;
                }
                else
#endif
                {
                    ++stack[depth].ts_fidx;
                    if (fword[sp->ts_fidx] == fword[sp->ts_fidx + 1])
                        stack[depth].ts_score -= SCORE_DEL - SCORE_DELDUP;
                }
                break;
            }
            /*FALLTHROUGH*/

        case STATE_INS_PREP:
            if (sp->ts_flags & TSF_DIDDEL)
            {
                /* If we just deleted a byte then inserting won't make sense,
                 * a substitute is always cheaper. */
                sp->ts_state = STATE_SWAP;
                break;
            }

            /* skip over NUL bytes */
            n = sp->ts_arridx;
            for (;;)
            {
                if (sp->ts_curi > byts[n])
                {
                    /* Only NUL bytes at this node, go to next state. */
                    sp->ts_state = STATE_SWAP;
                    break;
                }
                if (byts[n + sp->ts_curi] != NUL)
                {
                    /* Found a byte to insert. */
                    sp->ts_state = STATE_INS;
                    break;
                }
                ++sp->ts_curi;
            }
            break;

            /*FALLTHROUGH*/

        case STATE_INS:
            /* Insert one byte.  Repeat this for each possible byte at this
             * node. */
            n = sp->ts_arridx;
            if (sp->ts_curi > byts[n])
            {
                /* Done all bytes at this node, go to next state. */
                sp->ts_state = STATE_SWAP;
                break;
            }

            /* Do one more byte at this node, but:
             * - Skip NUL bytes.
             * - Skip the byte if it's equal to the byte in the word,
             *   accepting that byte is always better.
             */
            n += sp->ts_curi++;
            c = byts[n];
            if (soundfold && sp->ts_twordlen == 0 && c == '*')
                /* Inserting a vowel at the start of a word counts less,
                 * see soundalike_score(). */
                newscore = 2 * SCORE_INS / 3;
            else
                newscore = SCORE_INS;
            if (c != fword[sp->ts_fidx]
                                    && TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, newscore))
            {
                go_deeper(stack, depth, newscore);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: insert %c",
                        sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                        c);
#endif
                ++depth;
                sp = &stack[depth];
                tword[sp->ts_twordlen++] = c;
                sp->ts_arridx = idxs[n];
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                if (has_mbyte)
                {
                    fl = MB_BYTE2LEN(c);
                    if (fl > 1)
                    {
                        /* There are following bytes for the same character.
                         * We must find all bytes before trying
                         * delete/insert/swap/etc. */
                        sp->ts_tcharlen = fl;
                        sp->ts_tcharidx = 1;
                        sp->ts_isdiff = DIFF_INSERT;
                    }
                }
                else
                    fl = 1;
                if (fl == 1)
#endif
                {
                    /* If the previous character was the same, thus doubling a
                     * character, give a bonus to the score.  Also for
                     * soundfold words (illogical but does give a better
                     * score). */
                    if (sp->ts_twordlen >= 2
                                           && tword[sp->ts_twordlen - 2] == c)
                        sp->ts_score -= SCORE_INS - SCORE_INSDUP;
                }
            }
            break;

        case STATE_SWAP:
            /*
             * Swap two bytes in the bad word: "12" -> "21".
             * We change "fword" here, it's changed back afterwards at
             * STATE_UNSWAP.
             */
            p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
            c = *p;
            if (c == NUL)
            {
                /* End of word, can't swap or replace. */
                sp->ts_state = STATE_FINAL;
                break;
            }

            /* Don't swap if the first character is not a word character.
             * SWAP3 etc. also don't make sense then. */
            if (!soundfold && !spell_iswordp(p, curbuf))
            {
                sp->ts_state = STATE_REP_INI;
                break;
            }

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                n = mb_cptr2len(p);
                c = mb_ptr2char(p);
                if (!soundfold && !spell_iswordp(p + n, curbuf))
                    c2 = c; /* don't swap non-word char */
                else
                    c2 = mb_ptr2char(p + n);
            }
            else
#endif
            {
                if (!soundfold && !spell_iswordp(p + 1, curbuf))
                    c2 = c; /* don't swap non-word char */
                else
                    c2 = p[1];
            }

            /* When characters are identical, swap won't do anything.
             * Also get here if the second char is not a word character. */
            if (c == c2)
            {
                sp->ts_state = STATE_SWAP3;
                break;
            }
            if (c2 != NUL && TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, SCORE_SWAP))
            {
                go_deeper(stack, depth, SCORE_SWAP);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: swap %c and %c",
                        sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                        c, c2);
#endif
                sp->ts_state = STATE_UNSWAP;
                ++depth;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                if (has_mbyte)
                {
                    fl = mb_char2len(c2);
                    mch_memmove(p, p + n, fl);
                    mb_char2bytes(c, p + fl);
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + n + fl;
                }
                else
#endif
                {
                    p[0] = c2;
                    p[1] = c;
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + 2;
                }
            }
            else
                /* If this swap doesn't work then SWAP3 won't either. */
                sp->ts_state = STATE_REP_INI;
            break;

        case STATE_UNSWAP:
            /* Undo the STATE_SWAP swap: "21" -> "12". */
            p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                n = MB_BYTE2LEN(*p);
                c = mb_ptr2char(p + n);
                mch_memmove(p + MB_BYTE2LEN(p[n]), p, n);
                mb_char2bytes(c, p);
            }
            else
#endif
            {
                c = *p;
                *p = p[1];
                p[1] = c;
            }
            /*FALLTHROUGH*/

        case STATE_SWAP3:
            /* Swap two bytes, skipping one: "123" -> "321".  We change
             * "fword" here, it's changed back afterwards at STATE_UNSWAP3. */
            p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                n = mb_cptr2len(p);
                c = mb_ptr2char(p);
                fl = mb_cptr2len(p + n);
                c2 = mb_ptr2char(p + n);
                if (!soundfold && !spell_iswordp(p + n + fl, curbuf))
                    c3 = c;     /* don't swap non-word char */
                else
                    c3 = mb_ptr2char(p + n + fl);
            }
            else
#endif
            {
                c = *p;
                c2 = p[1];
                if (!soundfold && !spell_iswordp(p + 2, curbuf))
                    c3 = c;     /* don't swap non-word char */
                else
                    c3 = p[2];
            }

            /* When characters are identical: "121" then SWAP3 result is
             * identical, ROT3L result is same as SWAP: "211", ROT3L result is
             * same as SWAP on next char: "112".  Thus skip all swapping.
             * Also skip when c3 is NUL.
             * Also get here when the third character is not a word character.
             * Second character may any char: "a.b" -> "b.a" */
            if (c == c3 || c3 == NUL)
            {
                sp->ts_state = STATE_REP_INI;
                break;
            }
            if (TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, SCORE_SWAP3))
            {
                go_deeper(stack, depth, SCORE_SWAP3);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: swap3 %c and %c",
                        sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                        c, c3);
#endif
                sp->ts_state = STATE_UNSWAP3;
                ++depth;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                if (has_mbyte)
                {
                    tl = mb_char2len(c3);
                    mch_memmove(p, p + n + fl, tl);
                    mb_char2bytes(c2, p + tl);
                    mb_char2bytes(c, p + fl + tl);
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + n + fl + tl;
                }
                else
#endif
                {
                    p[0] = p[2];
                    p[2] = c;
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + 3;
                }
            }
            else
                sp->ts_state = STATE_REP_INI;
            break;

        case STATE_UNSWAP3:
            /* Undo STATE_SWAP3: "321" -> "123" */
            p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                n = MB_BYTE2LEN(*p);
                c2 = mb_ptr2char(p + n);
                fl = MB_BYTE2LEN(p[n]);
                c = mb_ptr2char(p + n + fl);
                tl = MB_BYTE2LEN(p[n + fl]);
                mch_memmove(p + fl + tl, p, n);
                mb_char2bytes(c, p);
                mb_char2bytes(c2, p + tl);
                p = p + tl;
            }
            else
#endif
            {
                c = *p;
                *p = p[2];
                p[2] = c;
                ++p;
            }

            if (!soundfold && !spell_iswordp(p, curbuf))
            {
                /* Middle char is not a word char, skip the rotate.  First and
                 * third char were already checked at swap and swap3. */
                sp->ts_state = STATE_REP_INI;
                break;
            }

            /* Rotate three characters left: "123" -> "231".  We change
             * "fword" here, it's changed back afterwards at STATE_UNROT3L. */
            if (TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, SCORE_SWAP3))
            {
                go_deeper(stack, depth, SCORE_SWAP3);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
                sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: rotate left %c%c%c",
                        sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                        p[0], p[1], p[2]);
#endif
                sp->ts_state = STATE_UNROT3L;
                ++depth;
                p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                if (has_mbyte)
                {
                    n = mb_cptr2len(p);
                    c = mb_ptr2char(p);
                    fl = mb_cptr2len(p + n);
                    fl += mb_cptr2len(p + n + fl);
                    mch_memmove(p, p + n, fl);
                    mb_char2bytes(c, p + fl);
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + n + fl;
                }
                else
#endif
                {
                    c = *p;
                    *p = p[1];
                    p[1] = p[2];
                    p[2] = c;
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + 3;
                }
            }
            else
                sp->ts_state = STATE_REP_INI;
            break;

        case STATE_UNROT3L:
            /* Undo ROT3L: "231" -> "123" */
            p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                n = MB_BYTE2LEN(*p);
                n += MB_BYTE2LEN(p[n]);
                c = mb_ptr2char(p + n);
                tl = MB_BYTE2LEN(p[n]);
                mch_memmove(p + tl, p, n);
                mb_char2bytes(c, p);
            }
            else
#endif
            {
                c = p[2];
                p[2] = p[1];
                p[1] = *p;
                *p = c;
            }

            /* Rotate three bytes right: "123" -> "312".  We change "fword"
             * here, it's changed back afterwards at STATE_UNROT3R. */
            if (TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, SCORE_SWAP3))
            {
                go_deeper(stack, depth, SCORE_SWAP3);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
                sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: rotate right %c%c%c",
                        sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                        p[0], p[1], p[2]);
#endif
                sp->ts_state = STATE_UNROT3R;
                ++depth;
                p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                if (has_mbyte)
                {
                    n = mb_cptr2len(p);
                    n += mb_cptr2len(p + n);
                    c = mb_ptr2char(p + n);
                    tl = mb_cptr2len(p + n);
                    mch_memmove(p + tl, p, n);
                    mb_char2bytes(c, p);
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + n + tl;
                }
                else
#endif
                {
                    c = p[2];
                    p[2] = p[1];
                    p[1] = *p;
                    *p = c;
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + 3;
                }
            }
            else
                sp->ts_state = STATE_REP_INI;
            break;

        case STATE_UNROT3R:
            /* Undo ROT3R: "312" -> "123" */
            p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                c = mb_ptr2char(p);
                tl = MB_BYTE2LEN(*p);
                n = MB_BYTE2LEN(p[tl]);
                n += MB_BYTE2LEN(p[tl + n]);
                mch_memmove(p, p + tl, n);
                mb_char2bytes(c, p + n);
            }
            else
#endif
            {
                c = *p;
                *p = p[1];
                p[1] = p[2];
                p[2] = c;
            }
            /*FALLTHROUGH*/

        case STATE_REP_INI:
            /* Check if matching with REP items from the .aff file would work.
             * Quickly skip if:
             * - there are no REP items and we are not in the soundfold trie
             * - the score is going to be too high anyway
             * - already applied a REP item or swapped here  */
            if ((lp->lp_replang == NULL && !soundfold)
                    || sp->ts_score + SCORE_REP >= su->su_maxscore
                    || sp->ts_fidx < sp->ts_fidxtry)
            {
                sp->ts_state = STATE_FINAL;
                break;
            }

            /* Use the first byte to quickly find the first entry that may
             * match.  If the index is -1 there is none. */
            if (soundfold)
                sp->ts_curi = slang->sl_repsal_first[fword[sp->ts_fidx]];
            else
                sp->ts_curi = lp->lp_replang->sl_rep_first[fword[sp->ts_fidx]];

            if (sp->ts_curi < 0)
            {
                sp->ts_state = STATE_FINAL;
                break;
            }

            sp->ts_state = STATE_REP;
            /*FALLTHROUGH*/

        case STATE_REP:
            /* Try matching with REP items from the .aff file.  For each match
             * replace the characters and check if the resulting word is
             * valid. */
            p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;

            if (soundfold)
                gap = &slang->sl_repsal;
            else
                gap = &lp->lp_replang->sl_rep;
            while (sp->ts_curi < gap->ga_len)
            {
                ftp = (fromto_T *)gap->ga_data + sp->ts_curi++;
                if (*ftp->ft_from != *p)
                {
                    /* past possible matching entries */
                    sp->ts_curi = gap->ga_len;
                    break;
                }
                if (STRNCMP(ftp->ft_from, p, STRLEN(ftp->ft_from)) == 0
                        && TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, SCORE_REP))
                {
                    go_deeper(stack, depth, SCORE_REP);
#ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
                    sprintf(changename[depth], "%.*s-%s: replace %s with %s",
                            sp->ts_twordlen, tword, fword + sp->ts_fidx,
                            ftp->ft_from, ftp->ft_to);
#endif
                    /* Need to undo this afterwards. */
                    sp->ts_state = STATE_REP_UNDO;

                    /* Change the "from" to the "to" string. */
                    ++depth;
                    fl = (int)STRLEN(ftp->ft_from);
                    tl = (int)STRLEN(ftp->ft_to);
                    if (fl != tl)
                    {
                        mch_memmove(p + tl, p + fl, STRLEN(p + fl) + 1);
                        repextra += tl - fl;
                    }
                    mch_memmove(p, ftp->ft_to, tl);
                    stack[depth].ts_fidxtry = sp->ts_fidx + tl;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    stack[depth].ts_tcharlen = 0;
#endif
                    break;
                }
            }

            if (sp->ts_curi >= gap->ga_len && sp->ts_state == STATE_REP)
                /* No (more) matches. */
                sp->ts_state = STATE_FINAL;

            break;

        case STATE_REP_UNDO:
            /* Undo a REP replacement and continue with the next one. */
            if (soundfold)
                gap = &slang->sl_repsal;
            else
                gap = &lp->lp_replang->sl_rep;
            ftp = (fromto_T *)gap->ga_data + sp->ts_curi - 1;
            fl = (int)STRLEN(ftp->ft_from);
            tl = (int)STRLEN(ftp->ft_to);
            p = fword + sp->ts_fidx;
            if (fl != tl)
            {
                mch_memmove(p + fl, p + tl, STRLEN(p + tl) + 1);
                repextra -= tl - fl;
            }
            mch_memmove(p, ftp->ft_from, fl);
            sp->ts_state = STATE_REP;
            break;

        default:
            /* Did all possible states at this level, go up one level. */
            --depth;

            if (depth >= 0 && stack[depth].ts_prefixdepth == PFD_PREFIXTREE)
            {
                /* Continue in or go back to the prefix tree. */
                byts = pbyts;
                idxs = pidxs;
            }

            /* Don't check for CTRL-C too often, it takes time. */
            if (--breakcheckcount == 0)
            {
                ui_breakcheck();
                breakcheckcount = 1000;
            }
        }
    }
}


/*
 * Go one level deeper in the tree.
 */
    static void
go_deeper(stack, depth, score_add)
    trystate_T  *stack;
    int         depth;
    int         score_add;
{
    stack[depth + 1] = stack[depth];
    stack[depth + 1].ts_state = STATE_START;
    stack[depth + 1].ts_score = stack[depth].ts_score + score_add;
    stack[depth + 1].ts_curi = 1;       /* start just after length byte */
    stack[depth + 1].ts_flags = 0;
}

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
/*
 * Case-folding may change the number of bytes: Count nr of chars in
 * fword[flen] and return the byte length of that many chars in "word".
 */
    static int
nofold_len(fword, flen, word)
    char_u      *fword;
    int         flen;
    char_u      *word;
{
    char_u      *p;
    int         i = 0;

    for (p = fword; p < fword + flen; mb_ptr_adv(p))
        ++i;
    for (p = word; i > 0; mb_ptr_adv(p))
        --i;
    return (int)(p - word);
}
#endif

/*
 * "fword" is a good word with case folded.  Find the matching keep-case
 * words and put it in "kword".
 * Theoretically there could be several keep-case words that result in the
 * same case-folded word, but we only find one...
 */
    static void
find_keepcap_word(slang, fword, kword)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *fword;
    char_u      *kword;
{
    char_u      uword[MAXWLEN];         /* "fword" in upper-case */
    int         depth;
    idx_T       tryidx;

    /* The following arrays are used at each depth in the tree. */
    idx_T       arridx[MAXWLEN];
    int         round[MAXWLEN];
    int         fwordidx[MAXWLEN];
    int         uwordidx[MAXWLEN];
    int         kwordlen[MAXWLEN];

    int         flen, ulen;
    int         l;
    int         len;
    int         c;
    idx_T       lo, hi, m;
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *byts = slang->sl_kbyts;    /* array with bytes of the words */
    idx_T       *idxs = slang->sl_kidxs;    /* array with indexes */

    if (byts == NULL)
    {
        /* array is empty: "cannot happen" */
        *kword = NUL;
        return;
    }

    /* Make an all-cap version of "fword". */
    allcap_copy(fword, uword);

    /*
     * Each character needs to be tried both case-folded and upper-case.
     * All this gets very complicated if we keep in mind that changing case
     * may change the byte length of a multi-byte character...
     */
    depth = 0;
    arridx[0] = 0;
    round[0] = 0;
    fwordidx[0] = 0;
    uwordidx[0] = 0;
    kwordlen[0] = 0;
    while (depth >= 0)
    {
        if (fword[fwordidx[depth]] == NUL)
        {
            /* We are at the end of "fword".  If the tree allows a word to end
             * here we have found a match. */
            if (byts[arridx[depth] + 1] == 0)
            {
                kword[kwordlen[depth]] = NUL;
                return;
            }

            /* kword is getting too long, continue one level up */
            --depth;
        }
        else if (++round[depth] > 2)
        {
            /* tried both fold-case and upper-case character, continue one
             * level up */
            --depth;
        }
        else
        {
            /*
             * round[depth] == 1: Try using the folded-case character.
             * round[depth] == 2: Try using the upper-case character.
             */
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                flen = mb_cptr2len(fword + fwordidx[depth]);
                ulen = mb_cptr2len(uword + uwordidx[depth]);
            }
            else
#endif
                ulen = flen = 1;
            if (round[depth] == 1)
            {
                p = fword + fwordidx[depth];
                l = flen;
            }
            else
            {
                p = uword + uwordidx[depth];
                l = ulen;
            }

            for (tryidx = arridx[depth]; l > 0; --l)
            {
                /* Perform a binary search in the list of accepted bytes. */
                len = byts[tryidx++];
                c = *p++;
                lo = tryidx;
                hi = tryidx + len - 1;
                while (lo < hi)
                {
                    m = (lo + hi) / 2;
                    if (byts[m] > c)
                        hi = m - 1;
                    else if (byts[m] < c)
                        lo = m + 1;
                    else
                    {
                        lo = hi = m;
                        break;
                    }
                }

                /* Stop if there is no matching byte. */
                if (hi < lo || byts[lo] != c)
                    break;

                /* Continue at the child (if there is one). */
                tryidx = idxs[lo];
            }

            if (l == 0)
            {
                /*
                 * Found the matching char.  Copy it to "kword" and go a
                 * level deeper.
                 */
                if (round[depth] == 1)
                {
                    STRNCPY(kword + kwordlen[depth], fword + fwordidx[depth],
                                                                        flen);
                    kwordlen[depth + 1] = kwordlen[depth] + flen;
                }
                else
                {
                    STRNCPY(kword + kwordlen[depth], uword + uwordidx[depth],
                                                                        ulen);
                    kwordlen[depth + 1] = kwordlen[depth] + ulen;
                }
                fwordidx[depth + 1] = fwordidx[depth] + flen;
                uwordidx[depth + 1] = uwordidx[depth] + ulen;

                ++depth;
                arridx[depth] = tryidx;
                round[depth] = 0;
            }
        }
    }

    /* Didn't find it: "cannot happen". */
    *kword = NUL;
}

/*
 * Compute the sound-a-like score for suggestions in su->su_ga and add them to
 * su->su_sga.
 */
    static void
score_comp_sal(su)
    suginfo_T   *su;
{
    langp_T     *lp;
    char_u      badsound[MAXWLEN];
    int         i;
    suggest_T   *stp;
    suggest_T   *sstp;
    int         score;
    int         lpi;

    if (ga_grow(&su->su_sga, su->su_ga.ga_len) == FAIL)
        return;

    /*  Use the sound-folding of the first language that supports it. */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);
        if (lp->lp_slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0)
        {
            /* soundfold the bad word */
            spell_soundfold(lp->lp_slang, su->su_fbadword, TRUE, badsound);

            for (i = 0; i < su->su_ga.ga_len; ++i)
            {
                stp = &SUG(su->su_ga, i);

                /* Case-fold the suggested word, sound-fold it and compute the
                 * sound-a-like score. */
                score = stp_sal_score(stp, su, lp->lp_slang, badsound);
                if (score < SCORE_MAXMAX)
                {
                    /* Add the suggestion. */
                    sstp = &SUG(su->su_sga, su->su_sga.ga_len);
                    sstp->st_word = vim_strsave(stp->st_word);
                    if (sstp->st_word != NULL)
                    {
                        sstp->st_wordlen = stp->st_wordlen;
                        sstp->st_score = score;
                        sstp->st_altscore = 0;
                        sstp->st_orglen = stp->st_orglen;
                        ++su->su_sga.ga_len;
                    }
                }
            }
            break;
        }
    }
}

/*
 * Combine the list of suggestions in su->su_ga and su->su_sga.
 * They are intwined.
 */
    static void
score_combine(su)
    suginfo_T   *su;
{
    int         i;
    int         j;
    garray_T    ga;
    garray_T    *gap;
    langp_T     *lp;
    suggest_T   *stp;
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      badsound[MAXWLEN];
    int         round;
    int         lpi;
    slang_T     *slang = NULL;

    /* Add the alternate score to su_ga. */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);
        if (lp->lp_slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0)
        {
            /* soundfold the bad word */
            slang = lp->lp_slang;
            spell_soundfold(slang, su->su_fbadword, TRUE, badsound);

            for (i = 0; i < su->su_ga.ga_len; ++i)
            {
                stp = &SUG(su->su_ga, i);
                stp->st_altscore = stp_sal_score(stp, su, slang, badsound);
                if (stp->st_altscore == SCORE_MAXMAX)
                    stp->st_score = (stp->st_score * 3 + SCORE_BIG) / 4;
                else
                    stp->st_score = (stp->st_score * 3
                                                  + stp->st_altscore) / 4;
                stp->st_salscore = FALSE;
            }
            break;
        }
    }

    if (slang == NULL)  /* Using "double" without sound folding. */
    {
        (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su->su_ga, su->su_maxscore,
                                                             su->su_maxcount);
        return;
    }

    /* Add the alternate score to su_sga. */
    for (i = 0; i < su->su_sga.ga_len; ++i)
    {
        stp = &SUG(su->su_sga, i);
        stp->st_altscore = spell_edit_score(slang,
                                                su->su_badword, stp->st_word);
        if (stp->st_score == SCORE_MAXMAX)
            stp->st_score = (SCORE_BIG * 7 + stp->st_altscore) / 8;
        else
            stp->st_score = (stp->st_score * 7 + stp->st_altscore) / 8;
        stp->st_salscore = TRUE;
    }

    /* Remove bad suggestions, sort the suggestions and truncate at "maxcount"
     * for both lists. */
    check_suggestions(su, &su->su_ga);
    (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su->su_ga, su->su_maxscore, su->su_maxcount);
    check_suggestions(su, &su->su_sga);
    (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su->su_sga, su->su_maxscore, su->su_maxcount);

    ga_init2(&ga, (int)sizeof(suginfo_T), 1);
    if (ga_grow(&ga, su->su_ga.ga_len + su->su_sga.ga_len) == FAIL)
        return;

    stp = &SUG(ga, 0);
    for (i = 0; i < su->su_ga.ga_len || i < su->su_sga.ga_len; ++i)
    {
        /* round 1: get a suggestion from su_ga
         * round 2: get a suggestion from su_sga */
        for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round)
        {
            gap = round == 1 ? &su->su_ga : &su->su_sga;
            if (i < gap->ga_len)
            {
                /* Don't add a word if it's already there. */
                p = SUG(*gap, i).st_word;
                for (j = 0; j < ga.ga_len; ++j)
                    if (STRCMP(stp[j].st_word, p) == 0)
                        break;
                if (j == ga.ga_len)
                    stp[ga.ga_len++] = SUG(*gap, i);
                else
                    vim_free(p);
            }
        }
    }

    ga_clear(&su->su_ga);
    ga_clear(&su->su_sga);

    /* Truncate the list to the number of suggestions that will be displayed. */
    if (ga.ga_len > su->su_maxcount)
    {
        for (i = su->su_maxcount; i < ga.ga_len; ++i)
            vim_free(stp[i].st_word);
        ga.ga_len = su->su_maxcount;
    }

    su->su_ga = ga;
}

/*
 * For the goodword in "stp" compute the soundalike score compared to the
 * badword.
 */
    static int
stp_sal_score(stp, su, slang, badsound)
    suggest_T   *stp;
    suginfo_T   *su;
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *badsound;      /* sound-folded badword */
{
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *pbad;
    char_u      *pgood;
    char_u      badsound2[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      fword[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      goodsound[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      goodword[MAXWLEN];
    int         lendiff;

    lendiff = (int)(su->su_badlen - stp->st_orglen);
    if (lendiff >= 0)
        pbad = badsound;
    else
    {
        /* soundfold the bad word with more characters following */
        (void)spell_casefold(su->su_badptr, stp->st_orglen, fword, MAXWLEN);

        /* When joining two words the sound often changes a lot.  E.g., "t he"
         * sounds like "t h" while "the" sounds like "@".  Avoid that by
         * removing the space.  Don't do it when the good word also contains a
         * space. */
        if (vim_iswhite(su->su_badptr[su->su_badlen])
                                         && *skiptowhite(stp->st_word) == NUL)
            for (p = fword; *(p = skiptowhite(p)) != NUL; )
                mch_memmove(p, p + 1, STRLEN(p));

        spell_soundfold(slang, fword, TRUE, badsound2);
        pbad = badsound2;
    }

    if (lendiff > 0)
    {
        /* Add part of the bad word to the good word, so that we soundfold
         * what replaces the bad word. */
        STRCPY(goodword, stp->st_word);
        vim_strncpy(goodword + stp->st_wordlen,
                            su->su_badptr + su->su_badlen - lendiff, lendiff);
        pgood = goodword;
    }
    else
        pgood = stp->st_word;

    /* Sound-fold the word and compute the score for the difference. */
    spell_soundfold(slang, pgood, FALSE, goodsound);

    return soundalike_score(goodsound, pbad);
}

/* structure used to store soundfolded words that add_sound_suggest() has
 * handled already. */
typedef struct
{
    short       sft_score;      /* lowest score used */
    char_u      sft_word[1];    /* soundfolded word, actually longer */
} sftword_T;

static sftword_T dumsft;
#define HIKEY2SFT(p)  ((sftword_T *)(p - (dumsft.sft_word - (char_u *)&dumsft)))
#define HI2SFT(hi)     HIKEY2SFT((hi)->hi_key)

/*
 * Prepare for calling suggest_try_soundalike().
 */
    static void
suggest_try_soundalike_prep()
{
    langp_T     *lp;
    int         lpi;
    slang_T     *slang;

    /* Do this for all languages that support sound folding and for which a
     * .sug file has been loaded. */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);
        slang = lp->lp_slang;
        if (slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0 && slang->sl_sbyts != NULL)
            /* prepare the hashtable used by add_sound_suggest() */
            hash_init(&slang->sl_sounddone);
    }
}

/*
 * Find suggestions by comparing the word in a sound-a-like form.
 * Note: This doesn't support postponed prefixes.
 */
    static void
suggest_try_soundalike(su)
    suginfo_T   *su;
{
    char_u      salword[MAXWLEN];
    langp_T     *lp;
    int         lpi;
    slang_T     *slang;

    /* Do this for all languages that support sound folding and for which a
     * .sug file has been loaded. */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);
        slang = lp->lp_slang;
        if (slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0 && slang->sl_sbyts != NULL)
        {
            /* soundfold the bad word */
            spell_soundfold(slang, su->su_fbadword, TRUE, salword);

            /* try all kinds of inserts/deletes/swaps/etc. */
            /* TODO: also soundfold the next words, so that we can try joining
             * and splitting */
            suggest_trie_walk(su, lp, salword, TRUE);
        }
    }
}

/*
 * Finish up after calling suggest_try_soundalike().
 */
    static void
suggest_try_soundalike_finish()
{
    langp_T     *lp;
    int         lpi;
    slang_T     *slang;
    int         todo;
    hashitem_T  *hi;

    /* Do this for all languages that support sound folding and for which a
     * .sug file has been loaded. */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);
        slang = lp->lp_slang;
        if (slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0 && slang->sl_sbyts != NULL)
        {
            /* Free the info about handled words. */
            todo = (int)slang->sl_sounddone.ht_used;
            for (hi = slang->sl_sounddone.ht_array; todo > 0; ++hi)
                if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
                {
                    vim_free(HI2SFT(hi));
                    --todo;
                }

            /* Clear the hashtable, it may also be used by another region. */
            hash_clear(&slang->sl_sounddone);
            hash_init(&slang->sl_sounddone);
        }
    }
}

/*
 * A match with a soundfolded word is found.  Add the good word(s) that
 * produce this soundfolded word.
 */
    static void
add_sound_suggest(su, goodword, score, lp)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    char_u      *goodword;
    int         score;          /* soundfold score  */
    langp_T     *lp;
{
    slang_T     *slang = lp->lp_slang;  /* language for sound folding */
    int         sfwordnr;
    char_u      *nrline;
    int         orgnr;
    char_u      theword[MAXWLEN];
    int         i;
    int         wlen;
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;
    int         n;
    int         wordcount;
    int         wc;
    int         goodscore;
    hash_T      hash;
    hashitem_T  *hi;
    sftword_T   *sft;
    int         bc, gc;
    int         limit;

    /*
     * It's very well possible that the same soundfold word is found several
     * times with different scores.  Since the following is quite slow only do
     * the words that have a better score than before.  Use a hashtable to
     * remember the words that have been done.
     */
    hash = hash_hash(goodword);
    hi = hash_lookup(&slang->sl_sounddone, goodword, hash);
    if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
    {
        sft = (sftword_T *)alloc((unsigned)(sizeof(sftword_T)
                                                         + STRLEN(goodword)));
        if (sft != NULL)
        {
            sft->sft_score = score;
            STRCPY(sft->sft_word, goodword);
            hash_add_item(&slang->sl_sounddone, hi, sft->sft_word, hash);
        }
    }
    else
    {
        sft = HI2SFT(hi);
        if (score >= sft->sft_score)
            return;
        sft->sft_score = score;
    }

    /*
     * Find the word nr in the soundfold tree.
     */
    sfwordnr = soundfold_find(slang, goodword);
    if (sfwordnr < 0)
    {
        EMSG2(_(e_intern2), "add_sound_suggest()");
        return;
    }

    /*
     * go over the list of good words that produce this soundfold word
     */
    nrline = ml_get_buf(slang->sl_sugbuf, (linenr_T)(sfwordnr + 1), FALSE);
    orgnr = 0;
    while (*nrline != NUL)
    {
        /* The wordnr was stored in a minimal nr of bytes as an offset to the
         * previous wordnr. */
        orgnr += bytes2offset(&nrline);

        byts = slang->sl_fbyts;
        idxs = slang->sl_fidxs;

        /* Lookup the word "orgnr" one of the two tries. */
        n = 0;
        wlen = 0;
        wordcount = 0;
        for (;;)
        {
            i = 1;
            if (wordcount == orgnr && byts[n + 1] == NUL)
                break;  /* found end of word */

            if (byts[n + 1] == NUL)
                ++wordcount;

            /* skip over the NUL bytes */
            for ( ; byts[n + i] == NUL; ++i)
                if (i > byts[n])        /* safety check */
                {
                    STRCPY(theword + wlen, "BAD");
                    goto badword;
                }

            /* One of the siblings must have the word. */
            for ( ; i < byts[n]; ++i)
            {
                wc = idxs[idxs[n + i]]; /* nr of words under this byte */
                if (wordcount + wc > orgnr)
                    break;
                wordcount += wc;
            }

            theword[wlen++] = byts[n + i];
            n = idxs[n + i];
        }
badword:
        theword[wlen] = NUL;

        /* Go over the possible flags and regions. */
        for (; i <= byts[n] && byts[n + i] == NUL; ++i)
        {
            char_u      cword[MAXWLEN];
            char_u      *p;
            int         flags = (int)idxs[n + i];

            /* Skip words with the NOSUGGEST flag */
            if (flags & WF_NOSUGGEST)
                continue;

            if (flags & WF_KEEPCAP)
            {
                /* Must find the word in the keep-case tree. */
                find_keepcap_word(slang, theword, cword);
                p = cword;
            }
            else
            {
                flags |= su->su_badflags;
                if ((flags & WF_CAPMASK) != 0)
                {
                    /* Need to fix case according to "flags". */
                    make_case_word(theword, cword, flags);
                    p = cword;
                }
                else
                    p = theword;
            }

            /* Add the suggestion. */
            if (sps_flags & SPS_DOUBLE)
            {
                /* Add the suggestion if the score isn't too bad. */
                if (score <= su->su_maxscore)
                    add_suggestion(su, &su->su_sga, p, su->su_badlen,
                                               score, 0, FALSE, slang, FALSE);
            }
            else
            {
                /* Add a penalty for words in another region. */
                if ((flags & WF_REGION)
                            && (((unsigned)flags >> 16) & lp->lp_region) == 0)
                    goodscore = SCORE_REGION;
                else
                    goodscore = 0;

                /* Add a small penalty for changing the first letter from
                 * lower to upper case.  Helps for "tath" -> "Kath", which is
                 * less common thatn "tath" -> "path".  Don't do it when the
                 * letter is the same, that has already been counted. */
                gc = PTR2CHAR(p);
                if (SPELL_ISUPPER(gc))
                {
                    bc = PTR2CHAR(su->su_badword);
                    if (!SPELL_ISUPPER(bc)
                                      && SPELL_TOFOLD(bc) != SPELL_TOFOLD(gc))
                        goodscore += SCORE_ICASE / 2;
                }

                /* Compute the score for the good word.  This only does letter
                 * insert/delete/swap/replace.  REP items are not considered,
                 * which may make the score a bit higher.
                 * Use a limit for the score to make it work faster.  Use
                 * MAXSCORE(), because RESCORE() will change the score.
                 * If the limit is very high then the iterative method is
                 * inefficient, using an array is quicker. */
                limit = MAXSCORE(su->su_sfmaxscore - goodscore, score);
                if (limit > SCORE_LIMITMAX)
                    goodscore += spell_edit_score(slang, su->su_badword, p);
                else
                    goodscore += spell_edit_score_limit(slang, su->su_badword,
                                                                    p, limit);

                /* When going over the limit don't bother to do the rest. */
                if (goodscore < SCORE_MAXMAX)
                {
                    /* Give a bonus to words seen before. */
                    goodscore = score_wordcount_adj(slang, goodscore, p, FALSE);

                    /* Add the suggestion if the score isn't too bad. */
                    goodscore = RESCORE(goodscore, score);
                    if (goodscore <= su->su_sfmaxscore)
                        add_suggestion(su, &su->su_ga, p, su->su_badlen,
                                         goodscore, score, TRUE, slang, TRUE);
                }
            }
        }
        /* smsg("word %s (%d): %s (%d)", sftword, sftnr, theword, orgnr); */
    }
}

/*
 * Find word "word" in fold-case tree for "slang" and return the word number.
 */
    static int
soundfold_find(slang, word)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *word;
{
    idx_T       arridx = 0;
    int         len;
    int         wlen = 0;
    int         c;
    char_u      *ptr = word;
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;
    int         wordnr = 0;

    byts = slang->sl_sbyts;
    idxs = slang->sl_sidxs;

    for (;;)
    {
        /* First byte is the number of possible bytes. */
        len = byts[arridx++];

        /* If the first possible byte is a zero the word could end here.
         * If the word ends we found the word.  If not skip the NUL bytes. */
        c = ptr[wlen];
        if (byts[arridx] == NUL)
        {
            if (c == NUL)
                break;

            /* Skip over the zeros, there can be several. */
            while (len > 0 && byts[arridx] == NUL)
            {
                ++arridx;
                --len;
            }
            if (len == 0)
                return -1;    /* no children, word should have ended here */
            ++wordnr;
        }

        /* If the word ends we didn't find it. */
        if (c == NUL)
            return -1;

        /* Perform a binary search in the list of accepted bytes. */
        if (c == TAB)       /* <Tab> is handled like <Space> */
            c = ' ';
        while (byts[arridx] < c)
        {
            /* The word count is in the first idxs[] entry of the child. */
            wordnr += idxs[idxs[arridx]];
            ++arridx;
            if (--len == 0)     /* end of the bytes, didn't find it */
                return -1;
        }
        if (byts[arridx] != c)  /* didn't find the byte */
            return -1;

        /* Continue at the child (if there is one). */
        arridx = idxs[arridx];
        ++wlen;

        /* One space in the good word may stand for several spaces in the
         * checked word. */
        if (c == ' ')
            while (ptr[wlen] == ' ' || ptr[wlen] == TAB)
                ++wlen;
    }

    return wordnr;
}

/*
 * Copy "fword" to "cword", fixing case according to "flags".
 */
    static void
make_case_word(fword, cword, flags)
    char_u      *fword;
    char_u      *cword;
    int         flags;
{
    if (flags & WF_ALLCAP)
        /* Make it all upper-case */
        allcap_copy(fword, cword);
    else if (flags & WF_ONECAP)
        /* Make the first letter upper-case */
        onecap_copy(fword, cword, TRUE);
    else
        /* Use goodword as-is. */
        STRCPY(cword, fword);
}

/*
 * Use map string "map" for languages "lp".
 */
    static void
set_map_str(lp, map)
    slang_T     *lp;
    char_u      *map;
{
    char_u      *p;
    int         headc = 0;
    int         c;
    int         i;

    if (*map == NUL)
    {
        lp->sl_has_map = FALSE;
        return;
    }
    lp->sl_has_map = TRUE;

    /* Init the array and hash tables empty. */
    for (i = 0; i < 256; ++i)
        lp->sl_map_array[i] = 0;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    hash_init(&lp->sl_map_hash);
#endif

    /*
     * The similar characters are stored separated with slashes:
     * "aaa/bbb/ccc/".  Fill sl_map_array[c] with the character before c and
     * before the same slash.  For characters above 255 sl_map_hash is used.
     */
    for (p = map; *p != NUL; )
    {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        c = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
#else
        c = *p++;
#endif
        if (c == '/')
            headc = 0;
        else
        {
            if (headc == 0)
                 headc = c;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            /* Characters above 255 don't fit in sl_map_array[], put them in
             * the hash table.  Each entry is the char, a NUL the headchar and
             * a NUL. */
            if (c >= 256)
            {
                int         cl = mb_char2len(c);
                int         headcl = mb_char2len(headc);
                char_u      *b;
                hash_T      hash;
                hashitem_T  *hi;

                b = alloc((unsigned)(cl + headcl + 2));
                if (b == NULL)
                    return;
                mb_char2bytes(c, b);
                b[cl] = NUL;
                mb_char2bytes(headc, b + cl + 1);
                b[cl + 1 + headcl] = NUL;
                hash = hash_hash(b);
                hi = hash_lookup(&lp->sl_map_hash, b, hash);
                if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
                    hash_add_item(&lp->sl_map_hash, hi, b, hash);
                else
                {
                    /* This should have been checked when generating the .spl
                     * file. */
                    EMSG(_("E783: duplicate char in MAP entry"));
                    vim_free(b);
                }
            }
            else
#endif
                lp->sl_map_array[c] = headc;
        }
    }
}

/*
 * Return TRUE if "c1" and "c2" are similar characters according to the MAP
 * lines in the .aff file.
 */
    static int
similar_chars(slang, c1, c2)
    slang_T     *slang;
    int         c1;
    int         c2;
{
    int         m1, m2;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    char_u      buf[MB_MAXBYTES];
    hashitem_T  *hi;

    if (c1 >= 256)
    {
        buf[mb_char2bytes(c1, buf)] = 0;
        hi = hash_find(&slang->sl_map_hash, buf);
        if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
            m1 = 0;
        else
            m1 = mb_ptr2char(hi->hi_key + STRLEN(hi->hi_key) + 1);
    }
    else
#endif
        m1 = slang->sl_map_array[c1];
    if (m1 == 0)
        return FALSE;


#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (c2 >= 256)
    {
        buf[mb_char2bytes(c2, buf)] = 0;
        hi = hash_find(&slang->sl_map_hash, buf);
        if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
            m2 = 0;
        else
            m2 = mb_ptr2char(hi->hi_key + STRLEN(hi->hi_key) + 1);
    }
    else
#endif
        m2 = slang->sl_map_array[c2];

    return m1 == m2;
}

/*
 * Add a suggestion to the list of suggestions.
 * For a suggestion that is already in the list the lowest score is remembered.
 */
    static void
add_suggestion(su, gap, goodword, badlenarg, score, altscore, had_bonus,
                                                                 slang, maxsf)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    garray_T    *gap;           /* either su_ga or su_sga */
    char_u      *goodword;
    int         badlenarg;      /* len of bad word replaced with "goodword" */
    int         score;
    int         altscore;
    int         had_bonus;      /* value for st_had_bonus */
    slang_T     *slang;         /* language for sound folding */
    int         maxsf;          /* su_maxscore applies to soundfold score,
                                   su_sfmaxscore to the total score. */
{
    int         goodlen;        /* len of goodword changed */
    int         badlen;         /* len of bad word changed */
    suggest_T   *stp;
    suggest_T   new_sug;
    int         i;
    char_u      *pgood, *pbad;

    /* Minimize "badlen" for consistency.  Avoids that changing "the the" to
     * "thee the" is added next to changing the first "the" the "thee".  */
    pgood = goodword + STRLEN(goodword);
    pbad = su->su_badptr + badlenarg;
    for (;;)
    {
        goodlen = (int)(pgood - goodword);
        badlen = (int)(pbad - su->su_badptr);
        if (goodlen <= 0 || badlen <= 0)
            break;
        mb_ptr_back(goodword, pgood);
        mb_ptr_back(su->su_badptr, pbad);
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (has_mbyte)
        {
            if (mb_ptr2char(pgood) != mb_ptr2char(pbad))
                break;
        }
        else
#endif
            if (*pgood != *pbad)
                break;
    }

    if (badlen == 0 && goodlen == 0)
        /* goodword doesn't change anything; may happen for "the the" changing
         * the first "the" to itself. */
        return;

    if (gap->ga_len == 0)
        i = -1;
    else
    {
        /* Check if the word is already there.  Also check the length that is
         * being replaced "thes," -> "these" is a different suggestion from
         * "thes" -> "these". */
        stp = &SUG(*gap, 0);
        for (i = gap->ga_len; --i >= 0; ++stp)
            if (stp->st_wordlen == goodlen
                    && stp->st_orglen == badlen
                    && STRNCMP(stp->st_word, goodword, goodlen) == 0)
            {
                /*
                 * Found it.  Remember the word with the lowest score.
                 */
                if (stp->st_slang == NULL)
                    stp->st_slang = slang;

                new_sug.st_score = score;
                new_sug.st_altscore = altscore;
                new_sug.st_had_bonus = had_bonus;

                if (stp->st_had_bonus != had_bonus)
                {
                    /* Only one of the two had the soundalike score computed.
                     * Need to do that for the other one now, otherwise the
                     * scores can't be compared.  This happens because
                     * suggest_try_change() doesn't compute the soundalike
                     * word to keep it fast, while some special methods set
                     * the soundalike score to zero. */
                    if (had_bonus)
                        rescore_one(su, stp);
                    else
                    {
                        new_sug.st_word = stp->st_word;
                        new_sug.st_wordlen = stp->st_wordlen;
                        new_sug.st_slang = stp->st_slang;
                        new_sug.st_orglen = badlen;
                        rescore_one(su, &new_sug);
                    }
                }

                if (stp->st_score > new_sug.st_score)
                {
                    stp->st_score = new_sug.st_score;
                    stp->st_altscore = new_sug.st_altscore;
                    stp->st_had_bonus = new_sug.st_had_bonus;
                }
                break;
            }
    }

    if (i < 0 && ga_grow(gap, 1) == OK)
    {
        /* Add a suggestion. */
        stp = &SUG(*gap, gap->ga_len);
        stp->st_word = vim_strnsave(goodword, goodlen);
        if (stp->st_word != NULL)
        {
            stp->st_wordlen = goodlen;
            stp->st_score = score;
            stp->st_altscore = altscore;
            stp->st_had_bonus = had_bonus;
            stp->st_orglen = badlen;
            stp->st_slang = slang;
            ++gap->ga_len;

            /* If we have too many suggestions now, sort the list and keep
             * the best suggestions. */
            if (gap->ga_len > SUG_MAX_COUNT(su))
            {
                if (maxsf)
                    su->su_sfmaxscore = cleanup_suggestions(gap,
                                      su->su_sfmaxscore, SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su));
                else
                {
                    i = su->su_maxscore;
                    su->su_maxscore = cleanup_suggestions(gap,
                                        su->su_maxscore, SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su));
                }
            }
        }
    }
}

/*
 * Suggestions may in fact be flagged as errors.  Esp. for banned words and
 * for split words, such as "the the".  Remove these from the list here.
 */
    static void
check_suggestions(su, gap)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    garray_T    *gap;               /* either su_ga or su_sga */
{
    suggest_T   *stp;
    int         i;
    char_u      longword[MAXWLEN + 1];
    int         len;
    hlf_T       attr;

    stp = &SUG(*gap, 0);
    for (i = gap->ga_len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
    {
        /* Need to append what follows to check for "the the". */
        STRCPY(longword, stp[i].st_word);
        len = stp[i].st_wordlen;
        vim_strncpy(longword + len, su->su_badptr + stp[i].st_orglen,
                                                               MAXWLEN - len);
        attr = HLF_COUNT;
        (void)spell_check(curwin, longword, &attr, NULL, FALSE);
        if (attr != HLF_COUNT)
        {
            /* Remove this entry. */
            vim_free(stp[i].st_word);
            --gap->ga_len;
            if (i < gap->ga_len)
                mch_memmove(stp + i, stp + i + 1,
                                       sizeof(suggest_T) * (gap->ga_len - i));
        }
    }
}


/*
 * Add a word to be banned.
 */
    static void
add_banned(su, word)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    char_u      *word;
{
    char_u      *s;
    hash_T      hash;
    hashitem_T  *hi;

    hash = hash_hash(word);
    hi = hash_lookup(&su->su_banned, word, hash);
    if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
    {
        s = vim_strsave(word);
        if (s != NULL)
            hash_add_item(&su->su_banned, hi, s, hash);
    }
}

/*
 * Recompute the score for all suggestions if sound-folding is possible.  This
 * is slow, thus only done for the final results.
 */
    static void
rescore_suggestions(su)
    suginfo_T   *su;
{
    int         i;

    if (su->su_sallang != NULL)
        for (i = 0; i < su->su_ga.ga_len; ++i)
            rescore_one(su, &SUG(su->su_ga, i));
}

/*
 * Recompute the score for one suggestion if sound-folding is possible.
 */
    static void
rescore_one(su, stp)
    suginfo_T   *su;
    suggest_T   *stp;
{
    slang_T     *slang = stp->st_slang;
    char_u      sal_badword[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      *p;

    /* Only rescore suggestions that have no sal score yet and do have a
     * language. */
    if (slang != NULL && slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0 && !stp->st_had_bonus)
    {
        if (slang == su->su_sallang)
            p = su->su_sal_badword;
        else
        {
            spell_soundfold(slang, su->su_fbadword, TRUE, sal_badword);
            p = sal_badword;
        }

        stp->st_altscore = stp_sal_score(stp, su, slang, p);
        if (stp->st_altscore == SCORE_MAXMAX)
            stp->st_altscore = SCORE_BIG;
        stp->st_score = RESCORE(stp->st_score, stp->st_altscore);
        stp->st_had_bonus = TRUE;
    }
}

static int
#ifdef __BORLANDC__
_RTLENTRYF
#endif
sug_compare __ARGS((const void *s1, const void *s2));

/*
 * Function given to qsort() to sort the suggestions on st_score.
 * First on "st_score", then "st_altscore" then alphabetically.
 */
    static int
#ifdef __BORLANDC__
_RTLENTRYF
#endif
sug_compare(s1, s2)
    const void  *s1;
    const void  *s2;
{
    suggest_T   *p1 = (suggest_T *)s1;
    suggest_T   *p2 = (suggest_T *)s2;
    int         n = p1->st_score - p2->st_score;

    if (n == 0)
    {
        n = p1->st_altscore - p2->st_altscore;
        if (n == 0)
            n = STRICMP(p1->st_word, p2->st_word);
    }
    return n;
}

/*
 * Cleanup the suggestions:
 * - Sort on score.
 * - Remove words that won't be displayed.
 * Returns the maximum score in the list or "maxscore" unmodified.
 */
    static int
cleanup_suggestions(gap, maxscore, keep)
    garray_T    *gap;
    int         maxscore;
    int         keep;           /* nr of suggestions to keep */
{
    suggest_T   *stp = &SUG(*gap, 0);
    int         i;

    /* Sort the list. */
    qsort(gap->ga_data, (size_t)gap->ga_len, sizeof(suggest_T), sug_compare);

    /* Truncate the list to the number of suggestions that will be displayed. */
    if (gap->ga_len > keep)
    {
        for (i = keep; i < gap->ga_len; ++i)
            vim_free(stp[i].st_word);
        gap->ga_len = keep;
        return stp[keep - 1].st_score;
    }
    return maxscore;
}

#if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
/*
 * Soundfold a string, for soundfold().
 * Result is in allocated memory, NULL for an error.
 */
    char_u *
eval_soundfold(word)
    char_u      *word;
{
    langp_T     *lp;
    char_u      sound[MAXWLEN];
    int         lpi;

    if (curwin->w_p_spell && *curbuf->b_p_spl != NUL)
        /* Use the sound-folding of the first language that supports it. */
        for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
        {
            lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);
            if (lp->lp_slang->sl_sal.ga_len > 0)
            {
                /* soundfold the word */
                spell_soundfold(lp->lp_slang, word, FALSE, sound);
                return vim_strsave(sound);
            }
        }

    /* No language with sound folding, return word as-is. */
    return vim_strsave(word);
}
#endif

/*
 * Turn "inword" into its sound-a-like equivalent in "res[MAXWLEN]".
 *
 * There are many ways to turn a word into a sound-a-like representation.  The
 * oldest is Soundex (1918!).   A nice overview can be found in "Approximate
 * swedish name matching - survey and test of different algorithms" by Klas
 * Erikson.
 *
 * We support two methods:
 * 1. SOFOFROM/SOFOTO do a simple character mapping.
 * 2. SAL items define a more advanced sound-folding (and much slower).
 */
    static void
spell_soundfold(slang, inword, folded, res)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *inword;
    int         folded;     /* "inword" is already case-folded */
    char_u      *res;
{
    char_u      fword[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      *word;

    if (slang->sl_sofo)
        /* SOFOFROM and SOFOTO used */
        spell_soundfold_sofo(slang, inword, res);
    else
    {
        /* SAL items used.  Requires the word to be case-folded. */
        if (folded)
            word = inword;
        else
        {
            (void)spell_casefold(inword, (int)STRLEN(inword), fword, MAXWLEN);
            word = fword;
        }

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
        if (has_mbyte)
            spell_soundfold_wsal(slang, word, res);
        else
#endif
            spell_soundfold_sal(slang, word, res);
    }
}

/*
 * Perform sound folding of "inword" into "res" according to SOFOFROM and
 * SOFOTO lines.
 */
    static void
spell_soundfold_sofo(slang, inword, res)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *inword;
    char_u      *res;
{
    char_u      *s;
    int         ri = 0;
    int         c;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    if (has_mbyte)
    {
        int     prevc = 0;
        int     *ip;

        /* The sl_sal_first[] table contains the translation for chars up to
         * 255, sl_sal the rest. */
        for (s = inword; *s != NUL; )
        {
            c = mb_cptr2char_adv(&s);
            if (enc_utf8 ? utf_class(c) == 0 : vim_iswhite(c))
                c = ' ';
            else if (c < 256)
                c = slang->sl_sal_first[c];
            else
            {
                ip = ((int **)slang->sl_sal.ga_data)[c & 0xff];
                if (ip == NULL)         /* empty list, can't match */
                    c = NUL;
                else
                    for (;;)            /* find "c" in the list */
                    {
                        if (*ip == 0)   /* not found */
                        {
                            c = NUL;
                            break;
                        }
                        if (*ip == c)   /* match! */
                        {
                            c = ip[1];
                            break;
                        }
                        ip += 2;
                    }
            }

            if (c != NUL && c != prevc)
            {
                ri += mb_char2bytes(c, res + ri);
                if (ri + MB_MAXBYTES > MAXWLEN)
                    break;
                prevc = c;
            }
        }
    }
    else
#endif
    {
        /* The sl_sal_first[] table contains the translation. */
        for (s = inword; (c = *s) != NUL; ++s)
        {
            if (vim_iswhite(c))
                c = ' ';
            else
                c = slang->sl_sal_first[c];
            if (c != NUL && (ri == 0 || res[ri - 1] != c))
                res[ri++] = c;
        }
    }

    res[ri] = NUL;
}

    static void
spell_soundfold_sal(slang, inword, res)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *inword;
    char_u      *res;
{
    salitem_T   *smp;
    char_u      word[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      *s = inword;
    char_u      *t;
    char_u      *pf;
    int         i, j, z;
    int         reslen;
    int         n, k = 0;
    int         z0;
    int         k0;
    int         n0;
    int         c;
    int         pri;
    int         p0 = -333;
    int         c0;

    /* Remove accents, if wanted.  We actually remove all non-word characters.
     * But keep white space.  We need a copy, the word may be changed here. */
    if (slang->sl_rem_accents)
    {
        t = word;
        while (*s != NUL)
        {
            if (vim_iswhite(*s))
            {
                *t++ = ' ';
                s = skipwhite(s);
            }
            else
            {
                if (spell_iswordp_nmw(s))
                    *t++ = *s;
                ++s;
            }
        }
        *t = NUL;
    }
    else
        STRCPY(word, s);

    smp = (salitem_T *)slang->sl_sal.ga_data;

    /*
     * This comes from Aspell phonet.cpp.  Converted from C++ to C.
     * Changed to keep spaces.
     */
    i = reslen = z = 0;
    while ((c = word[i]) != NUL)
    {
        /* Start with the first rule that has the character in the word. */
        n = slang->sl_sal_first[c];
        z0 = 0;

        if (n >= 0)
        {
            /* check all rules for the same letter */
            for (; (s = smp[n].sm_lead)[0] == c; ++n)
            {
                /* Quickly skip entries that don't match the word.  Most
                 * entries are less then three chars, optimize for that. */
                k = smp[n].sm_leadlen;
                if (k > 1)
                {
                    if (word[i + 1] != s[1])
                        continue;
                    if (k > 2)
                    {
                        for (j = 2; j < k; ++j)
                            if (word[i + j] != s[j])
                                break;
                        if (j < k)
                            continue;
                    }
                }

                if ((pf = smp[n].sm_oneof) != NULL)
                {
                    /* Check for match with one of the chars in "sm_oneof". */
                    while (*pf != NUL && *pf != word[i + k])
                        ++pf;
                    if (*pf == NUL)
                        continue;
                    ++k;
                }
                s = smp[n].sm_rules;
                pri = 5;    /* default priority */

                p0 = *s;
                k0 = k;
                while (*s == '-' && k > 1)
                {
                    k--;
                    s++;
                }
                if (*s == '<')
                    s++;
                if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*s))
                {
                    /* determine priority */
                    pri = *s - '0';
                    s++;
                }
                if (*s == '^' && *(s + 1) == '^')
                    s++;

                if (*s == NUL
                        || (*s == '^'
                            && (i == 0 || !(word[i - 1] == ' '
                                      || spell_iswordp(word + i - 1, curbuf)))
                            && (*(s + 1) != '$'
                                || (!spell_iswordp(word + i + k0, curbuf))))
                        || (*s == '$' && i > 0
                            && spell_iswordp(word + i - 1, curbuf)
                            && (!spell_iswordp(word + i + k0, curbuf))))
                {
                    /* search for followup rules, if:    */
                    /* followup and k > 1  and  NO '-' in searchstring */
                    c0 = word[i + k - 1];
                    n0 = slang->sl_sal_first[c0];

                    if (slang->sl_followup && k > 1 && n0 >= 0
                                           && p0 != '-' && word[i + k] != NUL)
                    {
                        /* test follow-up rule for "word[i + k]" */
                        for ( ; (s = smp[n0].sm_lead)[0] == c0; ++n0)
                        {
                            /* Quickly skip entries that don't match the word.
                             * */
                            k0 = smp[n0].sm_leadlen;
                            if (k0 > 1)
                            {
                                if (word[i + k] != s[1])
                                    continue;
                                if (k0 > 2)
                                {
                                    pf = word + i + k + 1;
                                    for (j = 2; j < k0; ++j)
                                        if (*pf++ != s[j])
                                            break;
                                    if (j < k0)
                                        continue;
                                }
                            }
                            k0 += k - 1;

                            if ((pf = smp[n0].sm_oneof) != NULL)
                            {
                                /* Check for match with one of the chars in
                                 * "sm_oneof". */
                                while (*pf != NUL && *pf != word[i + k0])
                                    ++pf;
                                if (*pf == NUL)
                                    continue;
                                ++k0;
                            }

                            p0 = 5;
                            s = smp[n0].sm_rules;
                            while (*s == '-')
                            {
                                /* "k0" gets NOT reduced because
                                 * "if (k0 == k)" */
                                s++;
                            }
                            if (*s == '<')
                                s++;
                            if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*s))
                            {
                                p0 = *s - '0';
                                s++;
                            }

                            if (*s == NUL
                                    /* *s == '^' cuts */
                                    || (*s == '$'
                                            && !spell_iswordp(word + i + k0,
                                                                     curbuf)))
                            {
                                if (k0 == k)
                                    /* this is just a piece of the string */
                                    continue;

                                if (p0 < pri)
                                    /* priority too low */
                                    continue;
                                /* rule fits; stop search */
                                break;
                            }
                        }

                        if (p0 >= pri && smp[n0].sm_lead[0] == c0)
                            continue;
                    }

                    /* replace string */
                    s = smp[n].sm_to;
                    if (s == NULL)
                        s = (char_u *)"";
                    pf = smp[n].sm_rules;
                    p0 = (vim_strchr(pf, '<') != NULL) ? 1 : 0;
                    if (p0 == 1 && z == 0)
                    {
                        /* rule with '<' is used */
                        if (reslen > 0 && *s != NUL && (res[reslen - 1] == c
                                                    || res[reslen - 1] == *s))
                            reslen--;
                        z0 = 1;
                        z = 1;
                        k0 = 0;
                        while (*s != NUL && word[i + k0] != NUL)
                        {
                            word[i + k0] = *s;
                            k0++;
                            s++;
                        }
                        if (k > k0)
                            mch_memmove(word + i + k0, word + i + k,
                                                    STRLEN(word + i + k) + 1);

                        /* new "actual letter" */
                        c = word[i];
                    }
                    else
                    {
                        /* no '<' rule used */
                        i += k - 1;
                        z = 0;
                        while (*s != NUL && s[1] != NUL && reslen < MAXWLEN)
                        {
                            if (reslen == 0 || res[reslen - 1] != *s)
                                res[reslen++] = *s;
                            s++;
                        }
                        /* new "actual letter" */
                        c = *s;
                        if (strstr((char *)pf, "^^") != NULL)
                        {
                            if (c != NUL)
                                res[reslen++] = c;
                            mch_memmove(word, word + i + 1,
                                                    STRLEN(word + i + 1) + 1);
                            i = 0;
                            z0 = 1;
                        }
                    }
                    break;
                }
            }
        }
        else if (vim_iswhite(c))
        {
            c = ' ';
            k = 1;
        }

        if (z0 == 0)
        {
            if (k && !p0 && reslen < MAXWLEN && c != NUL
                    && (!slang->sl_collapse || reslen == 0
                                                     || res[reslen - 1] != c))
                /* condense only double letters */
                res[reslen++] = c;

            i++;
            z = 0;
            k = 0;
        }
    }

    res[reslen] = NUL;
}

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
/*
 * Turn "inword" into its sound-a-like equivalent in "res[MAXWLEN]".
 * Multi-byte version of spell_soundfold().
 */
    static void
spell_soundfold_wsal(slang, inword, res)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *inword;
    char_u      *res;
{
    salitem_T   *smp = (salitem_T *)slang->sl_sal.ga_data;
    int         word[MAXWLEN];
    int         wres[MAXWLEN];
    int         l;
    char_u      *s;
    int         *ws;
    char_u      *t;
    int         *pf;
    int         i, j, z;
    int         reslen;
    int         n, k = 0;
    int         z0;
    int         k0;
    int         n0;
    int         c;
    int         pri;
    int         p0 = -333;
    int         c0;
    int         did_white = FALSE;

    /*
     * Convert the multi-byte string to a wide-character string.
     * Remove accents, if wanted.  We actually remove all non-word characters.
     * But keep white space.
     */
    n = 0;
    for (s = inword; *s != NUL; )
    {
        t = s;
        c = mb_cptr2char_adv(&s);
        if (slang->sl_rem_accents)
        {
            if (enc_utf8 ? utf_class(c) == 0 : vim_iswhite(c))
            {
                if (did_white)
                    continue;
                c = ' ';
                did_white = TRUE;
            }
            else
            {
                did_white = FALSE;
                if (!spell_iswordp_nmw(t))
                    continue;
            }
        }
        word[n++] = c;
    }
    word[n] = NUL;

    /*
     * This comes from Aspell phonet.cpp.
     * Converted from C++ to C.  Added support for multi-byte chars.
     * Changed to keep spaces.
     */
    i = reslen = z = 0;
    while ((c = word[i]) != NUL)
    {
        /* Start with the first rule that has the character in the word. */
        n = slang->sl_sal_first[c & 0xff];
        z0 = 0;

        if (n >= 0)
        {
            /* check all rules for the same index byte */
            for (; ((ws = smp[n].sm_lead_w)[0] & 0xff) == (c & 0xff); ++n)
            {
                /* Quickly skip entries that don't match the word.  Most
                 * entries are less then three chars, optimize for that. */
                if (c != ws[0])
                    continue;
                k = smp[n].sm_leadlen;
                if (k > 1)
                {
                    if (word[i + 1] != ws[1])
                        continue;
                    if (k > 2)
                    {
                        for (j = 2; j < k; ++j)
                            if (word[i + j] != ws[j])
                                break;
                        if (j < k)
                            continue;
                    }
                }

                if ((pf = smp[n].sm_oneof_w) != NULL)
                {
                    /* Check for match with one of the chars in "sm_oneof". */
                    while (*pf != NUL && *pf != word[i + k])
                        ++pf;
                    if (*pf == NUL)
                        continue;
                    ++k;
                }
                s = smp[n].sm_rules;
                pri = 5;    /* default priority */

                p0 = *s;
                k0 = k;
                while (*s == '-' && k > 1)
                {
                    k--;
                    s++;
                }
                if (*s == '<')
                    s++;
                if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*s))
                {
                    /* determine priority */
                    pri = *s - '0';
                    s++;
                }
                if (*s == '^' && *(s + 1) == '^')
                    s++;

                if (*s == NUL
                        || (*s == '^'
                            && (i == 0 || !(word[i - 1] == ' '
                                    || spell_iswordp_w(word + i - 1, curbuf)))
                            && (*(s + 1) != '$'
                                || (!spell_iswordp_w(word + i + k0, curbuf))))
                        || (*s == '$' && i > 0
                            && spell_iswordp_w(word + i - 1, curbuf)
                            && (!spell_iswordp_w(word + i + k0, curbuf))))
                {
                    /* search for followup rules, if:    */
                    /* followup and k > 1  and  NO '-' in searchstring */
                    c0 = word[i + k - 1];
                    n0 = slang->sl_sal_first[c0 & 0xff];

                    if (slang->sl_followup && k > 1 && n0 >= 0
                                           && p0 != '-' && word[i + k] != NUL)
                    {
                        /* Test follow-up rule for "word[i + k]"; loop over
                         * all entries with the same index byte. */
                        for ( ; ((ws = smp[n0].sm_lead_w)[0] & 0xff)
                                                         == (c0 & 0xff); ++n0)
                        {
                            /* Quickly skip entries that don't match the word.
                             */
                            if (c0 != ws[0])
                                continue;
                            k0 = smp[n0].sm_leadlen;
                            if (k0 > 1)
                            {
                                if (word[i + k] != ws[1])
                                    continue;
                                if (k0 > 2)
                                {
                                    pf = word + i + k + 1;
                                    for (j = 2; j < k0; ++j)
                                        if (*pf++ != ws[j])
                                            break;
                                    if (j < k0)
                                        continue;
                                }
                            }
                            k0 += k - 1;

                            if ((pf = smp[n0].sm_oneof_w) != NULL)
                            {
                                /* Check for match with one of the chars in
                                 * "sm_oneof". */
                                while (*pf != NUL && *pf != word[i + k0])
                                    ++pf;
                                if (*pf == NUL)
                                    continue;
                                ++k0;
                            }

                            p0 = 5;
                            s = smp[n0].sm_rules;
                            while (*s == '-')
                            {
                                /* "k0" gets NOT reduced because
                                 * "if (k0 == k)" */
                                s++;
                            }
                            if (*s == '<')
                                s++;
                            if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*s))
                            {
                                p0 = *s - '0';
                                s++;
                            }

                            if (*s == NUL
                                    /* *s == '^' cuts */
                                    || (*s == '$'
                                         && !spell_iswordp_w(word + i + k0,
                                                                     curbuf)))
                            {
                                if (k0 == k)
                                    /* this is just a piece of the string */
                                    continue;

                                if (p0 < pri)
                                    /* priority too low */
                                    continue;
                                /* rule fits; stop search */
                                break;
                            }
                        }

                        if (p0 >= pri && (smp[n0].sm_lead_w[0] & 0xff)
                                                               == (c0 & 0xff))
                            continue;
                    }

                    /* replace string */
                    ws = smp[n].sm_to_w;
                    s = smp[n].sm_rules;
                    p0 = (vim_strchr(s, '<') != NULL) ? 1 : 0;
                    if (p0 == 1 && z == 0)
                    {
                        /* rule with '<' is used */
                        if (reslen > 0 && ws != NULL && *ws != NUL
                                && (wres[reslen - 1] == c
                                                    || wres[reslen - 1] == *ws))
                            reslen--;
                        z0 = 1;
                        z = 1;
                        k0 = 0;
                        if (ws != NULL)
                            while (*ws != NUL && word[i + k0] != NUL)
                            {
                                word[i + k0] = *ws;
                                k0++;
                                ws++;
                            }
                        if (k > k0)
                            mch_memmove(word + i + k0, word + i + k,
                                    sizeof(int) * (STRLEN(word + i + k) + 1));

                        /* new "actual letter" */
                        c = word[i];
                    }
                    else
                    {
                        /* no '<' rule used */
                        i += k - 1;
                        z = 0;
                        if (ws != NULL)
                            while (*ws != NUL && ws[1] != NUL
                                                          && reslen < MAXWLEN)
                            {
                                if (reslen == 0 || wres[reslen - 1] != *ws)
                                    wres[reslen++] = *ws;
                                ws++;
                            }
                        /* new "actual letter" */
                        if (ws == NULL)
                            c = NUL;
                        else
                            c = *ws;
                        if (strstr((char *)s, "^^") != NULL)
                        {
                            if (c != NUL)
                                wres[reslen++] = c;
                            mch_memmove(word, word + i + 1,
                                    sizeof(int) * (STRLEN(word + i + 1) + 1));
                            i = 0;
                            z0 = 1;
                        }
                    }
                    break;
                }
            }
        }
        else if (vim_iswhite(c))
        {
            c = ' ';
            k = 1;
        }

        if (z0 == 0)
        {
            if (k && !p0 && reslen < MAXWLEN && c != NUL
                    && (!slang->sl_collapse || reslen == 0
                                                     || wres[reslen - 1] != c))
                /* condense only double letters */
                wres[reslen++] = c;

            i++;
            z = 0;
            k = 0;
        }
    }

    /* Convert wide characters in "wres" to a multi-byte string in "res". */
    l = 0;
    for (n = 0; n < reslen; ++n)
    {
        l += mb_char2bytes(wres[n], res + l);
        if (l + MB_MAXBYTES > MAXWLEN)
            break;
    }
    res[l] = NUL;
}
#endif

/*
 * Compute a score for two sound-a-like words.
 * This permits up to two inserts/deletes/swaps/etc. to keep things fast.
 * Instead of a generic loop we write out the code.  That keeps it fast by
 * avoiding checks that will not be possible.
 */
    static int
soundalike_score(goodstart, badstart)
    char_u      *goodstart;     /* sound-folded good word */
    char_u      *badstart;      /* sound-folded bad word */
{
    char_u      *goodsound = goodstart;
    char_u      *badsound = badstart;
    int         goodlen;
    int         badlen;
    int         n;
    char_u      *pl, *ps;
    char_u      *pl2, *ps2;
    int         score = 0;

    /* adding/inserting "*" at the start (word starts with vowel) shouldn't be
     * counted so much, vowels halfway the word aren't counted at all. */
    if ((*badsound == '*' || *goodsound == '*') && *badsound != *goodsound)
    {
        if (badsound[1] == goodsound[1]
                || (badsound[1] != NUL
                    && goodsound[1] != NUL
                    && badsound[2] == goodsound[2]))
        {
            /* handle like a substitute */
        }
        else
        {
            score = 2 * SCORE_DEL / 3;
            if (*badsound == '*')
                ++badsound;
            else
                ++goodsound;
        }
    }

    goodlen = (int)STRLEN(goodsound);
    badlen = (int)STRLEN(badsound);

    /* Return quickly if the lengths are too different to be fixed by two
     * changes. */
    n = goodlen - badlen;
    if (n < -2 || n > 2)
        return SCORE_MAXMAX;

    if (n > 0)
    {
        pl = goodsound;     /* goodsound is longest */
        ps = badsound;
    }
    else
    {
        pl = badsound;      /* badsound is longest */
        ps = goodsound;
    }

    /* Skip over the identical part. */
    while (*pl == *ps && *pl != NUL)
    {
        ++pl;
        ++ps;
    }

    switch (n)
    {
        case -2:
        case 2:
            /*
             * Must delete two characters from "pl".
             */
            ++pl;       /* first delete */
            while (*pl == *ps)
            {
                ++pl;
                ++ps;
            }
            /* strings must be equal after second delete */
            if (STRCMP(pl + 1, ps) == 0)
                return score + SCORE_DEL * 2;

            /* Failed to compare. */
            break;

        case -1:
        case 1:
            /*
             * Minimal one delete from "pl" required.
             */

            /* 1: delete */
            pl2 = pl + 1;
            ps2 = ps;
            while (*pl2 == *ps2)
            {
                if (*pl2 == NUL)        /* reached the end */
                    return score + SCORE_DEL;
                ++pl2;
                ++ps2;
            }

            /* 2: delete then swap, then rest must be equal */
            if (pl2[0] == ps2[1] && pl2[1] == ps2[0]
                                             && STRCMP(pl2 + 2, ps2 + 2) == 0)
                return score + SCORE_DEL + SCORE_SWAP;

            /* 3: delete then substitute, then the rest must be equal */
            if (STRCMP(pl2 + 1, ps2 + 1) == 0)
                return score + SCORE_DEL + SCORE_SUBST;

            /* 4: first swap then delete */
            if (pl[0] == ps[1] && pl[1] == ps[0])
            {
                pl2 = pl + 2;       /* swap, skip two chars */
                ps2 = ps + 2;
                while (*pl2 == *ps2)
                {
                    ++pl2;
                    ++ps2;
                }
                /* delete a char and then strings must be equal */
                if (STRCMP(pl2 + 1, ps2) == 0)
                    return score + SCORE_SWAP + SCORE_DEL;
            }

            /* 5: first substitute then delete */
            pl2 = pl + 1;           /* substitute, skip one char */
            ps2 = ps + 1;
            while (*pl2 == *ps2)
            {
                ++pl2;
                ++ps2;
            }
            /* delete a char and then strings must be equal */
            if (STRCMP(pl2 + 1, ps2) == 0)
                return score + SCORE_SUBST + SCORE_DEL;

            /* Failed to compare. */
            break;

        case 0:
            /*
             * Lenghts are equal, thus changes must result in same length: An
             * insert is only possible in combination with a delete.
             * 1: check if for identical strings
             */
            if (*pl == NUL)
                return score;

            /* 2: swap */
            if (pl[0] == ps[1] && pl[1] == ps[0])
            {
                pl2 = pl + 2;       /* swap, skip two chars */
                ps2 = ps + 2;
                while (*pl2 == *ps2)
                {
                    if (*pl2 == NUL)    /* reached the end */
                        return score + SCORE_SWAP;
                    ++pl2;
                    ++ps2;
                }
                /* 3: swap and swap again */
                if (pl2[0] == ps2[1] && pl2[1] == ps2[0]
                                             && STRCMP(pl2 + 2, ps2 + 2) == 0)
                    return score + SCORE_SWAP + SCORE_SWAP;

                /* 4: swap and substitute */
                if (STRCMP(pl2 + 1, ps2 + 1) == 0)
                    return score + SCORE_SWAP + SCORE_SUBST;
            }

            /* 5: substitute */
            pl2 = pl + 1;
            ps2 = ps + 1;
            while (*pl2 == *ps2)
            {
                if (*pl2 == NUL)        /* reached the end */
                    return score + SCORE_SUBST;
                ++pl2;
                ++ps2;
            }

            /* 6: substitute and swap */
            if (pl2[0] == ps2[1] && pl2[1] == ps2[0]
                                             && STRCMP(pl2 + 2, ps2 + 2) == 0)
                return score + SCORE_SUBST + SCORE_SWAP;

            /* 7: substitute and substitute */
            if (STRCMP(pl2 + 1, ps2 + 1) == 0)
                return score + SCORE_SUBST + SCORE_SUBST;

            /* 8: insert then delete */
            pl2 = pl;
            ps2 = ps + 1;
            while (*pl2 == *ps2)
            {
                ++pl2;
                ++ps2;
            }
            if (STRCMP(pl2 + 1, ps2) == 0)
                return score + SCORE_INS + SCORE_DEL;

            /* 9: delete then insert */
            pl2 = pl + 1;
            ps2 = ps;
            while (*pl2 == *ps2)
            {
                ++pl2;
                ++ps2;
            }
            if (STRCMP(pl2, ps2 + 1) == 0)
                return score + SCORE_INS + SCORE_DEL;

            /* Failed to compare. */
            break;
    }

    return SCORE_MAXMAX;
}

/*
 * Compute the "edit distance" to turn "badword" into "goodword".  The less
 * deletes/inserts/substitutes/swaps are required the lower the score.
 *
 * The algorithm is described by Du and Chang, 1992.
 * The implementation of the algorithm comes from Aspell editdist.cpp,
 * edit_distance().  It has been converted from C++ to C and modified to
 * support multi-byte characters.
 */
    static int
spell_edit_score(slang, badword, goodword)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *badword;
    char_u      *goodword;
{
    int         *cnt;
    int         badlen, goodlen;        /* lengths including NUL */
    int         j, i;
    int         t;
    int         bc, gc;
    int         pbc, pgc;
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    char_u      *p;
    int         wbadword[MAXWLEN];
    int         wgoodword[MAXWLEN];

    if (has_mbyte)
    {
        /* Get the characters from the multi-byte strings and put them in an
         * int array for easy access. */
        for (p = badword, badlen = 0; *p != NUL; )
            wbadword[badlen++] = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
        wbadword[badlen++] = 0;
        for (p = goodword, goodlen = 0; *p != NUL; )
            wgoodword[goodlen++] = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
        wgoodword[goodlen++] = 0;
    }
    else
#endif
    {
        badlen = (int)STRLEN(badword) + 1;
        goodlen = (int)STRLEN(goodword) + 1;
    }

    /* We use "cnt" as an array: CNT(badword_idx, goodword_idx). */
#define CNT(a, b)   cnt[(a) + (b) * (badlen + 1)]
    cnt = (int *)lalloc((long_u)(sizeof(int) * (badlen + 1) * (goodlen + 1)),
                                                                        TRUE);
    if (cnt == NULL)
        return 0;       /* out of memory */

    CNT(0, 0) = 0;
    for (j = 1; j <= goodlen; ++j)
        CNT(0, j) = CNT(0, j - 1) + SCORE_INS;

    for (i = 1; i <= badlen; ++i)
    {
        CNT(i, 0) = CNT(i - 1, 0) + SCORE_DEL;
        for (j = 1; j <= goodlen; ++j)
        {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
            if (has_mbyte)
            {
                bc = wbadword[i - 1];
                gc = wgoodword[j - 1];
            }
            else
#endif
            {
                bc = badword[i - 1];
                gc = goodword[j - 1];
            }
            if (bc == gc)
                CNT(i, j) = CNT(i - 1, j - 1);
            else
            {
                /* Use a better score when there is only a case difference. */
                if (SPELL_TOFOLD(bc) == SPELL_TOFOLD(gc))
                    CNT(i, j) = SCORE_ICASE + CNT(i - 1, j - 1);
                else
                {
                    /* For a similar character use SCORE_SIMILAR. */
                    if (slang != NULL
                            && slang->sl_has_map
                            && similar_chars(slang, gc, bc))
                        CNT(i, j) = SCORE_SIMILAR + CNT(i - 1, j - 1);
                    else
                        CNT(i, j) = SCORE_SUBST + CNT(i - 1, j - 1);
                }

                if (i > 1 && j > 1)
                {
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    if (has_mbyte)
                    {
                        pbc = wbadword[i - 2];
                        pgc = wgoodword[j - 2];
                    }
                    else
#endif
                    {
                        pbc = badword[i - 2];
                        pgc = goodword[j - 2];
                    }
                    if (bc == pgc && pbc == gc)
                    {
                        t = SCORE_SWAP + CNT(i - 2, j - 2);
                        if (t < CNT(i, j))
                            CNT(i, j) = t;
                    }
                }
                t = SCORE_DEL + CNT(i - 1, j);
                if (t < CNT(i, j))
                    CNT(i, j) = t;
                t = SCORE_INS + CNT(i, j - 1);
                if (t < CNT(i, j))
                    CNT(i, j) = t;
            }
        }
    }

    i = CNT(badlen - 1, goodlen - 1);
    vim_free(cnt);
    return i;
}

typedef struct
{
    int         badi;
    int         goodi;
    int         score;
} limitscore_T;

/*
 * Like spell_edit_score(), but with a limit on the score to make it faster.
 * May return SCORE_MAXMAX when the score is higher than "limit".
 *
 * This uses a stack for the edits still to be tried.
 * The idea comes from Aspell leditdist.cpp.  Rewritten in C and added support
 * for multi-byte characters.
 */
    static int
spell_edit_score_limit(slang, badword, goodword, limit)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *badword;
    char_u      *goodword;
    int         limit;
{
    limitscore_T    stack[10];          /* allow for over 3 * 2 edits */
    int             stackidx;
    int             bi, gi;
    int             bi2, gi2;
    int             bc, gc;
    int             score;
    int             score_off;
    int             minscore;
    int             round;

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
    /* Multi-byte characters require a bit more work, use a different function
     * to avoid testing "has_mbyte" quite often. */
    if (has_mbyte)
        return spell_edit_score_limit_w(slang, badword, goodword, limit);
#endif

    /*
     * The idea is to go from start to end over the words.  So long as
     * characters are equal just continue, this always gives the lowest score.
     * When there is a difference try several alternatives.  Each alternative
     * increases "score" for the edit distance.  Some of the alternatives are
     * pushed unto a stack and tried later, some are tried right away.  At the
     * end of the word the score for one alternative is known.  The lowest
     * possible score is stored in "minscore".
     */
    stackidx = 0;
    bi = 0;
    gi = 0;
    score = 0;
    minscore = limit + 1;

    for (;;)
    {
        /* Skip over an equal part, score remains the same. */
        for (;;)
        {
            bc = badword[bi];
            gc = goodword[gi];
            if (bc != gc)       /* stop at a char that's different */
                break;
            if (bc == NUL)      /* both words end */
            {
                if (score < minscore)
                    minscore = score;
                goto pop;       /* do next alternative */
            }
            ++bi;
            ++gi;
        }

        if (gc == NUL)    /* goodword ends, delete badword chars */
        {
            do
            {
                if ((score += SCORE_DEL) >= minscore)
                    goto pop;       /* do next alternative */
            } while (badword[++bi] != NUL);
            minscore = score;
        }
        else if (bc == NUL) /* badword ends, insert badword chars */
        {
            do
            {
                if ((score += SCORE_INS) >= minscore)
                    goto pop;       /* do next alternative */
            } while (goodword[++gi] != NUL);
            minscore = score;
        }
        else                    /* both words continue */
        {
            /* If not close to the limit, perform a change.  Only try changes
             * that may lead to a lower score than "minscore".
             * round 0: try deleting a char from badword
             * round 1: try inserting a char in badword */
            for (round = 0; round <= 1; ++round)
            {
                score_off = score + (round == 0 ? SCORE_DEL : SCORE_INS);
                if (score_off < minscore)
                {
                    if (score_off + SCORE_EDIT_MIN >= minscore)
                    {
                        /* Near the limit, rest of the words must match.  We
                         * can check that right now, no need to push an item
                         * onto the stack. */
                        bi2 = bi + 1 - round;
                        gi2 = gi + round;
                        while (goodword[gi2] == badword[bi2])
                        {
                            if (goodword[gi2] == NUL)
                            {
                                minscore = score_off;
                                break;
                            }
                            ++bi2;
                            ++gi2;
                        }
                    }
                    else
                    {
                        /* try deleting/inserting a character later */
                        stack[stackidx].badi = bi + 1 - round;
                        stack[stackidx].goodi = gi + round;
                        stack[stackidx].score = score_off;
                        ++stackidx;
                    }
                }
            }

            if (score + SCORE_SWAP < minscore)
            {
                /* If swapping two characters makes a match then the
                 * substitution is more expensive, thus there is no need to
                 * try both. */
                if (gc == badword[bi + 1] && bc == goodword[gi + 1])
                {
                    /* Swap two characters, that is: skip them. */
                    gi += 2;
                    bi += 2;
                    score += SCORE_SWAP;
                    continue;
                }
            }

            /* Substitute one character for another which is the same
             * thing as deleting a character from both goodword and badword.
             * Use a better score when there is only a case difference. */
            if (SPELL_TOFOLD(bc) == SPELL_TOFOLD(gc))
                score += SCORE_ICASE;
            else
            {
                /* For a similar character use SCORE_SIMILAR. */
                if (slang != NULL
                        && slang->sl_has_map
                        && similar_chars(slang, gc, bc))
                    score += SCORE_SIMILAR;
                else
                    score += SCORE_SUBST;
            }

            if (score < minscore)
            {
                /* Do the substitution. */
                ++gi;
                ++bi;
                continue;
            }
        }
pop:
        /*
         * Get here to try the next alternative, pop it from the stack.
         */
        if (stackidx == 0)              /* stack is empty, finished */
            break;

        /* pop an item from the stack */
        --stackidx;
        gi = stack[stackidx].goodi;
        bi = stack[stackidx].badi;
        score = stack[stackidx].score;
    }

    /* When the score goes over "limit" it may actually be much higher.
     * Return a very large number to avoid going below the limit when giving a
     * bonus. */
    if (minscore > limit)
        return SCORE_MAXMAX;
    return minscore;
}

#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
/*
 * Multi-byte version of spell_edit_score_limit().
 * Keep it in sync with the above!
 */
    static int
spell_edit_score_limit_w(slang, badword, goodword, limit)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *badword;
    char_u      *goodword;
    int         limit;
{
    limitscore_T    stack[10];          /* allow for over 3 * 2 edits */
    int             stackidx;
    int             bi, gi;
    int             bi2, gi2;
    int             bc, gc;
    int             score;
    int             score_off;
    int             minscore;
    int             round;
    char_u          *p;
    int             wbadword[MAXWLEN];
    int             wgoodword[MAXWLEN];

    /* Get the characters from the multi-byte strings and put them in an
     * int array for easy access. */
    bi = 0;
    for (p = badword; *p != NUL; )
        wbadword[bi++] = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
    wbadword[bi++] = 0;
    gi = 0;
    for (p = goodword; *p != NUL; )
        wgoodword[gi++] = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p);
    wgoodword[gi++] = 0;

    /*
     * The idea is to go from start to end over the words.  So long as
     * characters are equal just continue, this always gives the lowest score.
     * When there is a difference try several alternatives.  Each alternative
     * increases "score" for the edit distance.  Some of the alternatives are
     * pushed unto a stack and tried later, some are tried right away.  At the
     * end of the word the score for one alternative is known.  The lowest
     * possible score is stored in "minscore".
     */
    stackidx = 0;
    bi = 0;
    gi = 0;
    score = 0;
    minscore = limit + 1;

    for (;;)
    {
        /* Skip over an equal part, score remains the same. */
        for (;;)
        {
            bc = wbadword[bi];
            gc = wgoodword[gi];

            if (bc != gc)       /* stop at a char that's different */
                break;
            if (bc == NUL)      /* both words end */
            {
                if (score < minscore)
                    minscore = score;
                goto pop;       /* do next alternative */
            }
            ++bi;
            ++gi;
        }

        if (gc == NUL)    /* goodword ends, delete badword chars */
        {
            do
            {
                if ((score += SCORE_DEL) >= minscore)
                    goto pop;       /* do next alternative */
            } while (wbadword[++bi] != NUL);
            minscore = score;
        }
        else if (bc == NUL) /* badword ends, insert badword chars */
        {
            do
            {
                if ((score += SCORE_INS) >= minscore)
                    goto pop;       /* do next alternative */
            } while (wgoodword[++gi] != NUL);
            minscore = score;
        }
        else                    /* both words continue */
        {
            /* If not close to the limit, perform a change.  Only try changes
             * that may lead to a lower score than "minscore".
             * round 0: try deleting a char from badword
             * round 1: try inserting a char in badword */
            for (round = 0; round <= 1; ++round)
            {
                score_off = score + (round == 0 ? SCORE_DEL : SCORE_INS);
                if (score_off < minscore)
                {
                    if (score_off + SCORE_EDIT_MIN >= minscore)
                    {
                        /* Near the limit, rest of the words must match.  We
                         * can check that right now, no need to push an item
                         * onto the stack. */
                        bi2 = bi + 1 - round;
                        gi2 = gi + round;
                        while (wgoodword[gi2] == wbadword[bi2])
                        {
                            if (wgoodword[gi2] == NUL)
                            {
                                minscore = score_off;
                                break;
                            }
                            ++bi2;
                            ++gi2;
                        }
                    }
                    else
                    {
                        /* try deleting a character from badword later */
                        stack[stackidx].badi = bi + 1 - round;
                        stack[stackidx].goodi = gi + round;
                        stack[stackidx].score = score_off;
                        ++stackidx;
                    }
                }
            }

            if (score + SCORE_SWAP < minscore)
            {
                /* If swapping two characters makes a match then the
                 * substitution is more expensive, thus there is no need to
                 * try both. */
                if (gc == wbadword[bi + 1] && bc == wgoodword[gi + 1])
                {
                    /* Swap two characters, that is: skip them. */
                    gi += 2;
                    bi += 2;
                    score += SCORE_SWAP;
                    continue;
                }
            }

            /* Substitute one character for another which is the same
             * thing as deleting a character from both goodword and badword.
             * Use a better score when there is only a case difference. */
            if (SPELL_TOFOLD(bc) == SPELL_TOFOLD(gc))
                score += SCORE_ICASE;
            else
            {
                /* For a similar character use SCORE_SIMILAR. */
                if (slang != NULL
                        && slang->sl_has_map
                        && similar_chars(slang, gc, bc))
                    score += SCORE_SIMILAR;
                else
                    score += SCORE_SUBST;
            }

            if (score < minscore)
            {
                /* Do the substitution. */
                ++gi;
                ++bi;
                continue;
            }
        }
pop:
        /*
         * Get here to try the next alternative, pop it from the stack.
         */
        if (stackidx == 0)              /* stack is empty, finished */
            break;

        /* pop an item from the stack */
        --stackidx;
        gi = stack[stackidx].goodi;
        bi = stack[stackidx].badi;
        score = stack[stackidx].score;
    }

    /* When the score goes over "limit" it may actually be much higher.
     * Return a very large number to avoid going below the limit when giving a
     * bonus. */
    if (minscore > limit)
        return SCORE_MAXMAX;
    return minscore;
}
#endif

/*
 * ":spellinfo"
 */
/*ARGSUSED*/
    void
ex_spellinfo(eap)
    exarg_T *eap;
{
    int         lpi;
    langp_T     *lp;
    char_u      *p;

    if (no_spell_checking(curwin))
        return;

    msg_start();
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < curbuf->b_langp.ga_len && !got_int; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf->b_langp, lpi);
        msg_puts((char_u *)"file: ");
        msg_puts(lp->lp_slang->sl_fname);
        msg_putchar('\n');
        p = lp->lp_slang->sl_info;
        if (p != NULL)
        {
            msg_puts(p);
            msg_putchar('\n');
        }
    }
    msg_end();
}

#define DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE   1   /* round 2: keep-case tree */
#define DUMPFLAG_COUNT      2   /* include word count */
#define DUMPFLAG_ICASE      4   /* ignore case when finding matches */
#define DUMPFLAG_ONECAP     8   /* pattern starts with capital */
#define DUMPFLAG_ALLCAP     16  /* pattern is all capitals */

/*
 * ":spelldump"
 */
    void
ex_spelldump(eap)
    exarg_T *eap;
{
    buf_T       *buf = curbuf;

    if (no_spell_checking(curwin))
        return;

    /* Create a new empty buffer by splitting the window. */
    do_cmdline_cmd((char_u *)"new");
    if (!bufempty() || !buf_valid(buf))
        return;

    spell_dump_compl(buf, NULL, 0, NULL, eap->forceit ? DUMPFLAG_COUNT : 0);

    /* Delete the empty line that we started with. */
    if (curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count > 1)
        ml_delete(curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count, FALSE);

    redraw_later(NOT_VALID);
}

/*
 * Go through all possible words and:
 * 1. When "pat" is NULL: dump a list of all words in the current buffer.
 *      "ic" and "dir" are not used.
 * 2. When "pat" is not NULL: add matching words to insert mode completion.
 */
    void
spell_dump_compl(buf, pat, ic, dir, dumpflags_arg)
    buf_T       *buf;       /* buffer with spell checking */
    char_u      *pat;       /* leading part of the word */
    int         ic;         /* ignore case */
    int         *dir;       /* direction for adding matches */
    int         dumpflags_arg;  /* DUMPFLAG_* */
{
    langp_T     *lp;
    slang_T     *slang;
    idx_T       arridx[MAXWLEN];
    int         curi[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      word[MAXWLEN];
    int         c;
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;
    linenr_T    lnum = 0;
    int         round;
    int         depth;
    int         n;
    int         flags;
    char_u      *region_names = NULL;       /* region names being used */
    int         do_region = TRUE;           /* dump region names and numbers */
    char_u      *p;
    int         lpi;
    int         dumpflags = dumpflags_arg;
    int         patlen;

    /* When ignoring case or when the pattern starts with capital pass this on
     * to dump_word(). */
    if (pat != NULL)
    {
        if (ic)
            dumpflags |= DUMPFLAG_ICASE;
        else
        {
            n = captype(pat, NULL);
            if (n == WF_ONECAP)
                dumpflags |= DUMPFLAG_ONECAP;
            else if (n == WF_ALLCAP
#ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
                    && (int)STRLEN(pat) > mb_ptr2len(pat)
#else
                    && (int)STRLEN(pat) > 1
#endif
                    )
                dumpflags |= DUMPFLAG_ALLCAP;
        }
    }

    /* Find out if we can support regions: All languages must support the same
     * regions or none at all. */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < buf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(buf->b_langp, lpi);
        p = lp->lp_slang->sl_regions;
        if (p[0] != 0)
        {
            if (region_names == NULL)       /* first language with regions */
                region_names = p;
            else if (STRCMP(region_names, p) != 0)
            {
                do_region = FALSE;          /* region names are different */
                break;
            }
        }
    }

    if (do_region && region_names != NULL)
    {
        if (pat == NULL)
        {
            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, "/regions=%s", region_names);
            ml_append(lnum++, IObuff, (colnr_T)0, FALSE);
        }
    }
    else
        do_region = FALSE;

    /*
     * Loop over all files loaded for the entries in 'spelllang'.
     */
    for (lpi = 0; lpi < buf->b_langp.ga_len; ++lpi)
    {
        lp = LANGP_ENTRY(buf->b_langp, lpi);
        slang = lp->lp_slang;
        if (slang->sl_fbyts == NULL)        /* reloading failed */
            continue;

        if (pat == NULL)
        {
            vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, "# file: %s", slang->sl_fname);
            ml_append(lnum++, IObuff, (colnr_T)0, FALSE);
        }

        /* When matching with a pattern and there are no prefixes only use
         * parts of the tree that match "pat". */
        if (pat != NULL && slang->sl_pbyts == NULL)
            patlen = (int)STRLEN(pat);
        else
            patlen = -1;

        /* round 1: case-folded tree
         * round 2: keep-case tree */
        for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round)
        {
            if (round == 1)
            {
                dumpflags &= ~DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE;
                byts = slang->sl_fbyts;
                idxs = slang->sl_fidxs;
            }
            else
            {
                dumpflags |= DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE;
                byts = slang->sl_kbyts;
                idxs = slang->sl_kidxs;
            }
            if (byts == NULL)
                continue;               /* array is empty */

            depth = 0;
            arridx[0] = 0;
            curi[0] = 1;
            while (depth >= 0 && !got_int
                                       && (pat == NULL || !compl_interrupted))
            {
                if (curi[depth] > byts[arridx[depth]])
                {
                    /* Done all bytes at this node, go up one level. */
                    --depth;
                    line_breakcheck();
                    ins_compl_check_keys(50);
                }
                else
                {
                    /* Do one more byte at this node. */
                    n = arridx[depth] + curi[depth];
                    ++curi[depth];
                    c = byts[n];
                    if (c == 0)
                    {
                        /* End of word, deal with the word.
                         * Don't use keep-case words in the fold-case tree,
                         * they will appear in the keep-case tree.
                         * Only use the word when the region matches. */
                        flags = (int)idxs[n];
                        if ((round == 2 || (flags & WF_KEEPCAP) == 0)
                                && (flags & WF_NEEDCOMP) == 0
                                && (do_region
                                    || (flags & WF_REGION) == 0
                                    || (((unsigned)flags >> 16)
                                                       & lp->lp_region) != 0))
                        {
                            word[depth] = NUL;
                            if (!do_region)
                                flags &= ~WF_REGION;

                            /* Dump the basic word if there is no prefix or
                             * when it's the first one. */
                            c = (unsigned)flags >> 24;
                            if (c == 0 || curi[depth] == 2)
                            {
                                dump_word(slang, word, pat, dir,
                                                      dumpflags, flags, lnum);
                                if (pat == NULL)
                                    ++lnum;
                            }

                            /* Apply the prefix, if there is one. */
                            if (c != 0)
                                lnum = dump_prefixes(slang, word, pat, dir,
                                                      dumpflags, flags, lnum);
                        }
                    }
                    else
                    {
                        /* Normal char, go one level deeper. */
                        word[depth++] = c;
                        arridx[depth] = idxs[n];
                        curi[depth] = 1;

                        /* Check if this characters matches with the pattern.
                         * If not skip the whole tree below it.
                         * Always ignore case here, dump_word() will check
                         * proper case later.  This isn't exactly right when
                         * length changes for multi-byte characters with
                         * ignore case... */
                        if (depth <= patlen
                                        && MB_STRNICMP(word, pat, depth) != 0)
                            --depth;
                    }
                }
            }
        }
    }
}

/*
 * Dump one word: apply case modifications and append a line to the buffer.
 * When "lnum" is zero add insert mode completion.
 */
    static void
dump_word(slang, word, pat, dir, dumpflags, wordflags, lnum)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *word;
    char_u      *pat;
    int         *dir;
    int         dumpflags;
    int         wordflags;
    linenr_T    lnum;
{
    int         keepcap = FALSE;
    char_u      *p;
    char_u      *tw;
    char_u      cword[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      badword[MAXWLEN + 10];
    int         i;
    int         flags = wordflags;

    if (dumpflags & DUMPFLAG_ONECAP)
        flags |= WF_ONECAP;
    if (dumpflags & DUMPFLAG_ALLCAP)
        flags |= WF_ALLCAP;

    if ((dumpflags & DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE) == 0 && (flags & WF_CAPMASK) != 0)
    {
        /* Need to fix case according to "flags". */
        make_case_word(word, cword, flags);
        p = cword;
    }
    else
    {
        p = word;
        if ((dumpflags & DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE)
                && ((captype(word, NULL) & WF_KEEPCAP) == 0
                                                 || (flags & WF_FIXCAP) != 0))
            keepcap = TRUE;
    }
    tw = p;

    if (pat == NULL)
    {
        /* Add flags and regions after a slash. */
        if ((flags & (WF_BANNED | WF_RARE | WF_REGION)) || keepcap)
        {
            STRCPY(badword, p);
            STRCAT(badword, "/");
            if (keepcap)
                STRCAT(badword, "=");
            if (flags & WF_BANNED)
                STRCAT(badword, "!");
            else if (flags & WF_RARE)
                STRCAT(badword, "?");
            if (flags & WF_REGION)
                for (i = 0; i < 7; ++i)
                    if (flags & (0x10000 << i))
                        sprintf((char *)badword + STRLEN(badword), "%d", i + 1);
            p = badword;
        }

        if (dumpflags & DUMPFLAG_COUNT)
        {
            hashitem_T  *hi;

            /* Include the word count for ":spelldump!". */
            hi = hash_find(&slang->sl_wordcount, tw);
            if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
            {
                vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff, IOSIZE, "%s\t%d",
                                                     tw, HI2WC(hi)->wc_count);
                p = IObuff;
            }
        }

        ml_append(lnum, p, (colnr_T)0, FALSE);
    }
    else if (((dumpflags & DUMPFLAG_ICASE)
                    ? MB_STRNICMP(p, pat, STRLEN(pat)) == 0
                    : STRNCMP(p, pat, STRLEN(pat)) == 0)
                && ins_compl_add_infercase(p, (int)STRLEN(p),
                                          p_ic, NULL, *dir, 0) == OK)
        /* if dir was BACKWARD then honor it just once */
        *dir = FORWARD;
}

/*
 * For ":spelldump": Find matching prefixes for "word".  Prepend each to
 * "word" and append a line to the buffer.
 * When "lnum" is zero add insert mode completion.
 * Return the updated line number.
 */
    static linenr_T
dump_prefixes(slang, word, pat, dir, dumpflags, flags, startlnum)
    slang_T     *slang;
    char_u      *word;      /* case-folded word */
    char_u      *pat;
    int         *dir;
    int         dumpflags;
    int         flags;      /* flags with prefix ID */
    linenr_T    startlnum;
{
    idx_T       arridx[MAXWLEN];
    int         curi[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      prefix[MAXWLEN];
    char_u      word_up[MAXWLEN];
    int         has_word_up = FALSE;
    int         c;
    char_u      *byts;
    idx_T       *idxs;
    linenr_T    lnum = startlnum;
    int         depth;
    int         n;
    int         len;
    int         i;

    /* If the word starts with a lower-case letter make the word with an
     * upper-case letter in word_up[]. */
    c = PTR2CHAR(word);
    if (SPELL_TOUPPER(c) != c)
    {
        onecap_copy(word, word_up, TRUE);
        has_word_up = TRUE;
    }

    byts = slang->sl_pbyts;
    idxs = slang->sl_pidxs;
    if (byts != NULL)           /* array not is empty */
    {
        /*
         * Loop over all prefixes, building them byte-by-byte in prefix[].
         * When at the end of a prefix check that it supports "flags".
         */
        depth = 0;
        arridx[0] = 0;
        curi[0] = 1;
        while (depth >= 0 && !got_int)
        {
            n = arridx[depth];
            len = byts[n];
            if (curi[depth] > len)
            {
                /* Done all bytes at this node, go up one level. */
                --depth;
                line_breakcheck();
            }
            else
            {
                /* Do one more byte at this node. */
                n += curi[depth];
                ++curi[depth];
                c = byts[n];
                if (c == 0)
                {
                    /* End of prefix, find out how many IDs there are. */
                    for (i = 1; i < len; ++i)
                        if (byts[n + i] != 0)
                            break;
                    curi[depth] += i - 1;

                    c = valid_word_prefix(i, n, flags, word, slang, FALSE);
                    if (c != 0)
                    {
                        vim_strncpy(prefix + depth, word, MAXWLEN - depth - 1);
                        dump_word(slang, prefix, pat, dir, dumpflags,
                                (c & WF_RAREPFX) ? (flags | WF_RARE)
                                                               : flags, lnum);
                        if (lnum != 0)
                            ++lnum;
                    }

                    /* Check for prefix that matches the word when the
                     * first letter is upper-case, but only if the prefix has
                     * a condition. */
                    if (has_word_up)
                    {
                        c = valid_word_prefix(i, n, flags, word_up, slang,
                                                                        TRUE);
                        if (c != 0)
                        {
                            vim_strncpy(prefix + depth, word_up,
                                                         MAXWLEN - depth - 1);
                            dump_word(slang, prefix, pat, dir, dumpflags,
                                    (c & WF_RAREPFX) ? (flags | WF_RARE)
                                                               : flags, lnum);
                            if (lnum != 0)
                                ++lnum;
                        }
                    }
                }
                else
                {
                    /* Normal char, go one level deeper. */
                    prefix[depth++] = c;
                    arridx[depth] = idxs[n];
                    curi[depth] = 1;
                }
            }
        }
    }

    return lnum;
}

/*
 * Move "p" to the end of word "start".
 * Uses the spell-checking word characters.
 */
    char_u *
spell_to_word_end(start, buf)
    char_u  *start;
    buf_T   *buf;
{
    char_u  *p = start;

    while (*p != NUL && spell_iswordp(p, buf))
        mb_ptr_adv(p);
    return p;
}

#if defined(FEAT_INS_EXPAND) || defined(PROTO)
/*
 * For Insert mode completion CTRL-X s:
 * Find start of the word in front of column "startcol".
 * We don't check if it is badly spelled, with completion we can only change
 * the word in front of the cursor.
 * Returns the column number of the word.
 */
    int
spell_word_start(startcol)
    int         startcol;
{
    char_u      *line;
    char_u      *p;
    int         col = 0;

    if (no_spell_checking(curwin))
        return startcol;

    /* Find a word character before "startcol". */
    line = ml_get_curline();
    for (p = line + startcol; p > line; )
    {
        mb_ptr_back(line, p);
        if (spell_iswordp_nmw(p))
            break;
    }

    /* Go back to start of the word. */
    while (p > line)
    {
        col = (int)(p - line);
        mb_ptr_back(line, p);
        if (!spell_iswordp(p, curbuf))
            break;
        col = 0;
    }

    return col;
}

/*
 * Need to check for 'spellcapcheck' now, the word is removed before
 * expand_spelling() is called.  Therefore the ugly global variable.
 */
static int spell_expand_need_cap;

    void
spell_expand_check_cap(col)
    colnr_T col;
{
    spell_expand_need_cap = check_need_cap(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, col);
}

/*
 * Get list of spelling suggestions.
 * Used for Insert mode completion CTRL-X ?.
 * Returns the number of matches.  The matches are in "matchp[]", array of
 * allocated strings.
 */
/*ARGSUSED*/
    int
expand_spelling(lnum, col, pat, matchp)
    linenr_T    lnum;
    int         col;
    char_u      *pat;
    char_u      ***matchp;
{
    garray_T    ga;

    spell_suggest_list(&ga, pat, 100, spell_expand_need_cap, TRUE);
    *matchp = ga.ga_data;
    return ga.ga_len;
}
#endif

#endif  /* FEAT_SPELL */